Special Studies

Report of the Advisory Committee on the Capital Formation and Regulatory Processes

July 24, 1996
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
ADVISORY COMMITTEE ON THE
CAPITAL FORMATION AND REGULATORY PROCESSES


     July 24, 1996


Chairman Arthur Levitt
Commissioner Norman S. Johnson
Commissioner Isaac C. Hunt
Securities and Exchange Commission
Washington, DC  20549

Dear Mr. Chairman and Commissioners:

     The Commission's Advisory Committee on the Capital Formation
and Regulatory Processes is pleased to transmit its final report
to the Commission.  The Committee unanimously recommends that the
Commission act promptly both to strengthen existing investor
safeguards and to reduce the costs of corporate capital formation
in the United States by establishing a company-based registration
system.

     Company registration is the logical culmination of a
progression over the past three decades -- a progression
encouraged by Congress, investors, industry and others -- away
from the transaction-based framework for the registration of
securities offerings.  On numerous occasions in the past, the
Commission, just as it has done now by creating this Committee,
has recognized the need for reforms in the transaction-based
system.  In 1982, for example, the Commission took a major step
towards the goal of company registration by establishing its
precursor -- the integrated disclosure system for the primary
offering and secondary trading markets, and the concurrent
adoption of the streamlined shelf registration procedure.
Consistent with the view of a decade and a half ago, the
Committee today believes that the transactional concepts still
underlying the current scheme continue to impose unnecessary
costs and restrictions on issuer access to capital.  Perhaps more
importantly, in many instances the transactional system also
serves as an impediment to full and timely disclosure to
investors and the markets, and the realization of the full
potential for investor protection provided by the Securities Act.

          After much research, study and debate, the Committee
has concluded that the significant changes in the securities
markets over the past sixty years, which have accelerated in the
last dozen or so, continue to strain the remnants of the current
transactional registration scheme.  More specifically, as
detailed in the Committee's report,


the Committee has identified a variety of regulatory
uncertainties, complexities and anomalies, many of which stem
from efforts to adapt the Securities Act's registration and
prospectus delivery provisions to current market developments.
Over time,  the continuation of these changes will reduce the
current scheme s ability to provide the highest level of
essential investor protections.

     Moreover, certain innovations brought about by, among other
factors, technology and the globalization of our markets, while
benefiting issuers, have not always produced meaningful
countervailing benefits for investors in either the primary
offering or secondary trading markets.  In fact, in certain
cases, these innovations have had the unintended consequence of
possibly weakening available investor protections.  In addition,
they have not addressed the concerns of other market participants
who have legal obligations created under a scheme crafted in the
1930s, but whose ability to execute their duties has come under
stress in the financing environment of the 1990s.

     Accordingly, the Committee commends Chairman Levitt and the
Commission for charging the Committee with the responsibility to
evaluate the continuing efficacy of the present scheme governing
corporate capital formation, and to consider and, if warranted,
recommend an alternative approach.  The Committee recognizes that
streamlining can be accomplished at the expense of, or at least
without increasing, investor protection.  Consistent with the
principles of Chairman Levitt s leadership and the Commission s
historical approach, the Committee refused to proceed in that
direction.  It assumed the mandate of crafting a system that
would both increase investor protection and reduce regulatory
burdens.

     Under the new approach, reporting companies will benefit
from an offering process that essentially converts the current,
stop-and-go shelf registration system into a continuous, pay-as-
you-go registration process.  Under a full company registration
system, the one-time registration of eligible companies generally
would encompass all securities that they or their affiliates
might offer or sell thereafter.  Issuers and investors will both
benefit from this fundamental conceptual change that will
eliminate artificial distinctions among the markets for the
issuer's securities and the restrictions on the resale of those
securities based upon the nature of the transaction in which the
security was initially sold.  In addition, investors benefit from
an appropriately expanded reach of the Securities Act s liability
protections to cover more transactions, including private
placements and the flowback of offshore offerings, and more
disclosures, than under the current system.


     Importantly, an integral part of the company registration
system is improvements in disclosure practices by registered


companies.  Increased attention focused on the periodic reports
provided to the markets makes sense.  Investors rely on those
reports in deciding whether to buy securities pursuant to an
offering by a public company or any of its affiliates.  They also
rely on those reports in deciding whether to buy or sell that
company's securities in the secondary trading markets.  The
secondary trading markets have grown so substantially, and so
dwarf the primary markets, that a disclosure system that relies
on high quality disclosures only when a company episodically, if
ever, goes to market disserves the investing public.  Moreover,
in order for a streamlined offering process that relies on the
existing periodic reports to work without harming investor
interests, the system must ensure the highest level of integrity
for those periodic reports.  Any streamlining without improving
the current disclosure process should not be acceptable.
Consequently, the company registration model includes specific
reforms tailored to enhance the accuracy and reliability of
information, and the timeliness of the information, furnished by
registered companies to investors and other participants in the
securities markets.

     The company registration model also reinforces investor
protection by incorporating measures that enhance the monitoring
functions of underwriters, outside directors and auditors.  All
these reforms are loyal to the central premise that the benefits
and protections of the regulatory process, heretofore triggered
by the infrequent and unpredictable occasion of a public offering
of securities, should operate on a continuous basis for the
benefit of all investors in the company's securities.

     The Committee recommends that the Commission pursue as its
ultimate goal the implementation of a full company registration
model that eliminates completely the need to register securities
offerings, thereby replacing the current transactional
registration requirements and exemptions for all reporting
companies.  The Committee also recommends, however, that the
system be initiated through a voluntary "pilot" program open only
to larger, more seasoned, companies.  The Committee believes that
such a pilot will provide a meaningful  market test  of the
advantages of this model and will provide greater flexibility for
any experimentation or adjustment the Commission might deem
necessary or appropriate.  The pilot program should provide the
foundation for deciding what legislative and regulatory
modifications, if any, would be appropriate to complete the
transition to a company registration system.

     In closing, the Committee's members wish to thank Chairman
Levitt and the Commission for the opportunity and the privilege
to serve on the Committee and to participate in these important
reforms.  The Committee strongly believes that this new system
will provide companies and their investors with a regulatory
scheme to meet their needs in the new century.  At each of the
times in the past when the Commission considered bold action that
would both improve investor protection and streamline the capital


formation process, this country's markets were the largest, the
most liquid, the deepest and the most honest.  Each time
regulatory innovations were in fact adopted that combined both
investor protection and streamlining, the markets became even
better.  The Commission has the opportunity to do that again
here.  Each member of the Committee looks forward to the
Commission's progress in considering the Committee's
recommendations, and remains willing to provide any additional
assistance in this regard.

             Respectfully submitted on behalf of the Committee,




                    The Honorable Steven M.H. Wallman
                    Committee Chairman


Members of the Committee:

Professor John C. Coffee, Jr.
The Honorable Barber B. Conable, Jr.
Robert K. Elliott
Edward F. Greene
Dr. George N. Hatsopolous
A. Bart Holaday
Paul Kolton
Roland M. Machold
Dr. Burton G. Malkiel
Claudine Malone
Charles Miller
Karen M. O'Brien
Lawrence W. Sonsini


                               TABLE OF CONTENTS


I.    INTRODUCTION AND SUMMARY

      A.    Findings and Recommendations of the Committee. . . . . . . . . .

      B.    The Work of the Committee and Structure of the Report. . . . . . .

II.   RECOMMENDATIONS OF THE ADVISORY COMMITTEE

      A.    Reasons for the Recommendations and Anticipated
Benefits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
      1.    General Statement of Committee's Recommendation to
            Shift
            From a Transactional Registration System to a Company
            Registration System. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

      2.    Identified Problems of the Current Transactional
            System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

      3.    Company Registration as the Logical Conclusion of
            Evolutionary
            Change in the Regulatory Process . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

      4.    The Benefits of the Company Registration System as
            Compared to the   Current Transactional Regulatory
            System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

      B.    Key Elements of the Recommendations

      1.    The Offering Process . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

      2.    Prospectus Delivery Requirement. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

      3.    Scope. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

      4.    Disclosure Enhancements. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

      5.    Liability. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

      6.    Due Diligence. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

      7.    Disclosure Committee . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

III.  CONCLUSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

IV.   SEPARATE STATEMENT OF JOHN C. COFFEE, JR., EDWARD F. GREENE,
      AND LAWRENCE W. SONSINI. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .


           APPENDIX A: THE IMPACT OF THE CURRENT REGULATORY SYSTEM
                 ON INVESTOR PROTECTION AND CAPITAL FORMATION


I.    Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

II.   Direct and Indirect Costs and Uncertainties Resulting
      From the Registration Process for Public Offerings . . . . . . . . . .

            A.    Costs of Registration - The Offering Process . . . . . . .

            B.    Indirect Costs Associated with the Current Regulatory Scheme

III.  Changes in the Markets and Offering Processes, and the Effect on
            Investor Protection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

            A.    Attractiveness of Public, Private and Offshore Markets . . .

            B.    Blurring of Distinctions Between Public, Private and
                  Offshore Markets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

            C.    Growth of Secondary Markets and Changes in Offering
                  Techniques . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

            D.    Changes in Gatekeeper Role . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

      Addendums to Appendix A

                    APPENDIX B:   ESSENTIAL ELEMENTS OF THE
                          COMPANY REGISTRATION SYSTEM

      I.    Disclosure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

            A.    Disclosure and Prospectus Delivery Under the Company
                  Registration System. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

            B.    Role of the SEC and Other Gatekeepers. . . . . . . . . . . .

      II.   Company Eligibility. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

      III.  Transactions Covered . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

            A.    Affiliate and Underwriter Resales. . . . . . . . . . . . . .

            B.    Exclusions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

            C.    Offshore Offerings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

            D.    Preservation of Transactional Exemptions . . . . . . . . . .

            E.    Limited Placements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .



      IV.   Disclosure Enhancements Under the Recommended Company
            Registration Model . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

            A.    Mandatory Disclosure Enhancements. . . . . . . . . . . . . .

            B.    Conclusion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

      V.    Liability and Due Diligence Under Company Registration . . . . . .

            A.    Liability Under Company Registration . . . . . . . . . . . .

            B.    Due Diligence Under Company Registration . . . . . . . . . .

            C.    Conclusion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

      Addendum to Appendix B -- Comparison of Company Registration and Shelf Offering
      System
              
==========================================START OF PAGE 1======

                        COMMITTEE MEMBERS

The Honorable Steven M.H. Wallman, Committee Chairman
SEC Commissioner; former partner, Covington & Burling

Professor John C. Coffee, Jr.
Adolf A. Berle Professor of Law, Columbia University Law School

The Honorable Barber B. Conable, Jr.
Corporate director; former President, World Bank; former member,
U.S. House of Representatives; and former New York Stock Exchange
director

Robert K. Elliott
Partner, KPMG Peat Marwick LLP; Chair, AICPA Special Committee on
Assurance Services, and Member, AICPA's Board of Directors and
Governing Council

Edward F. Greene
Partner, Cleary, Gottlieb, Steen & Hamilton; former SEC General
Counsel; and former Director, SEC Division of Corporation Finance

Dr. George N. Hatsopoulos
Chairman of the Board and President, Thermo Electron Corporation;
and former Chairman, Federal Reserve Bank of Boston

A. Bart Holaday
Managing Partner, Private Markets Group and Member of the Board
of Directors, Brinson Partners, Inc.; and member of the board,
National Venture Capital Association

Paul Kolton
Corporate and fund director; former President and Chairman of the
American Stock Exchange; former Chairman, Financial Accounting
Standards Board's Advisory Council

Roland M. Machold
Director, New Jersey Division of Investment; former Vice
President, Morgan Stanley & Co.

Dr. Burton G. Malkiel
Professor of Economics, Princeton University and corporate and
fund director; former Dean, Yale School of Management; former
member, President's Council of Economic Advisers.

Claudine B. Malone
President of Financial & Management Consulting, Inc., and
corporate director; former Professor, Harvard Graduate School of
Business Administration

Charles Miller


==========================================START OF PAGE 2======

Chairman, Medallion Investment Management Company and Meridian
Advisors, Ltd.; corporate director; former Chief Investment
Officer, Transamerica Asset Management Group

Karen M. O'Brien
General Counsel, North American Securities Administrators
Association

Lawrence W. Sonsini
Partner, Wilson, Sonsini, Goodrich & Rosati; corporate director


                         COMMITTEE STAFF

David A. Sirignano, Committee Staff Director
Associate Director
Division of Corporation Finance

Dr. Robert Comment
Deputy Chief Economist
Office of Economic Analysis

Catherine T. Dixon
Chief, Office of Mergers and Acquisitions
Division of Corporation Finance

Meridith Mitchell
Assistant General Counsel
Office of the General Counsel

Luise M. Welby
Special Counsel
Office of International Corporate Finance
Division of Corporation Finance.


==========================================START OF PAGE i======
                   I. INTRODUCTION AND SUMMARY

A.   Findings and Recommendations of the Committee

     In February 1995, the Securities and Exchange Commission

(the "Commission" or "SEC") established the Advisory Committee on

the Capital Formation and Regulatory Processes (the "Committee").


Commissioner Steven M.H. Wallman was appointed by SEC Chairman

Arthur Levitt as the Committee's Chairman.  The Committee was

authorized to advise the Commission on, among other things, the

current regulatory process and the disclosure and reporting

requirements relating to public offerings of securities, as well

as secondary market trading, and to identify and develop means to

minimize the costs imposed by existing regulatory

programs.-[1]-

     The Committee determined to focus specifically on the

regulatory framework for securities offerings and continuing

disclosure by corporate issuers.  Early in its deliberations, the

Committee concluded that the current procedures under the

Securities Act of 1933 (the "Securities Act")-[2]- are well

suited for companies that are engaging in an initial public

offering, i.e., a transaction in which a company is publicly

offering its securities for the first time.  The Committee

determined, however, that the capital-raising activities of


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[1]-     Copies of the Committee's original Charter and
               renewal Charter are attached in Appendix D.

     -[2]-     15 U.S.C. 77a et seq.


==========================================START OF PAGE ii======

companies that have already offered their securities to the

public and are currently filing periodic reports with the

Commission pursuant to the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (the

"Exchange Act")-[3]- have changed dramatically and

fundamentally over the last half century.  Consequently, the

Committee primarily focused its attention on identifying issues

and crafting solutions related to those activities.

     The Committee initially identified certain aspects of the

current transactional registration approach of the Securities Act

that, at least as applied to reporting companies, may adversely

affect investor protection and the capital formation process.

The Committee then explored alternative regulatory strategies

that would: (i) enhance investor protection by extending and

reinforcing the protections of the Securities Act; (ii) improve

the efficiency of access by such companies to the U.S. capital

markets; (iii) eliminate unnecessary regulatory costs and

uncertainties for issuers; and (iv) enhance the quality and

integrity of disclosures provided to investors in both the

primary offering and secondary trading markets.-[4]-  The

Committee generally concluded that, in order to achieve these

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[3]-     15 U.S.C. 78a et seq.

     -[4]-     The Committee staff also examined foreign
               regulatory schemes relating to public offerings of
               securities for guidance with respect to possible
               alternative regulatory approaches, particularly
               with respect to offerings by seasoned issuers.
               See Documents for Advisory Committee Meeting, June
               15, 1995, Tab F (the Committee staff's study of
               certain foreign regulatory schemes).


==========================================START OF PAGE iii======

goals, the focus of the regulatory process in the post-initial

public offering context should be shifted from registering

transactions to registering companies, with a corresponding

emphasis on better ensuring the accuracy and integrity of

continuing disclosures.  As a consequence of this conceptual

shift, once a company is registered and filing the required

public reports, all the securities that the company or its

affiliates sell thereafter would be deemed registered for

purposes of the Securities Act, investors would be more fully

protected in more transactions, and the issuer would be able to

offer and sell its securities without any regulatory delay in

virtually all cases.

     The Committee next developed a package of concepts -- under

the label "company registration" -- to accomplish this shift in

regulatory focus.  At the request of the Committee, the Committee

staff created a working "Term Sheet" describing possible company

registration models to be implemented on an experimental or

"pilot" basis, which the Committee used as an evolving framework

for consideration and discussions at Committee

meetings.-[5]-  The model includes measures designed both to

streamline the offering and disclosure processes, and to improve

the timeliness, quality, reliability and integrity of information

provided to investors and other participants in the securities


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[5]-     The most recent Term Sheet outlining a model for a
               pilot program to test the company registration
               concept is attached as Appendix C to this Report.


==========================================START OF PAGE iv======

markets.  Based upon Committee deliberations, as well as

Committee and staff consultations with representatives of the

investor, issuer, underwriter, legal, accounting and academic

communities, the Committee concluded that the proposed company

registration system would reduce substantially unnecessary

regulatory costs and burdens for issuers while enhancing investor

protection.

     As discussed more fully in the balance of this Report, the

Committee determined that a pilot company registration program

would be the most appropriate way to begin the transition.  The

pilot would be available initially only to issuers that meet

certain criteria, such as having a specified minimum public float

and reporting history.  Because these issuers generally are more

sophisticated with respect to financial reporting and other

disclosure requirements and are more widely followed by the

markets, the Committee concluded that permitting these types of

issuers to opt into the pilot program would provide the best test

of the advantages of the company registration system as compared

to the current system.  If the pilot is successful, the Committee

believes that the Commission should extend the benefits of

company registration, perhaps with additional conditions, to

smaller public companies and their investors as soon as possible.

     The streamlining of the offering process will result from

the adoption of a new registration procedure under which the

company would register to enter into the system (on a new Form C-

1 registration statement).  Thereafter, each issuance by the


==========================================START OF PAGE v======

registered company of its securities would be deemed registered

under the Securities Act, including securities issued in

acquisitions and securities initially sold offshore that flow

back into the United States, with all the protections and

remedies that currently adhere to a registered transaction.  A

registration fee would be paid to the Commission at the time of

each sale of securities, rather than at the time of filing of the

Form C-1 (thereby creating a "pay-as-you-go" system).  As a

result, the current limitations of the shelf registration system

on the amount of securities that could be registered would be

eliminated, as would the need to file a new registration

statement to register additional securities.  This process also

would eliminate the uncertainties and delay in the offering

process resulting from the potential for Commission staff review

prior to a registration statement being declared effective.

Such uncertainty and delay has already been eliminated in the

context of takedowns from an already effective shelf registration

statement, but not with respect to the initial effectiveness of

the shelf registration statement.

     Under company registration, the nature and amount of

information about the company and its securities required to be

on file with the Commission at the time of sale would be at least

as extensive as that now required under the current Securities

Act registration forms.  Provided all mandated information has

been disclosed to the markets, issuers in routine transactions

would be permitted to tailor the disclosure physically delivered


==========================================START OF PAGE vi======
to investors in a prospectus as necessary to meet the

informational demands of investors in light of the nature of the

transaction, as assessed by the issuer and underwriter in

marketing the securities.  Consequently, the information provided

to investors should be both more readable (in plainer English)

and more useful (because it is tailored to the investors' needs).


Moreover, under a "full" company registration system where all

securities are registered, a reduction in the scope of the resale

restrictions applicable to affiliates is possible and desirable

because subjecting these holders to resale restrictions would

serve no purpose since all the securities are already registered.


As a result, most directors and officers will no longer be

subject to resale restrictions.

     The investor protection improvements of the company

registration system will deliver benefits both at the time of the

offering and on an ongoing basis.  In most equity offerings,

information regarding the specific transaction and any material

developments will be filed with the Commission, and therefore

made available to all investors and the markets, no later than

the date of first sale (material developments will have to be on

file in sufficient time for the market to absorb the information

before the sale is made), rather than as late as two days after

the delivery of the prospectus as permitted under the current

shelf registration system.  This reform will serve a number of

beneficial purposes.  First, it ensures that the market receives

timely notice of material developments, thereby providing the


==========================================START OF PAGE vii======

market sufficient opportunity to react to the information prior

to investors making an investment decision.  Second, it will

assist underwriters and others with due diligence

responsibilities to focus on the information important to the

offering and help ensure that it is fully and accurately

disclosed.  Third, it will extend full coverage of the statutory

liability provisions to this important information.  In addition,

in those large offerings where issuers will be required under the

model to deliver a formal prospectus, the prospectus must be

delivered to a potential investor in time to inform the

investment decision.  Under current procedures, the prospectus

can be delivered with the confirmation, well after an investor

has already made an investment decision.

     Various measures designed to improve the quality and

integrity of a registered company's disclosure on an ongoing

basis are part of the recommended company registration system.

These measures include improved procedures to focus the attention

of management and the board of directors on the periodic and

other reports prepared and filed by the company, and to provide

for more timely disclosure of material developments.  For the

first time, risk factor disclosure will be provided to investors

in the secondary trading markets through the company's annual

report on Form 10-K filed with the Commission.  In addition, the

company registration system will create incentives for the

reordering and rationalization of "information monitoring" or

"gatekeeping" functions to provide greater oversight of the


======================================START OF PAGE viii======

issuer's disclosures on an ongoing basis.  The system does so by,

among other things, specifying additional factors that may be

taken into consideration in satisfying the due diligence and

reasonable care defenses of certain gatekeepers or monitors under

Sections 11 and 12(a)(2) of the Securities Act.  By enhancing the

quality and integrity of disclosure and thereby reducing the

likelihood of material misstatements and omissions by the issuer

and others engaged in a public offering, the model also should

operate, as a practical matter, to decrease the liability

exposure of these parties.

     In connection with its deliberations on company

registration, the Committee also examined the concept of

encouraging a company's board of directors to adopt a board

"disclosure committee" (which could be the audit committee).

This concept has as its goal enhancing the reliability and

integrity of an issuer's public disclosures, by promoting better

and more intensive due diligence on the part of outside directors

on an ongoing basis.  This separate recommendation of the

Committee, which could be effectuated regardless of whether

company registration is adopted (and, conversely, company

registration could be adopted regardless of whether the

disclosure committee concept is embraced), also is discussed in

this Report.

B.   The Work of the Committee and Structure of the Report

     The Committee held eight public meetings.  The Committee and

its staff also met with numerous groups and individuals concerned


==========================================START OF PAGE ix======
with or affected by the Commission's regulation of the capital

formation process.  The Committee wishes to acknowledge with deep

appreciation the thoughtful comments and insights provided by

these groups and individuals.  The letters and articles submitted

by commenters for the benefit of the Committee are available from

the SEC Public Reference Room, File No. 265-20.

     Except with respect to certain recommendations to improve

the quality and integrity of periodic reporting under the

Exchange Act, the Committee determined not to address specific

line-item requirements prescribing the content and manner of

presentation of disclosure documents filed with the Commission.

An internal Commission task force, known as the Task Force on

Disclosure Simplification, has reviewed these requirements, and

recently published a report recommending that the Commission

eliminate 91 rules and 22 forms, and modify dozens of

others.-[6]-  Separately, the Commission also initiated

rulemaking addressing several issues raised by Committee members

in the course of the Committee's deliberations.-[7]-  The

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[6]-     See Report of the Task Force on Disclosure
               Simplification to the Securities and Exchange
               Commission (March 5, 1996).

     -[7]-     For example, improving the safe-harbor for
               forward-looking statements was a significant
               concern of some members of the Committee, a matter
               which already was under consideration by both the
               Commission and Congress during the deliberations
               on the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of
               1995, enacted in late 1995 (Pub. L. No. 104-67
               (December 22, 1995)); see also Safe Harbor For
               Forward-Looking Statements, Securities Act Rel.
               7101 (October 13, 1994)[59 FR 52723 (October 19,
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE x======

Committee also determined at the outset of its deliberations to

focus on issues regarding the application of the Securities Act

to companies that are reporting under the Exchange Act.  The

Commission already was pursuing many issues affecting non-

reporting companies that access the securities markets for

capital pursuant to various Securities Act exemptions.-[8]-

Consequently, these specific issues and policies are not

addressed in this Report.

     The Committee's recommendations are presented in two main

parts in this Report.  Section IIA of the Report contains a

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[7]-(...continued)
               1994)].  Various Committee members also were
               critical of the Commission's rules under the
               Securities Act requiring the disclosure of
               financial and other business information about
               material acquisitions or dispositions.  The
               Commission has now proposed conforming those rules
               under the Securities Act to the requirements under
               the Exchange Act.  See Streamlining Disclosure
               Requirements Relating to Significant Business
               Acquisitions and Requiring Quarterly Reporting of
               Unregistered Equity Sales, Securities Act Rel.
               7189 (June 27, 1995)[60 FR 35656 (July 10, 1995)].

     -[8]-     For example, numerous Committee members suggested
               that the Commission seek ways to facilitate
               capital formation by small businesses.  In June
               1995, the Commission issued a proposal regarding a
               "test the waters" provision with respect to
               initial public offerings to allow private
               companies contemplating a public offering to
               ascertain whether their securities are marketable
               before preparing expensive registration
               documentation. See Solicitations of Interest Prior
               to an Initial Public Offering, Securities Act Rel.
               7188 (June 27, 1995)[60 FR 35648 (July 10, 1995)];
               see also the recently adopted Exemption for
               Certain California Limited Issues, Securities Act
               Rel. 7285 (May 1, 1996)[61 FR 21356 (May 9,
               1996)].


==========================================START OF PAGE xi======
general discussion of the Committee's recommendation that the

Commission shift its regulatory focus from the registration of

securities transactions to the registration of companies, and the

reasoning underlying that recommendation.  Appendix A to the

Report provides more detailed support for the Committee's

recommendations.  It also includes data and empirical research on

the effects of the current regulatory scheme governing public

offerings on investor protection and capital formation in the

U.S. markets.  In addition, Appendix A discusses the various

costs and uncertainties of the current transactional process for

Exchange Act reporting companies.  It reviews the increasingly

complex and technical regulatory concepts that have become

necessary to protect the current transaction-based paradigm in

light of significant shifts in investor demographics, market

structure and communications technology, and describes how these

concepts may no longer be achieving their intended goals of

protecting investors.  Appendix A concludes with a discussion of

the blurring among and between the public, private and offshore

markets, and the fundamental changes in both the composition of

these markets and their participants since the enactment of the

federal securities laws more than sixty years ago.

     Section IIB of the Report includes a summary description of

the recommended terms of the company registration system and the

suggested pilot project, as well as the Disclosure Committee

proposal.  Appendix B to the Report, in turn, describes in more

detail each of the essential elements of the company registration


==========================================START OF PAGE xii======
system -- with respect both to the recommended pilot and full

company registration system -- and explores further the support,

reasoning and rationale underlying each recommended element.

Finally, a concurring statement by Committee members John C.

Coffee, Jr., Edward F. Greene, and Lawrence W. Sonsini is set

forth in Section IV of the Report.


======================================START OF PAGE xiii======



              COMPANY REGISTRATION PILOT AT A GLANCE



Essential Elements



A.   Offering Process -- Further liberalization of shelf

     registration process; pay upon issuance fee system; no limit

     as to number or dollar amount of securities registered;

     available for acquisitions; prospectus delivery simplified.



B.   Disclosure Enhancements -- Improve level and reliability of

     information provided to primary and secondary trading

     markets through (i) measures such as senior management

     review of disclosure and management reports on procedures

     for disclosure preparation; (ii) more current disclosure of

     significant developments; and (iii) earlier filing of

     transactional information than under current requirements.



C.   Enhanced Monitor or Gatekeeper Functions -- Maintain current

     liability scheme while providing additional guidance

     regarding due diligence obligation to emphasize roles of

     parties involved with the company on a continuous basis and

     to facilitate greater involvement by certain "gatekeepers"

     or "monitors" in disclosure oversight.


==========================================START OF PAGE xiv======

D.   Enhanced Investor Protections -- In addition to B and C

     above, extend statutory liability to documents and

     transactions that currently lack such protections.



E.   Scope -- Voluntary system available to seasoned issuers

     during initial pilot; covers all offerings of nonexempt

     securities, eliminating need for the concept of "restricted"

     securities and limiting application of resale restrictions

     to a narrower subset of affiliates, and permitting narrower

     application of the statutory underwriter concept; issuers

     can elect less comprehensive pilot system preserving

     exemption for private placements, but then apply current

     restrictions on resales of privately placed securities,

     including current broader application of affiliate and

     statutory underwriter requirements.



Goals, Benefits, and Effects



A.   Eliminate unnecessary regulatory costs and uncertainties

     that impede access to capital; instead, market

     considerations, rather than regulatory concerns, will govern

     timing of offering; eliminate mandatory waiting period and

     potential for prior SEC staff review of routine transactions

     that now add cost and uncertainty.


==========================================START OF PAGE xv======

     Greater flexibility to go to market more often in lesser

     amounts in light of lower transaction costs and less delay

     and uncertainty -- will facilitate adoption of "just-in-time

     capital" techniques; alleviate market overhang effect that

     may still result from placing equity on a universal shelf;

     elimination of a separate registration requirement for

     acquisitions.



     Greater flexibility in defining nature of marketing efforts:

     timing and content of prospectus disclosure delivered to

     investors driven primarily by informational needs of

     investors, rather than need to prepare and deliver after-

     the-fact compliance documents; more flexibility in

     negotiating transactions because regulatory constraints

     significantly diminished.



B.   Reduce complexities and pricing discounts arising from the

     need to distinguish between public and private, domestic and

     offshore, and issuer and non-issuer transactions, including

     concerns regarding gun-jumping, integration, general

     solicitation, restricted securities, and other constructs

     developed over the years to maintain the separation of the

     public and private markets.



C.   Maintain and enhance the protection of investors in the

     primary and secondary trading markets with disclosure


==========================================START OF PAGE xvi======

     enhancements resulting in better due diligence practices and

     heightened level and reliability of corporate reporting;

     statutory remedies extended to more disclosure and to a

     broader class of transactions.



D.   Eliminate affiliate-type resale requirements for most

     officers and directors; provide additional guidance as to

     what constitutes "reasonable investigation" and "reasonable

     care" in context of the integrated disclosure and

     streamlined offering process.

          II.  RECOMMENDATIONS OF THE ADVISORY COMMITTEE

A.  Reasons for the Recommendations and Anticipated Benefits

     1.   General Statement of Committee's Recommendation to
          Shift From a Transactional Registration System to a
          Company Registration System

     In the Committee's view, the U.S. capital markets are deep,

liquid, efficient and reliable and, overall, the U.S. regulatory

system for securities offerings works relatively well.  While

concluding that the system is not broken, the Committee believes

that there is room for improvement.  In the words of one member,

"some fixing would make the system work even better."-[1]-

The fact that the primary equity markets have not demonstrated

any long-term upward trend as a source of capital since 1933,

despite the fact that real Gross Domestic Product has tripled

during that period,-[2]- amply justifies an inquiry into

possible regulatory inefficiencies.  In this regard, the

Committee identified various uncertainties, complexities and

anomalies in the current transactional system that unduly burden

capital formation for issuers without providing significant


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[1]-     Transcript of May 8, 1995 Advisory Committee
               meeting at 155 (statement of Dr. Burton Malkiel).
               Indeed, as noted by one commenter, the "strength
               of our current capital markets serves as a
               testament to the existing securities legislation,
               related regulations, and interpretations."
               Documents for Advisory Committee Meeting, May 8,
               1995, Tab I (Letter dated April 10, 1995 from
               Michael A. Conway, Senior Partner, KPMG Peat
               Marwick LLP to the Committee).

     -[2]-     See Figures 1 and 2 in the Addendum to Appendix A
               of the Report.


==========================================START OF PAGE 2======

offsetting benefits to investors, and other anomalies that

operate to deny needed investor protections.  Although

recognizing the past and ongoing efforts of the Commission to

address these concerns through incremental regulatory reform, the

Committee strongly believes that the time has come for a

fundamental conceptual change in the scheme of regulation

governing public offerings.-[3]-

     The Committee views a shift to company registration as the

most logical culmination of the evolving recognition over the

past thirty years by the Commission, commentators, the courts and

market participants, of the need for reform.  Specifically, it

has long been recognized that a disclosure scheme dependent on

infrequent, unpredictable and episodic offering transactions to

provide continuous and current, high quality disclosure to

investors and the public markets is not optimal.  Stated

differently, a regulatory structure that focuses on such

transactions is neither efficient nor does it necessarily serve


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[3]-     A number of expert commentators similarly have
               called for fundamental reform of the current
               regulatory system.  See, e.g., Roberta Karmel, Is
               Section 5 an Anachronism?, N.Y.L.J., December 21,
               1995, at 3; John C. Coffee, Jr., Is the Securities
               Act of 1933 Obsolete?  The SEC Increasingly
               Appears to Believe So But Has Not Yet Adopted a
               Consistent Policy to Replace It, Nat'l L. J.,
               September 4, 1995, at B4; Gerald S. Backman and
               Stephen E. Kim, A Cure for Securities Act
               Metaphysics:  Integrated Registration, INSIGHTS,
               May 1995, at 18; Joseph McLaughlin, 1933 Act's
               Registration Provisions:  Is Time Ripe for
               Repealing Them?, Nat'l L. J., August 18, 1986, at
               44.


==========================================START OF PAGE 3======

the public interest well, especially in light of the relative

size -- 35 times larger -- of the equity trading markets

(approximately $5.5 trillion dollars in 1995) as compared to the

primary markets (approximately only $155 billion in

1995).-[4]-

     If the regulatory focus is shifted to a company registration

model that would replace the transactional registration

requirements, issuers would benefit from the elimination of the

increasingly complex, but often ineffective, series of

regulations and concepts fashioned over the years to preserve

those transactional requirements.  Eligible companies would have

easier access to the capital markets with lower regulatory and

transaction costs, enabling companies to tap the equity markets

far more often than they do now.  Equally as important, adoption

of a company registration system would allow the Commission to

eliminate those anomalies under the current system that function

to deny investors the protections originally contemplated by the

Securities Act, and to make the necessary adjustments to

secondary market disclosure practices and due diligence

responsibilities that would benefit investors and provide better

continuous disclosures to the markets.

     The Committee recognized that the task of streamlining and

simplifying the current regulatory system would be beneficial.

Likewise, enhancing investor protection is always desirable.

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[4]-     See Figure 2 in the Addendum to Appendix A of the
               Report.



==========================================START OF PAGE 4======

Each of these goals could be accomplished easily at the expense

of the other by dispensing with or adding burdens, restrictions,

or liability.  However, the Committee assumed the far more

difficult task of crafting a system that both streamlines and

simplifies the offering process, thereby lowering costs, while

also enhancing investor protection and the integrity of corporate

disclosures.  The Committee believes that this company

registration model, which would accomplish both goals, is

superior to an approach that accomplishes only one.  The

Committee's approach represents a different concept in regulatory

problem-solving -- crafting a whole model -- as opposed to

effecting incremental changes to particular regulations.

     The recommendations of this Committee build upon the work of

prior Commission committees and task forces,-[5]- and upon

the work of Professor Louis Loss and other members of the

American Law Institute in connection with its Federal Securities

Code.-[6]-  That the time has come to complete the

transition to a company registration scheme is underscored by the

fact that the ALI Code -- including its centerpiece proposal for

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[5]-     See, e.g., Report of the Advisory Committee on
               Corporate Disclosure to the Securities and
               Exchange Commission, 95th Cong., 1st Sess. (Comm.
               Print 1977) (the "1977 Advisory Committee
               Report"); Disclosure to Investors, A Reappraisal
               of Administrative Policies Under the 1933 and 1934
               Acts, Report and Recommendations to the SEC from
               the Disclosure Policy Study (March 27, 1969) (the
               "Wheat Report").

     -[6]-     Federal Securities Code (Am. Law Inst.) (1980)
               (the "ALI Code").


==========================================START OF PAGE 5======

company registration -- was endorsed by two separate Commissions

in 1980 and 1982.-[7]-  Experience in the intervening decade

has only reinforced the advisability of modernizing the current

system.  The Committee urges the present Commission to complete

the transition to a system of company registration, thereby

freeing the markets of the costs, uncertainties and confusion

engendered by the current transactional registration scheme.

     The Commission's ultimate goal should be the implementation

of a system of company registration that totally replaces the

current transactional registration concept for all reporting

companies.  In order to test most effectively the feasibility of

the company registration model, however, the Committee recommends

that the Commission establish a pilot program that would be open

initially only to certain "seasoned" issuers on a voluntary

basis.  The Committee has suggested the general framework of the

pilot system, recognizing that the Commission has the expertise

to craft the details.  As the Commission and issuers gain

experience under the new system, it could be refined if necessary

and then, with appropriate modifications, be made available to a

broader class of issuers.  Once the company registration system

has sufficiently demonstrated its benefits during the pilot,




---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[7]-     Statement Concerning Codification of the Federal
               Securities Laws, Securities Act Rel. 6377 (January
               21, 1982); Statement Concerning Codification of
               the Federal Securities Laws, Securities Act Rel.
               6242 (September 18, 1980).


==========================================START OF PAGE 6======

regulatory simplification could be completed through rulemaking

and/or legislative changes, as necessary or appropriate.

     2.   Identified Problems of the Current Transactional
          System-[8]-

     The Committee identified uncertainties, complexities and

anomalies in the current transactional registration system that

increase costs of capital formation when a public trading market

already exists for an issuer's securities and adequate

information concerning the issuer is widely disseminated and

followed in that market, without providing significant

countervailing benefits to investors.  These costs are both

direct and indirect.

          a.   Procedural Requirements of the Registration

               Process

     Statutory limitations and regulatory restrictions on

solicitation activities prior to and during the registration

process make it difficult for reporting companies to distinguish

between permitted and prohibited market communications.

Companies and other offering participants therefore have limited

their ordinary-course market communications unnecessarily when

contemplating or conducting a public offering.  In the event of

improper soliciting activities (called "gun-jumping"), the

Commission may delay an offering, resulting in a possible loss of

a temporary market opportunity.  The ability of an issuer to


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[8]-     For a more in-depth discussion of the issues
               outlined in this section, see Appendix A to the
               Report.


==========================================START OF PAGE 7======

control the timing of its public offering, and therefore its

ability to take advantage of a favorable market opportunity, also

is affected by both the uncertainty of selection of its

registration statement for Commission staff review and the length

of the resultant delay if so selected.  This uncertainty

continues to impact even those companies eligible to register

securities under the shelf registration system, who may wish to

make immediate offerings, or "takedowns," after filing the shelf

registration statement, but who must wait until any possible

staff review of the registration statement is complete, before

takedown is permitted.

     In addition, the mandatory nature of the prospectus delivery

obligation in connection with a registered offering under the

current system restricts the ability of the issuer to tailor the

required document to suit the varying needs of prospective

investors.  Moreover, and perhaps more importantly, prospectus

disclosure under the current system frequently is not even

received by investors until after an investment decision is made.


This anomaly defeats the primary purpose of mandated prospectus

delivery -- that investors receive all information material to an

investment decision before making that decision.

     Similarly, under the current system, the prospectus

supplement is not required to be filed with the Commission until

two days after it is delivered to investors in the primary

offering.  Although the purchasers may have received key pricing

and other transactional information orally from participating


==========================================START OF PAGE 8======

broker-dealers at the time of takedown, the market frequently

does not have the information contained in the prospectus

supplement until days after completion of the shelf offering.

Thus, investors trading in the secondary markets

contemporaneously with a shelf offering do not have equal access

to material information until after their trading decision is

made, even though their investment decision takes place at the

same time as the primary offering.

     Perhaps more importantly, one of the central tenets of the

current shelf process -- namely the existence of an efficient

market for the issuer's securities that helps establish the price

for those securities -- is violated because the market does not

have timely access to this prospectus supplement information.

Consequently, to the extent the market is being relied upon to

help set the price for the primary offering, it is being denied

the full information it needs to do so.  This disparity in the

regulatory system exists because, under the current transactional

registration system, the focus is on information given to

purchasers in the offering, not the market.  Under the company-

focused approach, by contrast, there is a greater concern for the

quality and timeliness of information available to the market and

all investors.

     Further driving the need to reassess this process is the

development of new technologies that are changing rapidly the way

in which information is communicated and disseminated in our

markets.  Present and future changes in technology, particularly


==========================================START OF PAGE 9======

in light of the advent of T+3 clearance and settlement,

electronic dissemination of offering documents, and the

development of trading markets over the Internet, can only

continue to challenge the current system.

     Finally, the registration process itself imposes direct

expenses on an issuer in the form of legal, accounting,

underwriting, printing and filing fees, as well as indirect costs

due to the effects of market overhang and short-selling and

related activities on the market price of an issuer's securities

traded in the secondary markets.  Under a company registration

system that allows "just-in-time" financing techniques, these

costs should be reduced.


==========================================START OF PAGE 10======

          b.   Technical Distinctions and Concepts Designed to
               Protect the Integrity of the Transactional
               Registration Paradigm

      While originally devised to prevent evasion of the

transactional registration requirements, the technical

distinctions and concepts developed by regulation and/or

interpretation over the years -- such as "restricted" securities,

integration of offerings and limitations on general solicitations

-- have added a significant degree of confusion and uncertainty,

as well as constraints and costs, to the capital formation

process.  These concepts and requirements increasingly have been

condemned as "metaphysics,"-[9]- and are among the reasons

why issuers often offer securities in the private and offshore

markets.  Public companies that today wish to avoid the

disadvantages of the current registration scheme currently bear

the burden of an illiquidity discount in private placements of

securities or the additional logistical burdens of an overseas

offering.  In the case of seasoned companies, these restrictive

concepts have limited practical or economic substance in terms of

investor protection.  Given that they drive seasoned companies to

markets where there are in fact little or no Securities Act

investor protections, these concepts are increasingly difficult

to defend on a legal, economic or investor protection basis.


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[9]-     See, e.g., Stanley Keller, Basic Securities Act
               Concepts Revisited, INSIGHTS, May 1995, at 5;
               Gerald S. Backman and Stephen E. Kim, A Cure for
               Securities Act Metaphysics: Integrated
               Registration, INSIGHTS, May 1995, at 18.


==========================================START OF PAGE 11======

          c.   Changes in the Markets and Offering Processes, and
               the Effect on Investor Protection

     While the public, private and offshore markets are still

treated as technically distinct and separate markets under the

Securities Act, the traditional boundaries between and among such

markets have increasingly become blurred and distorted by

technological advances and evolving trading practices.  The

Committee questions whether the regulatory distinctions drawn

between and among these markets should, or can, be maintained for

seasoned issuers.  Through the use of such strategies as hedging

techniques, equity forwards, and equity swaps, and so-called "A/B

exchange offers" and "PIPE" transactions-[10]- that the

Committee believes promote form over substance, the vital

investor protection concepts underpinning the Securities Act are

losing their effectiveness.  Simply put, through these

techniques, issuers in essence can engage in public offerings

without providing investors with the benefits and remedies of the

Securities Act at the time of the investment decision.

     The nature of our securities markets has changed

dramatically over the last sixty years.  The rate of change has

been even more striking in the last two decades.  In the

Committee's view, the statutory schemes first enacted in 1933 and



---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[10]-    For an explanation of these devices and additional
               information regarding the blurring of public,
               private, domestic and offshore markets and the
               consequent effects on investor protection, see
               Appendix A to the Report at p. 38-45.


==========================================START OF PAGE 12======

1934 were well adapted to the markets of the time.-[11]-

Sixty years ago, the secondary trading markets for equity were

far smaller and less active than they are today -- only a few

times the size of the primary markets, as opposed to 35 times

today -- and there were few mechanisms for the general public to

make investments other than through the direct purchase of

corporate shares in primary offerings.

     Since then, trends such as the growth in the secondary

trading markets for equity relative to the primary issuance

market, the general shift of retail investor participation from

the primary markets to the secondary markets, and the increasing

institutionalization of the markets for both debt and equity,

have called into question whether the current statutory

provisions of the Securities Act continue to protect investors as

efficiently and effectively as possible.  In addition,

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[11]-    For example, during the 1930s and 1940s, on
               average, the number of registration statements
               declared effective on a yearly basis was
               approximately 400 as compared to over 8,000 today
               (including all registration forms).  Annual Report
               of the Securities and Exchange Commission for the
               fiscal years 1935 through 1950; Division of
               Corporation Finance data.

     In the past, companies tapped the equity markets only when
     necessary because costs were extremely high.  Prospectuses,
     even for the most seasoned issuers, were fully stand-alone
     documents presenting an entire picture of a company, without
     incorporation by reference to other disclosure documents.
     Offerings frequently took months to complete, and the
     process for seasoned issuers was not very different from the
     process for an initial public offering.  Moreover, the SEC
     Commissioners themselves would actually meet to review the
     few registration statements that were submitted each week
     and provide written comments on the disclosure presented in
     the registration statement.


==========================================START OF PAGE 13======

evolutionary changes in the rules governing the offering process

made by the Commission over time to facilitate issuer access to

the markets, including the increased reliance on Exchange Act

reports to satisfy many core Securities Act disclosure

requirements, the adoption of shelf registration for primary

offerings and the timing of prospectus delivery, may be impairing

the ability of issuers' boards of directors, underwriters and

independent accounting firms to perform their traditional

Securities Act "due diligence."

     3.   Company Registration as the Logical Conclusion of
          Evolutionary Change in the Regulatory Process

     Past initiatives demonstrate that, while also enhancing

investor protection, cost savings can be anticipated from a

transition to a company registration system.  In this regard, the

Committee does not write on a blank slate.  Almost thirty years

ago, Milton Cohen described the need for a dramatic

transformation in focus and thinking regarding the regulatory

structure of the federal securities laws, when he wrote:

     [i]t is my thesis that the combined disclosure
     requirements of [the Securities Act and the Exchange
     Act] would have been quite different if the [Acts] had
     been enacted in opposite order, or had been enacted as
     a single, integrated statute -- that is, if the
     starting point had been a statutory scheme of
     continuous disclosures covering issuers of actively
     traded securities and the question of special
     disclosures in connection with public offerings had
     then been faced in this setting.  Accordingly, it is my
     plea that there now be created a new coordinated
     disclosure system having as its basis the continuous
     disclosure system of the [Exchange] Act and treating


==========================================START OF PAGE 14======

     "[Securities] Act" disclosure needs on this
     foundation.-[12]-

Further suggestions regarding the integration of the disclosure

and regulatory schemes of the Securities Act and Exchange Act --

actions moving towards a company registration model -- were

raised in the 1969 Wheat Report,-[13]- the 1977

recommendations of the SEC's Advisory Committee on Corporate

Disclosure,-[14]- and the ALI Code.-[15]-  As a

result, the integrated disclosure system and the shelf

registration process were implemented by the Commission in the

early 1980s, and have now firmly taken hold and demonstrated

their benefits.

     Moreover, with the adoption of Rule 144A in 1990, the

Commission began the development of a limited institutional

trading market in certain restricted securities, thereby

permitting greater liquidity and a lower illiquidity discount,

and consequently reducing the regulatory costs imposed by resale

restrictions on these securities.  Similar to public offerings,

Rule 144A placements generally are conducted with the assistance

of investment banking firms.  In addition, Rule 144A placements

often involve the use of detailed offering circulars making


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[12]-    Milton H. Cohen, "Truth in Securities" Revisited,
               79 Harv. L. Rev. 1340, 1341 - 1342 (1966).

     -[13]-    Wheat Report, supra n.5.

     -[14]-    1977 Advisory Committee Report, supra n.5.

     -[15]-    ALI Code, supra n.6.


==========================================START OF PAGE 15======

extensive disclosures regarding the offering as well as the

company and its financial condition.  This is the case even

though there are no explicit Commission-mandated disclosure

requirements applicable in a Rule 144A placement.-[16]-

     Due to the innovative ideas of integrated disclosure

(including incorporation by reference), short-form shelf

registration and Rule 144A, offerings today can be conducted on a

more cost-efficient basis than under the traditional model for

underwritten public offerings:

          Under the current selective review system, the majority
          of registration statements relating to public offerings
          by seasoned issuers are not reviewed by the
          Commission's staff prior to effectiveness.  Moreover,
          in the case of primary shelf offerings, the information
          contained in prospectus supplements is never required
          to be pre-reviewed by the staff prior to the takedown
          of securities from the shelf.

          A shelf registration statement need not describe in
          advance a specific contemplated offering.  Since 1992,
          issuers have been able to complete an offering under a
          universal shelf registration statement that
          simultaneously registers an unspecified amount of each
          enumerated type of security registered, subject only to
          the unallocated total dollar amount of securities being
          registered and a presumed two-year limit on the amount
          reasonably expected to be offered.

          The traditional methods of prospectus delivery are not
          necessary in connection with all public offerings.
          Today, in the case of offerings by seasoned issuers,
          much of the crucial company-related information is
          incorporated by reference from the company's filed
          reports, rather than physically delivered to investors
          as part of the prospectus.

          The success of the Rule 144A institutional market
          evidences that an active primary issuance market can

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[16]-    Of course, the general antifraud provisions of the
               federal securities laws still apply.


==========================================START OF PAGE 16======

          develop, with procedures and disclosure documents
          delivered to investors that better suit their needs, in
          the absence of a mandated Securities Act transactional
          registration process, and disclosure delivery
          requirements.

     That the Commission already has travelled so far from the

original transactional disclosure model does not imply, however,

that there is nothing more to be done to enhance investor

protection and facilitate capital formation.  It should be noted

that, at each phase in the development of the current system,

this country's securities markets were functioning well and were

the deepest, most liquid and largest of any in the world.  With

each transition to a new phase, the markets improved.  The

favorable experience with these reforms illustrates that issuers,

under the proper conditions, can be freed from many of the

constraints of the transactional registration process not only

without undermining the Securities Act's investor protection

goals but also, if appropriately and thoughtfully done, by better

satisfying them.  The overall success of the current integrated

disclosure and shelf offering systems, and the Rule 144A market,

provides the Commission with a solid foundation for making

additional improvements to facilitate issuer access to the U.S.

public markets consistent with these goals.

          4.   The Benefits of the Company Registration System as
               Compared to the Current Transactional Regulatory
               System

     The reforms that would be instituted under the proposed

company registration system are part of this ongoing evolutionary

process.  Transactions under company registration would not


==========================================START OF PAGE 17======

differ significantly from transactions under the current

universal shelf system, in the sense that the issuer in advance

of an offering need only describe its financing plans in general

terms, and would not be subject to a separate registration

process and staff review when it wishes to proceed to market.

There will, however, be significant advantages for the issuer and

its shareholders over the current shelf system because the

company registration system essentially will make the Form C-1

the equivalent of a shelf registration statement that is

applicable on a continuous basis for all future offerings.  The

various elements of company registration that will effect this

change include the pay-as-you-go fee system, the elimination of

the need to register a specified amount of securities in advance

(which should alleviate the concerns regarding equity market

overhang that persist notwithstanding the adoption of the

unallocated or "universal" shelf procedure), as well as the

extension of the streamlined offering process to most

acquisitions.  Smaller, more frequent, offerings likewise will be

facilitated by the simplicity and ease of the company

registration system.  In addition, elimination of current

restrictions on at-the-market equity offerings will eliminate the

lingering confusion surrounding this concept.

     Moreover, issuers should realize significant cost savings as

a result of the more flexible prospectus delivery requirements,

while maintaining, and even enhancing, the nature and amount of

disclosure on file with the Commission and hence disclosed to the


==========================================START OF PAGE 18======

markets at the time of sale.  Finally, the full company

registration system eliminates the unnecessary application of

resale restrictions on most directors and officers.

     Company registration also would offer issuers and investors

significant advantages over Rule 144A:

               all the speed and predictability of a Rule 144A
               offering;

               no illiquidity discount, which generally now
               attaches to restricted (unregistered) securities;

               offering not limited to a prescribed class of
               qualified institutional buyers;

               offered securities not limited by fungibility
               restrictions;

               satisfaction of investor demand for registered
               securities;

               investors afforded the Securities Act protections
               of a registered transaction; and

               avoidance of uncertainties arising from potential
               integration with non-144A offerings.

     Unlike the current shelf rule and even Rule 144A, full

implementation of a company registration model would simplify the

complex regulatory quilt of rules and doctrines that has been

patched together in an effort to preserve the transactional focus

of the existing regulatory scheme and its core registration

requirement.  Thus, the need to superimpose legal distinctions on

economically indistinct markets would be eliminated.

     At the same time, and as important, company registration

would provide an opportunity to buttress the fundamental investor

protections that have come under increasing stress as the markets

have experimented with more efficient offering methods, some of


==========================================START OF PAGE 19======

which are outside the scope of the Securities Act altogether.  As

efforts have been made to accommodate demands for more

flexibility under the current system, and as issuers and other

sellers of securities have found mechanisms to utilize exemptions

and jurisdictional limitations under the current system because

they find its requirements too burdensome, the core protections

of the current system have begun to erode.-[17]-  By

contrast, with a rationalized, streamlined and cost effective

regulatory process in place, the incentive for issuers to utilize

jurisdictional or other means to escape the Securities Act should

be substantially diminished.  Concomitantly, the opportunity is

presented to reinstate and provide for better investor

protections.  At base, by reducing unnecessary costs of complying

with the registration requirements of the Securities Act, the

Committee expects that more issuers will register more offerings,

thereby extending the benefits of the Securities Act to more

investors.

     Company registration also will further the longstanding

Commission goal of improving the quality and reliability of

information disseminated by public corporations on an ongoing

basis to a level comparable to that traditionally provided in

primary offerings.-[18]-  Disclosure will be required on an

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[17]-    See p. 36-54 of Appendix A to the Report for more
               detail.

     -[18]-    As Milton Cohen observed in 1985, "[d]isclosures
               for [Exchange] Act purposes still tend to be taken
               less seriously, and to be of lower quality, than
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 20======
Exchange Act Form 8-K of transactional information and material

developments at the time of virtually all equity offerings.  This

requirement also will ensure full availability to investors of

Securities Act (as well as Rule 10b-5) remedies for material

deficiencies in that information, facilitate the due diligence

efforts of underwriters and other participants in the offering,

and provide material information regarding the issuer and the

transaction to the markets earlier than under the current system.




     Reordering and rationalizing the various gatekeeping or

monitoring functions to provide greater oversight of the issuer's

disclosures on an ongoing basis will be accomplished through the

provision of more detailed and explicit guidance regarding the

due diligence and reasonable care defenses of certain gatekeepers

under Sections 11 and 12(a)(2) of the Securities Act.  Such

guidance should encourage companies to adopt interim reviews of

financial information by outside auditors, a disclosure committee

of the board to perform continuous oversight of the disclosure

process, and various other measures.

     In addition, the flexibility company registration provides

to issuers to tailor offering materials to the needs of

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[18]-(...continued)
               those historically provided, and still aspired to,
               under the [Securities] Act despite the advent in
               1982 of incorporation by reference of Exchange Act
               reports into Securities Act registration
               statements."  Milton H. Cohen, The Integrated
               Disclosure System -- Unfinished Business, 40 Bus.
               Law. 987, 992 (1985).


==========================================START OF PAGE 21======

investors, including putting them in plain English, will result

in those documents being more readable and more informative, just

as "profile prospectuses" in the mutual fund industry are more

readable.  Thus, company registration complements well, and

furthers, the potential application of the Commission's "plain

English" initiative.

     The Committee recognizes that there may be costs associated

with an issuer's opting into the pilot, particularly in

connection with the adoption of the recommended disclosure

enhancements discussed below.  In the Committee's view, however,

issuers should embrace both the mandatory and voluntary

disclosure enhancements because they reflect better practices,

should help reduce the potential for litigation based on material

misstatements or omissions, and will, in the long run, result in

lower costs to the issuer when it proceeds to market.  Because

participation in a company registration system would be voluntary

during the pilot, companies would be free to make their own

judgments whether the benefits of more efficient and less costly

access to capital pursuant to the company registration system

outweigh any attendant costs.

     B.   Key Elements of the Recommendations

     The following is a summary of the basic recommended features

of the company registration system and pilot, as well as the

Disclosure Committee proposal.  A full description of the

specific elements of the pilot is provided in Appendix B and in

the Term Sheet.


==========================================START OF PAGE 22======

     1.  The Offering Process.  The basic principle of a company

registration system is that the regulatory process is company-

based, rather than transaction-based.  Once meeting eligibility

standards, companies would register with the Commission.  To

become company-registered, an eligible company would file a Form

C-1 registration statement, much like the current process for

registering a class of securities under the Exchange Act, and

also disclose its plans to sell securities from time to time in

the indefinite future on a company-registered basis.  Much like

today, companies also would file Exchange Act reports, which

would automatically be incorporated into the Form C-1, and the

information in the company's public file would then form the

primary basis for decisions by the investing public with respect

to a registered company's securities.

     Only a nominal registration fee would be paid when the

company is first registered.  The issuer would pay a full

registration fee at the time of sale based on the amount of

securities to be sold.  In effect, this process would create a

"pay-as-you-go" system somewhat similar to that now available to

open-end investment companies registered under the Investment

Company Act of 1940.

     Under a full company registration system, once a company is

registered and filing periodic and current reports, most routine

sales and resales of the company's securities would be

consummated immediately without any additional Commission staff

review prior to the sale of the security, just as is the case


==========================================START OF PAGE 23======

today for takedowns from a shelf, and would be based primarily

upon the information contained in the company's updated Exchange

Act disclosure file.  All subsequent sales of covered securities

by registered companies and their affiliates (outside Rule 144)

would be deemed to be covered by the registration statement, and

thus would be registered for purposes of the Securities Act.  All

purchasers of securities from the issuer or its affiliates,

regardless of the nature of the transaction, thus would receive

freely tradeable securities, as well as the benefit of all

statutory remedies that now attach to information disseminated in

connection with a registered offering of securities.  Therefore,

investor protection would be enhanced and extended to a broader

class of transactions, while the need for concepts such as gun-

jumping and restricted securities would be eliminated.

     At the time of each offering, the issuer would file with the

Commission material information relating to both the specific

offering, as well any material updates to the filed company-

related information that has not already been disclosed in its

filings at the time of the transaction.  In the case of non-

convertible debt and de minimis equity offerings, that

information could be filed by the issuer with the Commission on a

Form 8-K or, a prospectus supplement, and the registration fee

for the specific offering would be paid.  In the case of an

equity offering over a de minimis threshold (e.g., more than

three percent of the public float of the security in any three

business day period), this information must be filed on a Form 8-


==========================================START OF PAGE 24======

K, rather than merely in a prospectus supplement, on a date no

later than the date of the first sale.  This Form 8-K

transactional filing, which is not required today for takedowns

from a shelf registration, will ensure that this important

information is incorporated into the registration statement and

thus within the coverage of Section 11 liability, and facilitate

the due diligence inquiries of underwriters and other

gatekeepers, thereby improving the quality of the disclosure made

to investors in both the primary and secondary trading markets.

The Committee also recommends that, during the pilot, this Form

8-K filing requirement be applied to all non-de minimis equity

offerings utilizing the current shelf registration process.

     In further distinction to the current system, where a Form

8-K is required to be filed or is voluntarily filed for the

purposes of the incorporation by reference method of prospectus

delivery (as discussed more fully below), any information that is

material company-related disclosure (including, where necessary,

an updated Management's Discussion and Analysis) that is not yet

in the public file would be required to be filed some period of

time before the sale (which could be, for example, the same day

as, or one to three business days before, the transaction,

depending on the issuer and the information) to provide an

adequate opportunity for the market to absorb the information.

(The transactional information, however, normally need not be

filed until the day of sale.)  The company registration system

thereby corrects a clear infirmity in the current system,


==========================================START OF PAGE 25======

especially where transactions with purchasers are priced on the

basis of the current market price of the issuer's securities.

     The filing requirements regarding an auditor's consent to

the use of its report in connection with the issuer's financial

statements would remain unchanged from those followed today with

respect to primary shelf offerings.-[19]-

     Thus, company registration would enhance the timeliness,

quality, and level of information about companies and their

offerings that currently is made available to investors and the

markets through Commission filings.  At the same time, as noted

below, company registration would afford companies offering their

securities to the public the flexibility to tailor the disclosure

documents actually delivered to investors to the nature of the

transaction and the demands of the offering participants.

     2.  Prospectus Delivery Requirement.  In routine offerings,

issuers would have greater flexibility with respect to the

delivery of both the company-related and transactional

information mandated in a public offering.  This flexibility

regarding the delivery of information to investors is in contrast

to the filing of disclosure documents with the Commission: those

filed documents will be subject to the same Securities Act

content requirements but, in many instances, will be filed on an

accelerated basis.  Rather than imposing formal, full-fledged

delivery requirements in connection with all issuances of


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[19]-    See p. 24-28 of Appendix B to the Report.


==========================================START OF PAGE 26======

securities to the public, the appropriate style and level of

company and transactional disclosure that physically would be

delivered to investors would be determined in most offerings by

considerations relating to informational demands of participants

in the particular offering, thereby facilitating more useful and

more readable ("plain English") disclosure.

     Specifically, in routine offerings under company

registration, where physical delivery of a traditional prospectus

would not be mandated because the requisite information has been

filed on a Form 8-K and may be incorporated by reference and

constructively delivered, issuers and underwriters would be free

to decide whether to use some form of a formal prospectus and

what information to disclose in that prospectus if

used.-[20]-  The Committee expects that the information

that actually is delivered to investors in the form of a term

sheet, selling materials or a more formal prospectus, would be

the information that the issuer deems most relevant and material

to the investment decision.  Because all mandated company and

transactional disclosure must be filed with the Commission and

made part of the registration statement, strict liability will

attach to this information.  To the extent an issuer elects to

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[20]-    Just as under the current system, to the extent
               that disclosure made in any delivered document
               might be rendered misleading by the omission of
               information contained only in documents filed with
               the Commission, such as the transactional Form 8-
               K, the delivered documents must include such
               information. See p. 17-18 to Appendix B of the
               Report.


==========================================START OF PAGE 27======

use selling material without delivering a statutory prospectus,

those materials that ordinarily would not be filed at all and

would have only Rule 10b-5 liability, will now be filed and have

Section 12(a)(2) liability.  As is the case with the takedown

prospectus supplement under today's shelf procedures, there would

be no prior Commission staff review of any disclosure document

prior to the sale of the securities (although the Commission

staff may choose to review such a document, as it might any

other, in conjunction with a review of the company's disclosure

file).-[21]-

     In those circumstances where the company registration system

would continue to mandate formal prospectus delivery, physical

delivery of the formal prospectus must be provided to non-

accredited investors in sufficient time to influence the

investment decision.-[22]-  This is in sharp contrast to

the current system, where, as noted above, the disclosure

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[21]-    Even in the absence of Commission staff review at
               the time of the offering, issuers and underwriters
               still must comply with all other applicable
               regulatory requirements, e.g., state Blue Sky
               requirements, exchange and Nasdaq listing
               requirements, and NASD review of underwriter
               compensation.

     -[22]-    In these non-routine equity transactions, the
               prospectus received by the non-accredited
               investors prior to the sale would be similar to
               the preliminary prospectus mandated in initial
               public offerings (cf. Rule 15c2-8 under the
               Exchange Act [17 CFR 240.15c2-8]) and also
               routinely disseminated in non-shelf repeat equity
               offerings where the price-related and other
               current information often would not be
               incorporated into the document prior to sale.


==========================================START OF PAGE 28======

document frequently is received by investors at the time of the

confirmation of sale -- often days after the investment decision

has been made.

     For purposes of the pilot, the different levels of

transactions requiring varying levels of prospectus delivery

essentially fall into three tiers.  The Commission may wish to

consider whether the second tier (Nonroutine Transactions) is

necessary and whether it is practicable to require delivery of

prospectus information prior to the sale, or whether the system

could be simplified by extending the procedure for Routine

Transactions to this second tier.

     o    Routine Transactions (e.g., all offerings of all
          covered securities, except offerings of voting equity
          amounting to 20% or more of the existing public float
          of the security;-[23]- similar limitations on
          "routine" issuances for other types of securities could
          possibly be adopted as well)(This category established
          for prospectus delivery purposes encompasses the de
          minimis equity and other types of offerings that are
          exempt from the mandatory Form 8-K filing requirement.)


               The issuer could continue to use traditional
               prospectus delivery.

               In the alternative, the issuer may incorporate by
               reference any publicly filed information into a
               document serving as the prospectus, such as the
               confirmation of sale or selling materials.
               Issuers would file transactional and updating
               disclosure with the Commission on a Form 8-K and
               incorporate this information as well as any other



---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[23]-    Based on data from 1992-1994, approximately 70% of
               all firm commitment common equity offerings would
               be deemed routine under this threshold. See Figure
               6 in the Addendum to Appendix A of the Report.


==========================================START OF PAGE 29======

               necessary information in other filed
               reports.-[24]-  Much like under shelf
               registration today, the disclosure incorporated by
               reference need not be repeated in the document
               serving as the prospectus.  All mandated
               disclosure, including transactional disclosure,
               may be incorporated by reference from Exchange Act
               reports, a more flexible standard than under the
               current shelf registration system where
               transactional disclosure may not be incorporated
               by reference and must actually be delivered
               (albeit frequently after the investment decision
               has already been made).

               If the issuer wishes to use selling materials
               without having delivered a formal prospectus, the
               issuer would simply incorporate by reference into
               those selling materials the transactional
               disclosure and any material company-related
               updating disclosure (i.e., the disclosure
               currently required under shelf registration to be
               delivered in a formal prospectus) as well as all
               of the Exchange Act reports on file.  The selling
               materials then would be treated as the statutory
               prospectus, including for liability purposes.
               This new flexibility to use abbreviated selling
               materials without incurring the obligation to
               deliver physically a full statutory prospectus
               will facilitate the development of summary
               prospectuses and plain-English disclosure
               documents.

     o    Non-routine Transactions (e.g., offerings of voting
          equity amounting to 20% or more of existing public
          float of the security)

               The current requirement under shelf registration
               that transactional information (and any material
               updating company disclosure not already on file
               with the Commission) actually be delivered to
               investors in a formal prospectus (as opposed to
               incorporated by reference from filed documents)
               would be retained.  Where this more traditional

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[24]-    With respect to the filing requirement, unless the
               transaction is de minimis, the Form 8-K would be
               required to be on file in any equity offering
               regardless of whether the information is
               incorporated into a document serving as a
               prospectus.


==========================================START OF PAGE 30======

               prospectus is mandated to be delivered to the
               investor, delivery should be required to be made
               to investors prior to sale.

               ø    Traditional prospectus delivery may be useful
                    in transactions that would alter
                    significantly the information previously
                    disseminated to the markets and that likely
                    would be accompanied by significant selling
                    efforts.

               Physical delivery of a prospectus would not be
               required for accredited investor purchasers.

     o    Extraordinary Transactions (securities transactions
          that fundamentally change the nature of the company
          (e.g., offerings of voting equity amounting to 40% or
          more of the existing public float of the security))

               Traditional prospectus delivery would be mandated
               as in non-routine transactions.

               The opportunity for Commission review of the
               prospectus prior to its use would be retained for
               this category of transactions.

               Physical delivery of a prospectus would not be
               required for accredited investor purchasers.



==========================================START OF PAGE 31======
                 COMPANY REGISTRATION PILOT
                              
                     SIZE/TYPE OFFERING
                              


----------------------------------------------Equity--------------------------------|  Non-convertible Debt

                 De Minimis        Routine          Non-routine       Extraordinary    
                                                                                      
                 <=3%              >3% <20%         >=20% <40%                         >=40%             
Transactional    Optional          Yes              Yes                                Optional
8-K -[1]-                                                             Yes              
Filing                                                                                 
required (at                                                                           
or prior to                                                                            
sale)                                                                                  
                 No (unless        No (unless       No (unless                         No (unless
Post-            fundamental       fundamental      fundamental       Yes              fundamental
effective        change to         change to        change to                          change to
Amendment -[2]-  R/S)              R/S)             R/S)                               R/S)
(must be                                                                               
declared                                                                               
effective by                                                                           
staff before     (1)               (1)              Traditional       Traditional      No (if
takedown)        Traditional       Traditional      prospectus        prospectus       choose to be
                 prospectus        prospectus       supp.             supp.            covered,
Prospectus       supp.             supp.            delivered to      delivered to     treat as
Delivery -[2]-   delivered at      delivered at     investor          investor         Routine
                 or prior to       or prior to      prior to          prior to         regardless
                 confirm; or       confirm; or      confirm and       confirm and      of face
                 (2)               (2)              at same time      at same time     amount of
                 Transactional     Transactional    filed with        filed with       offering)
                                                    SEC under         SEC under
                 information       information      cover of 8-K.     cover of 8-K.
                 filed on          filed on                                      
                 Form 8-K and      Form 8-K and     Incorporation     Incorporation
                 incorporated      incorporated       by                by
                 by reference      by reference     reference         reference
                 3 into            3 into           option            option
                 confirm or        confirm or       available         available
                 sales             sales            only with         only with
                 literature,       literature,      respect to        respect to
                 which is          which is         accredited        accredited
                 then              then             investors         investors
                 delivered as      delivered as
                 statutory         statutory
                 prospectus        prospectus
                 at or prior       at or prior
                 to confirm        to confirm

 -[1]-   All equity and equity equivalents.

 -[2]-   Voting equity or equivalents only.

 -[3]-   Where disclosable (e.g., per 10b-5 (Basic) and/or 8-K
     line item) material change regarding company has
     occurred since last 10-K, 10-Q or 8-K and using
     incorporation by reference method of prospectus
     delivery, must file 8-K reporting change in sufficient
     time before takedown to permit market assimilation
     (e.g., 1 to 3 days).
==========================================START OF PAGE 32======

     3.  Scope.  Participation in the company registration pilot

would be voluntary and would be limited to a senior class of

seasoned issuers, i.e., issuers with a $75 million public float,

two years of reporting history, and a class of securities listed

on a national securities exchange or traded on the National

Market System of the Nasdaq Stock Market.  Thus, the current

Securities Act transactional system, including specifically,

where applicable, Commission staff review of transactional

documents prior to the offering, would be retained for all other

issuers including for those engaging in initial public offerings.




     Foreign issuers could participate if they adopt the

reporting requirements applicable to domestic companies and

otherwise meet the eligibility criteria, including adopting the

disclosure enhancements described below.  The Committee

recommends, however, that the Commission consider whether

accommodations should be made for foreign issuers similar to

those that permit such issuers to use the shelf today.

     The extent to which smaller, less seasoned companies could

benefit from the system will depend on experience with the pilot

and, if otherwise deemed appropriate based on such experience,

may require mandating such additional protections as traditional

prospectus delivery, greater advance notice for prospective

investors of company and transaction information before any

offering, or the retention of the potential for staff review of


==========================================START OF PAGE 33======

annual financial information before its use in connection with an

offering.

     A company may opt out of the pilot by withdrawing its Form

C-1, but would not be eligible to opt back into the company

registration system for a period of two years.  For purposes of

the pilot, noncompliance with the issuer eligibility conditions

or any of the mandatory disclosure enhancements in any material

respect would result in the loss of eligibility to make offerings

pursuant to the Form C-1 for a two-year period.  Moreover, an

issuer would have to be current in its reporting obligations at

the time of each offering.

     Under full company registration, all issuances of any

covered security by a registered company or its affiliates,

including those issuances made for acquisitions, would be

afforded the same legal status and carry the same protections as

securities registered under the Securities Act today.

Accordingly, all securities sold by a registered company would be

freely tradeable.  Thus, a principal benefit of the comprehensive

nature of company registration is that distinctions currently

existing between public and nonpublic offerings (with the

resultant formalities and restrictive concepts such as gun-

jumping and integration) would be eliminated.  For example,

securities sold overseas by a registered company would be deemed

registered to the extent of any flowback of those securities into

the United States, providing investors in the United States the


==========================================START OF PAGE 34======

same protections they would have had if the securities had been

sold initially in this country.

     In addition, by thus eliminating the risk of unregistered

distributions through the use of conduits, the system also

eliminates any need for restrictions on resales by affiliates and

statutory underwriters.  Consequently, only the Chief Executive

Officer and inside directors, as well as holders of 20% of the

voting power, or 10% of the voting power with at least one

director representative on the board, need be subject to

affiliate resale restrictions.  Similarly, the statutory

underwriter concept would apply only to persons engaged in the

business of a broker-dealer (whether or not so registered) who

participate in a distribution of securities by a registered

company or its affiliates under the Form C-1.

     At their option, under the pilot, participating companies

may elect to continue to conduct offerings not registered under

the Securities Act (such as private placements and other

transactional exemptions, and offshore offerings under Regulation

S) for all types of securities, i.e., "modified company

registration."  Although the Committee was aware that the

addition of a modified company registration option would add

complexity, the Committee was concerned that, at this initial

stage and until issuers become comfortable with the company

registration concept, the loss of the ability to conduct exempt

private placement and offshore offerings could be a deterrent to


==========================================START OF PAGE 35======

the voluntary use of the company registration system.-[25]-



     Therefore, to permit a meaningful test of the company

registration concepts during the pilot stage, the Committee

believes that issuers should be afforded the option of continuing

to conduct nonregistered offerings, while still availing

themselves of most of the benefits of the system.  Companies

could choose either to waive transactional exemptions, or

determine to preserve the option to exclude those transactions

from the company registration system by using the modified

version of this system.  Under either approach, however,

companies could choose to exclude straight debt securities.  If a

company chooses to conduct an exempt offering, the securities

issued outside the Form C-1 would remain subject to the current

concepts of restricted securities, and the resale restrictions

and registration requirements applicable to current affiliates

and statutory underwriters would remain.  Exempt offerings,

however, would not be subject to integration with offerings made

pursuant to the company registration statement.

     The benefits resulting from registration, including the

issuance of freely tradeable securities in what otherwise would

have been a private transaction resulting in restricted

securities, should outweigh any additional costs imposed by

registering the securities under the system.  Illiquidity

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[25]-    Transcript of May 8, 1995 Advisory Committee
               Meeting at 177 (statements of Professor Coffee).


==========================================START OF PAGE 36======

discounts typically imposed by the market on non-registered

securities should be eliminated for all securities issued under

the company registration system.  As noted, these discounts can

range up to 20 percent for equity, compared to 0 basis points

market discount for shelf registered equity offerings (5 percent

total underwriter spread and fees).-[26]-  Also, issuers

would ultimately benefit by the reduction or elimination of the

costs and uncertainties that today result from complex

interpretive concepts and the concomitant need to monitor

transactions in restricted securities.

     4.  Disclosure Enhancements.  In the Committee's view,

enhancing the quality and reliability of secondary market reports

is an integral part of an effective company registration system,

because these reports are the cornerstone of the offering

disclosures by company-registered issuers.  While the Committee

does not consider the quality and reliability of the current

secondary market disclosure system to be so deficient as to

compromise investor protection, the Committee does find that

there is room for improvement.-[27]-  With registered

companies having almost immediate access to the capital markets,

new measures are necessary and appropriate to provide assurance

regarding the integrity of the disclosure disseminated by those

companies on an ongoing basis.  For these reasons, the Committee


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[26]-    See p. 37 and Table 1 of Appendix A to the Report.

     -[27]-    See p. 45-49 of Appendix A to the Report.


==========================================START OF PAGE 37======

believes that secondary market disclosures must be improved and

enhanced.

     The Committee recommends that any company registration

system adopted by the Commission include a series of procedural

disclosure enhancements as part of opting into company

registration and remaining in the system.  The purpose of these

disclosure enhancements is to ensure that those individuals and

entities best equipped to guard the integrity of the disclosure

provided in the company's filed reports focus increased attention

on these disclosures:

          Top Management Certifications   Certification to the
          Commission (not a filed document) would be required of
          two of any of the following four officers, attesting
          that they have reviewed the Form 10-K, the Form 10-Qs
          and any Form 8-Ks reporting mandated events, but not
          for voluntarily filed Form 8-Ks, and that they are not
          aware of any misleading disclosures or omissions: the
          chief executive officer, chief operating officer, chief
          financial officer, or chief accounting officer.  The
          attestation would be required upon the filing of each
          such document with the Commission.

          Management Report to Audit Committee   A report
          prepared by management and addressed and submitted to
          the board of directors' audit committee (or its
          equivalent or the disclosure committee, if adopted and
          different from the audit committee) describing
          procedures followed to ensure the integrity of periodic
          and current reports and procedures instituted to avoid
          potential insider trading abuses (e.g., any requirement
          that company insiders clear trades with the issuer's
          general counsel).-[28]-  This report would be

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[28]-    The recommendation that the Report cover
               procedures to prevent insider trading was
               suggested to complement the elimination of Form
               144 filings by those affiliates (officers and
               directors) who no longer would be subject to
               resale restrictions.  Those filings were believed
               to serve as a mechanism to help police improper
               insider trading.


==========================================START OF PAGE 38======

          made public as an exhibit to the Form 10-K; the report
          need not be resubmitted on a yearly basis if the
          described procedures are unchanged.

          Form 8-K Enhancements   Expansion of current reporting
          obligations on Form 8-K under the Exchange Act to
          mandate disclosure of additional material developments:


               ø    Material modifications to the rights of
                    security holders (current Item 2 of Form 10-
                    Q);

               ø    Resignation or removal of any of the top five
                    executive officers;

               ø    Defaults of senior securities (current Item 3
                    of Form 10-Q);

               ø    Sales of a significant percentage of the
                    company's outstanding stock (whether in the
                    form of common shares or convertible
                    securities or equity equivalents);

               ø    Issuer advised by independent auditor that
                    reliance on audit report included in previous
                    filings is no longer permissible because of
                    auditor concerns over its report, or issuer
                    seeks to have a different auditor reaudit a
                    period covered by a filed audit report.

          For the above items that are required now to be filed
          on a Form 10-Q, the information therefore would be
          provided on a current, rather than a quarterly, basis.
          Moreover, the period within which a Form 8-K must be
          filed following any mandatory event specified in that
          form would be accelerated from 15 calendar days to 5
          business days.

          Risk Factors   Risk factor analysis disclosure
          requirements to the extent currently required in an
          issuer's Securities Act filings would be added to the
          Form 10-K.

          Voluntary Measures   Voluntary measures would be
          encouraged by the opportunity for various gatekeepers
          to make the due diligence process more efficient, and
          would consist of: auditor review of interim financial
          information either consistent with SAS No. 71 or a more
          detailed interim audit procedure; auditor review of
          events subsequent to the date of the audited financial
          statements that may bear materially on those statements


==========================================START OF PAGE 39======

          pursuant to SAS No. 37; opinion letters by auditors
          pursuant to SAS No. 72 and by issuer's counsel that are
          provided to underwriters and outside directors in
          connection with offerings; and the establishment of a
          "disclosure committee" of outside directors (which
          could be the existing audit committee).

     5.  Liability  While the Committee evaluated alternative

liability schemes in its consideration of the company

registration system, the Committee has determined that the

company registration model should maintain the current Securities

Act liability scheme at least during the pilot stage.  The

Committee believes that the continued application of the current

liability scheme will ensure the maintenance of familiar investor

protection concepts during the transition from a transactional-

based system to a company-based system.

     In fact, investor protection would be enhanced under the

pilot program.  Notably, under the current shelf system,

companies deliver transactional information in a traditional

prospectus supplement that, although filed with the Commission,

is not deemed filed as part of the registration statement.  As a

consequence, investors are denied the core protections of Section

11 of the Securities Act with respect to this

information.-[29]-  By contrast, the pilot would expand the

scope of the Section 11 protections to these disclosures through

its requirement of a Form 8-K filing for non-de minimis equity


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[29]-    See Elimination of Pricing Amendments and Revision
               of Prospectus Filing Procedures, Securities Act
               Rel. 6672 ( Oct. 27, 1986)[51 FR 39868 (November
               3, 1986)].


==========================================START OF PAGE 40======

offerings.  For companies that fully opt into the system,

liability also would be expanded to cover transactions that are

not now subject to Section 11 liability, such as the flowback of

overseas offerings, private placements and other transactions

currently deemed "exempt" offerings.  In addition, sales

literature that today only receives the protection of Rule 10b-5

would, under many circumstances, receive the enhanced protection

of Section 12(a)(2) of the Securities Act.

     6.   Due Diligence   In reaching its conclusion to retain

the current Securities Act liability structure, the Committee

weighed concerns regarding the due diligence responsibilities of

various gatekeepers stemming from the expedited nature of the

current shelf registration process, and recognized that company

registration could further expedite the offering process.

Although the current system expects outside parties to act as

gatekeepers in the offering process, in practice and for a

variety of reasons, such roles are not necessarily being

fulfilled in the manner anticipated when the Securities Act was

adopted.-[30]-  From the outset, the Committee sought to

buttress and strengthen the gatekeepers' roles in protecting

investors not only in the context of episodic, transaction-

specific oversight, but also, and with increased emphasis, in the

context of ongoing oversight by those persons in the best

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[30]-    See ABA Committee on Federal Regulation of
               Securities, Report of Task Force on Sellers' Due
               Diligence and Similar Defenses Under the Federal
               Securities Laws, 48 Bus. Law. 1185 (May 1993).


==========================================START OF PAGE 41======

position to monitor the integrity and accuracy of company

disclosures.  Separately, proponents of the proposed Form 8-K

filing requirement at the time of the transaction asserted that

such a filing would help serve to focus and facilitate the due

diligence inquiries of underwriters.

     As part of the adoption of company registration, the

Committee recommends that the Commission provide interpretive

guidance to gatekeepers as to more effective methods of

satisfying the "reasonable investigation" and "reasonable care"

standards, respectively, of Sections 11 and 12(a)(2) of the

Securities Act.  In this regard, the Committee recommends

expanding the factors (currently enumerated in Securities Act

Rule 176) that may be taken into account by gatekeepers or

monitors in determining their appropriate due diligence

investigation, to refer specifically to compliance with the

mandatory and voluntary procedures outlined in the disclosure

enhancements.  To the extent that the addition of disclosure

enhancements, including voluntary enhancements such as SAS No. 71

reviews by independent auditors, increases the attention paid to

the disclosure by those having the best opportunity to monitor

the issuer on an ongoing basis, other participants in the

gatekeeping process could take such efforts into account when

deciding the appropriate level of due diligence needed to be

performed in order to satisfy their own statutory duties, and in

determining how best to satisfy those duties.


==========================================START OF PAGE 42======

     The underwriter thus would continue its pivotal role in

ensuring the adequacy of disclosure at the time of the offering

by drawing upon all available sources of information concerning

the company and assessing the scope of the ongoing reviews

conducted by the other gatekeepers in evaluating the appropriate

due diligence the underwriters should perform.  In this fashion,

the Committee has recognized both the practical demands of market

participants and the need to maintain the integrity of the

disclosure system.  If the proposals to enhance and rationalize

the due diligence process on an ongoing basis are implemented,

the gatekeeping function ultimately should be more effective in

protecting investors and in ensuring the integrity of corporate

disclosure disseminated to the markets, not only in the context

of episodic public offerings, but with respect to continuous

secondary market trading as well.  This principle is consistent

with one of the primary motivating factors underlying a shift

towards a company registration model: namely, the tremendous

movement during the last few decades in investor transactions

from the primary issuance markets to the secondary trading

markets.  Since only four to six percent of exchange and Nasdaq

traded issuers make public offerings of equity in a given

year,-[31]- strengthening the gatekeeping function

available on a continuous basis provides greatly enhanced

protection to investors overall.

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[31]-    See Figure 4 in the Addendum to Appendix A of the
               Report.


==========================================START OF PAGE 43======

     The Committee also urges the Commission to continue

exploring means to make the current liability structure more

effective and more fair for gatekeepers in light of modern

offering practices and techniques.  After the Commission gains

experience with the company registration offering process under

the pilot, the Committee recommends that the Commission revisit

the possibility (and the advisability) of providing more concrete

guidance to various gatekeepers as to when they may be deemed to

have satisfied their respective due diligence obligations.

     7.   Disclosure Committee

     In the course of its deliberations on the company

registration model, the Committee considered a separate proposal

to expand the role of the outside directors in ensuring the

integrity of corporate disclosures.-[32]-  Although not a

necessary part of the company registration model developed by the

Committee, the Committee strongly recommends that the Commission

endorse (but not require) a new procedure whereby outside

directors use the issuer's audit committee (or a separate


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[32]-    According to Professor Coffee, this concept would
               incorporate "the traditional reliance defense
               under state corporation law.  Under such a rule,
               other outside directors could rely on a committee
               of directors --- tentatively called the
               'disclosure committee' -- which would review the
               company's interim [Exchange] Act filings, such as
               its Form 10-K and Form 10-Q's, and consider the
               need for additional disclosures to cover material
               developments."  John C. Coffee, Jr., An
               'Evergreen' Company Registration Approach Would
               Modernize the 1933 Act, Nat'l L. J., Sept. 11,
               1995, at B4.


==========================================START OF PAGE 44======

committee of one or more outside directors to be known as a

"disclosure committee") to conduct an investigation of the

issuer's disclosures.  The Committee believes that this proposal

has merit whether or not company registration is pursued by the

Commission.

      The disclosure committee could conduct this investigation,

just as a board of directors may appoint a committee to engage in

other types of specialized inquiries, so long as (a) the

delegating directors reasonably believe that the member(s) of the

disclosure committee are sufficiently knowledgeable and capable

of discharging due diligence obligations on behalf of the outside

directors (if necessary, with the assistance of their

professional advisers) and are provided with adequate resources

to conduct the requisite investigation -- that is, the delegation

must be reasonable; (b) the delegating directors maintain

appropriate oversight of the disclosure committee (which would

entail requiring the disclosure committee to report periodically

to the Board on the procedures followed to ensure the integrity

of the disclosure) and reasonably believe that the disclosure

committee's procedures are adequate and were being performed; and

(c) the delegating directors reasonably believe that the

disclosure is not materially false or misleading.

     Although the reasonableness of a delegating director's

reliance on the disclosure committee, as well as the director's

belief in the accuracy of the disclosure based solely upon the

establishment of and procedures for investigation by the


==========================================START OF PAGE 45======

disclosure committee, will depend on the facts and circumstances

of each offering, the Committee believes that this practice

generally will permit a delegating director to satisfy its

obligations under both federal and state law.-[33]-  In

addressing the liability of outside directors under Section 11,

the legislative history to the Securities Act states that

"reliance by the fiduciary, if his reliance is reasonable in the

light of all the circumstances, is a full discharge of his

responsibilities."-[34]-  The requirements that the

delegation be reasonable and that the committee members

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[33]-    Under state law, where each director has a
               fiduciary duty with respect to the corporation,
               directors may create committees to ensure the
               proper functioning and discharge of their
               fiduciary obligations.  See, e.g., 8 Del. C. 
               141(e) (Del. 1994); 15 Pa.C.S.A. 1712(a)(3)
               (Penn. 1995); American Law Institute, Principles
               of Corporate Governance 4.03 (1994).  The
               legislative history of Section 11 of the
               Securities Act, including the 1934 amendment to
               the Act which deleted the original fiduciary
               standard and substituted a "prudent man" standard,
               does not suggest that Congress intended a more
               strict standard to apply under federal law. H.R.
               Rep. No. 1838, 73d Cong., 2nd Sess. 41 (1934). See
               James M. Landis, The Legislative History of the
               Securities Act of 1933, 28 Geo. Wash. L. Rev. 29,
               47-48 (1959) (stating the drafter's belief that "a
               goodly measure of delegation was justifiable,
               particularly insofar as corporate directors are
               concerned").

     -[34]-    H.R. No. 152, 73d Cong., 1st Sess. at 26 (1933).
               See also Circumstances Affecting the Determination
               of What Constitutes Reasonable Investigation and
               Reasonable Grounds for Belief Under Section 11 of
               the Securities Act; Treatment of Information
               Incorporated by Reference Into Registration
               Statements, Securities Act Rel. 6335 (August 6,
               1981) n. 106 [46 FR at 42022 (August 18, 1981)].


==========================================START OF PAGE 46======

periodically report on the procedures followed in conducting the

investigation,-[35]- should result in more meaningful

oversight of the issuer's disclosures by its outside directors.

The creation of such a voluntary committee would be consistent

with current corporate governance trends emphasizing the need for

outside directors to exercise continual diligence in monitoring

the performance of management and ensuring the candor and

completeness of company disclosures to the

marketplace.-[36]-   Moreover, the Commission recently

underscored the critical role of corporate directors in







---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[35]-    Cf. The Obligations of Underwriters, Brokers and
               Dealers in Distributing and Trading Securities
               Particularly of New High Risk Ventures, Securities
               Act Rel. No. 5275 (July 26, 1972) [37 FR 16011
               (Aug. 19, 1972)] at text accompanying n. 29
               (discussing relative responsibilities of the
               managing versus participating underwriters: "Thus,
               although the participant may delegate the
               performance of the investigation, he must take
               some steps to assure the accuracy of the
               statements in the registration statement.  To do
               this, he at least should assure himself that the
               manager made a reasonable investigation").

     -[36]-    See, e.g., J. Lorsch, Empowering the Board, Harv.
               Bus. Rev., Jan.-Feb. 1995, at 107, 113 ("[a]udit
               committees made up of outside directors in all
               public companies ensure that financial reports are
               accurate, that accounting rules are followed, and
               that assets are not misappropriated"); F. Lippman,
               What Should the Audit Committee Do? 3 Corp. Gov.
               Adv. 22 (March/April 1995); I. Millstein, The
               Evolution of the Certifying Board, 48 Bus. Law.
               1485 (1993).


==========================================START OF PAGE 47======

safeguarding the accuracy and integrity of a registrant's

periodic reports and other public statements.-[37]-

     This governance mechanism would benefit investors in a

variety of ways.  First, it would ensure more continuous

oversight of the disclosure preparation process and, over time,

improve the quality and integrity of periodic and secondary

market reporting and disclosure generally.  Second, it will

provide a focus at the board level for due diligence in the

context of primary offerings by issuers, thereby ensuring greater

involvement by outside directors as one set of monitors.  Third,

it will provide a practical means for greater outside director

involvement with the due diligence activities of other

gatekeepers, such as underwriters.

     Thus, the Committee hopes that many registered companies --

regardless of whether they are permitted to or elect to

participate in the company registration system -- would choose to

implement this measure as a natural extension of present "best

practices" that promote investor confidence in the adequacy of

corporate disclosures.  The result would be an increased focus by

the board on its existing statutory obligations, and additional



---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[37]-    See Report of Investigation in the Matter of the
               Cooper Companies, Inc. as it Relates to the
               Conduct of Cooper's Board of Directors, Exchange
               Act Rel. 35082 (December 12, 1994).  See also
               Report of Investigation in the Matter of National
               Telephone Co., Inc. Relating to Activities of the
               Outside Directors, Exchange Act Rel. 14380
               (January 16, 1978).


==========================================START OF PAGE 48======

review by a qualified committee-[38]- of outside directors,

while allowing the outside directors an appropriate mechanism to

fulfill their Securities Act responsibilities.

                         III.  CONCLUSION

     The Committee believes that company registration is superior

to incremental liberalization of the current offering process.

Short of implementing company registration, the Commission could

continue its approach of implementing incremental changes to

improve seasoned issuer access to the markets, particularly

through further liberalization of the shelf procedure.  As noted

in the description of the offering process under the company

registration model, much of the suggested company registration

pilot can be implemented primarily by modifying and liberalizing

the shelf concept.  Similarly, the Commission could take discrete

steps to allow issuers to meet market demands within the

framework of the current registration scheme, such as the

elimination of the nonfungibility requirement of Rule 144A, the

broadening of the eligibility requirements for purchasers in the

Rule 144A market, the minimization of the resale limitations on

restricted securities, the allowance of greater flexibility under

the gun-jumping doctrine to permit "testing of the waters," and


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[38]-    Establishment of disclosure committees might also
               lead to the appointment of disclosure specialists
               (such as lawyers, accountants or bankers) to the
               board so that they may serve as members of the
               disclosure committee, just as directors are often
               selected based upon their qualifications to serve
               on audit committees.


==========================================START OF PAGE 49======

the implementation of more flexible regulatory interpretations

such as those permitting A/B exchange offers.

     Indeed, the Committee is pleased that, since the time the

Committee began its deliberations and commenced its observations

on the shortcomings of the current system,  the Commission has

made significant proposals, and the staff has rendered

interpretations, to begin to take some of these steps.  The

Commission's Task Force on Disclosure Simplification followed the

work of the Committee and has recommended the measures crafted by

the Committee to streamline further the shelf offering

process.-[39]-  The Task Force, however, did not make any

specific recommendations for Securities Act disclosure

enhancements or other measures to ensure adequate investor

protections in the context of a streamlined offering process;

instead it urges the Commission in implementing the streamlining

recommendations to take the steps necessary to ensure quality

disclosure and investor protection and points to the Committee's

efforts in that regard.-[40]-

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[39]-    Report of the Task Force on Disclosure
               Simplification to the Securities and Exchange
               Commission (March 5, 1996), at 34, 38-40 (the
               "Task Force Report").

     -[40]-    As noted in the Task Force Report:

          The recommendations for seasoned issuers set forth
          under the [Task Force Report's] "Shelf Offerings"
          caption, as well as certain other items in this Report,
          are substantially identical to the streamlining
          concepts of the "company registration" framework
          developed by the Advisory Committee.  Although the Task
          Force was not designed to overlap with the work of the
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 50======

     Nevertheless, continued incremental liberalization of the

offering process alone would not achieve all of the benefits

sought by the Committee.  While such steps would benefit issuers

(including those who by choice or by reason of ineligibility

remain outside the company registration system), such steps


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[40]-(...continued)
          Advisory Committee, the Task Force members have
          followed the work of the . . . Committee.  The Task
          Force recommends almost all of the streamlining
          elements of company registration [e.g., eliminate
          restrictions on at-the-market offerings, permit an
          issuer to add additional securities without having to
          file a new registration statement, narrow the
          definition of affiliate, allow prospectus delivery by
          means of full incorporation by reference into a
          confirmation, and establish a pay-as-you-go fee
          system].  Given its original purpose, the Task Force
          only has sought to identify and recommend ways to
          streamline the regulatory process and thus only has
          looked at the suggestions individually.  Were the
          Commission to reach the next step of putting the pieces
          together into a comprehensive package, the Task Force
          recommends that the Commission consider reasonably
          expected investor protections consequences of any
          particular package.  The Task Force notes that the
          Advisory Committee has devoted significant time to
          deliberations on these issues as it assembled its
          complete [company registration] model and has added,
          what the Advisory Committee intends to be, significant
          investor protections.

                         *  *  *  *  *

          The Task Force believes that the Commission, in its
          consideration of these recommendations [to streamline
          the existing shelf offering process] and any
          alternatives that may be suggested, should take steps
          to ensure that the quality of disclosure provided to
          investors be at least of the same quality as that
          provided to investors today.  The Task Force notes that
          improving the quality of disclosures in periodic
          reports is an area being considered by the Advisory
          Committee.

     Id. at 34.


==========================================START OF PAGE 51======

should be balanced with increased protections for investors.

Moreover, as noted in this Report, there are investor protection

concerns in the current system that should be addressed before

further streamlining proceeds.  In addition, without a shift in

the underlying regulatory philosophy, new "metaphysics" would

continually be constructed to preserve the Securities Act's

current transactional registration requirement.  In the

Committee's view, these concepts and requirements will continue

to cause confusion, add substantial costs to the capital

formation process, and drive issuers to alternative markets where

investors will not be able to avail themselves of the protections

of the Securities Act.

     The Committee believes that the cumulative effect of the

evolutionary changes in the markets since the 1930s now requires

a reassessment of the conceptual underpinnings of the regulatory

process, as opposed to continued incremental changes.  Company

registration is consistent with the evolutionary approach of

incremental liberalization, but it is also, unmistakably, a new

departure.  Unlike incrementalism, it says with finality that

registration should not take precedence over periodic disclosure

for companies that are already traded.  It recognizes and

addresses what was not yet apparent in the early 1930s:  the

economic importance of traded companies raising additional

capital by issuing securities.  Thus company registration is far

more than a cost-reduction and efficiency reform.  It is a new

beginning for the registration process, and it is overdue.  The


==========================================START OF PAGE 52======

shift to a company registration system thus would change the way

we think about the regulation of the capital formation process

and foster a fresh approach to addressing the various problems.

This more comprehensive conceptual approach would address both

the interests of seasoned issuers in today's fast-moving markets,

and the implications of those changes in the markets and offering

processes for investors, underwriters, and other participants.

     The company registration pilot described in this Report

continues the process of using the Commission's existing

rulemaking authority to effect appropriate reforms, rather than

recommending major legislative changes.  The Committee decided at

the outset, at the urging of Chairman Levitt and Commissioner

Wallman, to promote primarily those modifications that could be

accomplished, at least initially, through rulemaking as opposed

to legislation.  The benefit of this approach is that it provides

greater flexibility for Commission experimentation and timely

regulatory adjustments as dictated by experience with the pilot.

While some of the complexity and various aspects of the pilot are

necessary in order to fit within the current regulatory scheme

and would be unnecessary under a legislatively implemented

system, experience gained under the pilot will provide a firm

foundation for determining what legislative changes and/or

rulemaking changes, if any, would be appropriate to simplify

further the regulatory process and complete the long-awaited

transition to a company registration system.


==========================================START OF PAGE 53======



         IV.  SEPARATE STATEMENT OF JOHN C. COFFEE, JR.,
            EDWARD F. GREENE, AND LAWRENCE W. SONSINI

     We write separately, not to criticize the Advisory

Committee's Report (with which we fully concur), but to voice our

concerns that additional steps must be taken by the SEC to fully

realize the Report's goals and to stress the need for any

specific reforms adopted based on this Report to be consistent

with the integrated approach taken by this Report, which seeks to

pursue both deregulation and qualitative improvement in our

disclosure system.  Achieving one without the other will not be

an advance.  Essentially, we advance two basic contentions:

     (1)  The transition from the transaction-oriented disclosure

     system of the past to the company registration system

     envisioned herein must be accompanied by a corresponding

     transition in liability rules.  Otherwise, there is a

     fundamental incongruence between what can realistically be

     expected of the independent "gatekeepers" (outside

     directors, accountants, underwriters and others) who monitor

     the corporation's disclosures and their statutory

     responsibilities under the Securities Act of 1933.  In

     particular, we are skeptical that practitioners will

     recommend, or that corporations will adopt, some of the

     reforms that this Report proposes (such as, in particular,

     the disclosure committee) without further guidance from the

     Commission.  In particular, some form of safe harbor must be

     developed that protects disinterested persons who undertake


==========================================START OF PAGE 54======

     due diligence efforts under company registration from

     thereby effectively incurring insurer-like liability for the

     accuracy of all factual information incorporated into the

     registration statement.

     (2)  The incentives to opt into a company registration

     system are uncertain and limited.  Some companies may prefer

     to rely on the existing shelf registration system.  In our

     judgment, it is unwise to have two parallel systems, one

     carrying the obligation to file a mandatory Form 8-K at the

     time of a substantial equity issuance plus requirements for

     certification by top management and the preparation of a

     senior management report; and the other, not.  Any disparity

     between company registration and shelf registration that

     requires mandatory filings, certifications, and reports

     under the former (but not the latter) will create an

     unfortunate and powerful incentive for issuers to opt to

     remain within the existing shelf registration system.  Thus,

     we would urge the Commission to adopt similar requirements

     with respect to the existing shelf registration system.

     More generally, our concern is that pressures may develop

     for the Commission to adopt selectively the deregulatory

     proposals from this Report while quietly ignoring the

     disclosure enhancements and supplemental filing obligations

     that this Report also envisions.  The proposals in this

     Report are part of a balanced and integrated package, which

     should not be implemented on a piecemeal basis.


==========================================START OF PAGE 55======

     1.  Due Diligence Under Company Registration Model and the

Problem of Liability.  We share the view clearly stated in this

Report that company registration has not made, and should not

make, obsolete the efforts of the corporation's independent

"gatekeepers" (i.e., its outside directors, accountants, and

underwriters) to verify and monitor the accuracy of the

corporation's disclosures.  No less than our colleagues on the

committee, we believe such due diligence efforts play a critical

role in assuring the integrity of our disclosure system.  But the

advent of company registration (as the culmination of a shelf

registration system that has efficiently evolved over time so as

to assure issuers increasingly rapid market access) does require

that we rethink how due diligence is undertaken and the level of

liability that can be fairly attached to it.

     In the past, concern has been expressed that the rapid pace

and time constraints associated with shelf registration makes due

diligence infeasible.-[1]-  Although the available evidence

remains largely anecdotal, we recognize that such a tendency may

exist and could accelerate under a company registration system.

     The Report directly addresses this problem by recommending a

mandatory Form 8-K filing at the time of any substantial equity

issuance (i.e., greater than 3% of outstanding shares).  As

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[1]-     Compare Merritt Fox, Shelf Registration,
               Integrated Disclosure, and Underwriter Due
               Diligence:  An Economic Analysis, 70 Va. L. Rev.
               1005 (1984) and David Green, Due Diligence Under
               Rule 415 Is the Insurance Worth the Premium?, 38
               Emory L.J. 793 (1989).


==========================================START OF PAGE 56======

strong proponents of such a requirement, we believe that one of

its most important virtues is that it may provide a focal point

for due diligence.-[2]-  Because a Form 8-K carries Section

11 liability (unlike a prospectus supplement), we expect that

participating underwriters, the company's senior management, and

its accountants would meet to discuss and review the contents of

the proposed Form 8-K and recent developments during the current

quarter.-[3]-  The existence of a mandatory filing

requirement may strengthen (perhaps only marginally) the position

of the underwriters in their negotiations with management over

the conduct of due diligence.-[4]-  On balance, we believe

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[2]-     Such due diligence would chiefly focus on whether
               material developments had occurred since the date
               of the corporation's last filing under the 1934
               Act's continuous disclosure system.  We do not
               mean to imply that verification of prior filings
               would necessarily be undertaken at such issuance.

     -[3]-     Indeed, some recent decisions suggest that the
               failure to implement such a review for late-
               breaking developments may subject the corporation
               and its directors to liability under 11 because
               the registration statement and prospectus may as a
               result contain material omissions.  See Shaw v.
               Digital Equipment Corp., 83 F.3d 1194 (1st Cir.
               1996) (where offering under a shelf registration
               statement occurred near end of quarter, the
               failure to disclose downturn during current
               quarter that was below analyst forecasts could
               constitute a material omission for purposes of 11
               of the Securities Act of 1933).

     -[4]-     In discussions we have had both within the
               Advisory Committee and with underwriters and
               others, this proposal has been described as the
               "Form 8-K speed bump."  This may mischaracterize
               it.  Like a speed bump, it does require the issuer
               to focus and pay attention to this filing
               obligation, but it does not require any necessary
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 57======

that such a requirement will better protect the interests of

investors at relatively low cost to issuers.

     But here difficulties surface that motivate us to write

separately.  To the extent that company registration is adopted

(or that any significant step is taken toward simplifying the

existing system of shelf registration), corporate issuers may

come to make more frequent use of the debt and equity

markets.-[5]-  Issuers seeking to make frequent use of

company registration (or the existing shelf registration system)

face a problem, because repetitive debt or equity offerings co-

exist uneasily at best with the statutory structure of the

Securities Act of 1933.  By regularly tapping the capital markets

through repetitive offerings, the corporation exposes its

directors to an increased risk of 11 liability under

circumstances that make effective compliance with their statutory

"due diligence" defenses infeasible.  Although we have no doubt

that the board should familiarize itself with the contents of the

registration statement in the context of a major public offering,

there is not the same opportunity for factual verification and

searching questioning in the context of smaller, repetitive


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[4]-(...continued)
               braking in the issuance process.

     -[5]-     If it occurs, such an evolution toward smaller,
               more frequent offerings could efficiently reduce
               the cost of capital to corporate issuers and might
               even parallel the "just-in-time" supply systems
               that American issuers have begun to copy from
               their Japanese originators.


==========================================START OF PAGE 58======

offerings.  Nor is it necessarily efficient to consume the

board's limited time in this fashion.  The dilemma then is that

either (1) board members are over-exposed to liability because

they cannot establish their due diligence defenses within these

compressed time frames, or (2) the corporation must forgo

repetitive offerings because of the legal risks to its directors.


Neither option is attractive; nor is this choice necessary.

     This example illustrates a more general point:  "company

registration" represents a movement away from a transaction-

oriented system of disclosure.  But the liability rules of the

Securities Act of 1933 remain transaction-oriented.  As a result,

a mismatch arises, which, we submit, requires that the liability

provisions of the federal securities laws also be re-assessed.

Of course, such an undertaking invites some controversy, but it

is today a feasible project now that the Private Securities

Litigation Reform Act of 1995 has given the Commission broad

exemptive authority under both the Securities Act of 1933 and the

Securities Exchange Act of 1934.-[6]-

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[6]-     See Section 27A(g) of the Securities Act of 1933,
               15 U.S.C. 77z-2(g), and Section 21E(g) of the
               Securities Exchange Act of 1934, 15 U.S.C. 78u-
               5(g).  We are, of course, aware that the
               Commission has not yet spoken to the scope of its
               exemptive authority under these sections.  We
               believe, however, that courts would defer to any
               "reasonable" construction of these provisions
               advanced by the Commission.  See Chevron U.S.A. v.
               Natural Resources Defense Council, Inc., 467 U.S.
               837 (1984).  The pending Securities Investment
               Promotion Act of 1996 would also greatly enhance
               the Commission's exemptive authority in even
               clearer statutory language.


==========================================START OF PAGE 59======

     How might the liability provisions of the Securities Act of

1933 be modified?  Less we be misunderstood, we stress at the

outset that we do not seek to abolish liability under 11 or 12.


Although there are multiple forces that drive our disclosure

system, the risk of liability is one of the most significant, and

it motivates independent gatekeepers to test and, if necessary,

challenge the issuer's proposed disclosure.  The proposed Form 8-

K requirement (which we support) at least technically increases

the risk of 11 liability for both board members and

underwriters.-[7]-

     In seeking to strike the proper balance, we believe the

proper starting point is to define a realistic role for

gatekeepers that is sensitive to both the time constraints

imposed on issuers and underwriters by the marketplace and the

character of the modern board of directors.  When the Securities

Act of 1933 was drafted, both were very different.  Corporate

boards were then insider-dominated with few truly independent

directors, and as a result it was natural to assume that board

members would be familiar with all material pending corporate

developments.  The modern board is now predominantly composed of

outside directors, who are not necessarily familiar on a daily

basis with all material information concerning their corporation

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[7]-     On the other hand, fulfillment of this duty may
               serve to protect directors and underwriters from
               liability for material omissions relating to
               developments subsequent to the issuer's last Form
               10-Q.  See Shaw v. Digital Equipment Corp., supra
               n.3.


==========================================START OF PAGE 60======

and who have other commitments and business obligations that

preclude them from devoting unlimited time to the corporations

they serve as outside directors.  Correspondingly, where once a

public offering of debt or equity securities was a long, drawn-

out process which permitted ample time for conducting a due

diligence review, it can now occur from conception to

consummation under shelf registration within the space of a

single day.  As a result, the full board of directors, dispersed

in the typical case across the country and subject to their own

time constraints, often cannot undertake a meaningful due

diligence review, at least not within the compressed time frames

that the equity marketplace imposes.

     What then can be done without sacrificing the idea of

independent gatekeepers?  The modern board necessarily functions

through specialization and delegation.  Thus, one of us has

recommended (and the Advisory Committee has accepted) the idea of

a disclosure committee in which the "due diligence" gatekeeping

function would be largely centralized.  Such a committee, which

would in all likelihood be a subcommittee of the audit committee,

would meet with the underwriters, senior management, and the

outside accountants to review the corporation's disclosures and

its proposed Form 8-K.  Directors not on this committee would be

entitled to rely on the efforts of such a committee (at least

provided that their reliance was reasonable and they did not have

any objective reason to doubt its performance and did not


==========================================START OF PAGE 61======

otherwise lack confidence in the accuracy of the corporation's

disclosures or financial statements).

     Even if the logic of our proposal is sound, movement toward

it will not come automatically.  Rather, the Commission must hold

out positive incentives to encourage its adoption.  Here, the

Report stops short of addressing these necessary incentives.  One

such incentive would be a clear right on the part of the other

directors to rely on such a committee, much as directors may do

under the common law or statutory provisions in most states.

Even more importantly, however, the SEC would need to face and

address the liability of the disclosure committee members,

themselves.  Easy as it is to say that the rest of the board can

rely upon the disclosure committee, this policy will not work if

outside directors are unwilling to staff such a committee for

fear of enhanced liability.  As a practical matter, we doubt that

practitioners will counsel directors to adopt such a committee or

to serve on it -- absent clearer SEC guidance.-[8]-  Such

SEC guidance could take a variety of forms:  safe harbors, a

burden shifting rule, or some fuller specification of what the

committee should do.  For example, when the disclosure committee

has engaged in a specified review of the corporation's financial


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[8]-     Indeed, the early commentary on a publicly
               circulated draft of this Report has focused on
               exactly this problem.  See Roberta S. Karmel,
               Deregulation:  Real or Alleged, N.Y.L.J., June 20,
               1996, at 3, 7 (noting that "there would be no
               diminution in 11 liability under the Securities
               Act . . ." under the Advisory Committee Report).


==========================================START OF PAGE 62======

statements and '34 Act filings, the Commission might exercise its

exemptive authority to shift the burden of proof under 11 to the

plaintiff to prove that this investigation was inadequate.  Such

a change would not wholly absolve committee members from

liability, but it would require the plaintiffs to prove by clear

and convincing evidence that the investigation that they did

conduct was unreasonable under the circumstances.

     Beyond this change, a more general principle might also be

recognized:  the diligence that is due should be proportionate to

the size and character of the offering.  Today, the leading

precedents that guide practitioners -- Feit v. Leasco Data

Processing Equip. Corp.,-[9]- and Escott v. Bar Chris

Construction Corp.-[10]- -- deal with major offerings by

high-risk companies.  These cases are clearly correct on their

facts, but they do not address the nature of the investigation

that should be required by outside directors or underwriters in

proportionately smaller offerings by established companies with

rapid access to the market under a company registration system in

order to establish a "reasonable investigation" defense under

11.  Here again, SEC guidance is necessary if the board and the

underwriters are to play a meaningful role as a gatekeeper in the

disclosure process.




---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[9]-     332 F. Supp. 544 (E.D.N.Y. 1971).

     -[10]-    283 F. Supp. 643 (S.D.N.Y. 1968).


==========================================START OF PAGE 63======

     We, of course, recognize that a single Advisory Committee

cannot address every issue, and this committee was not selected

to address legal issues.  Nonetheless, the Report concludes

without proposing ways to update the liability rules under the

federal securities laws to mesh with its proposed new disclosure

system.  As a result, the paradigm shift that this Report

envisions is incompletely articulated.

     Gatekeeper liability makes sense only when the gatekeeper is

placed in a position to take effective preventive action.

Strategies such as the disclosure committee may enable a board

committee to play a meaningful gatekeeper role in the disclosure

process.  But, to induce the corporation to form such a committee

or outside directors to staff it, some relief from the "in

terrorem" liabilities of 11 is necessary.  In the last analysis,

a choice must be made between (1) abandoning the idea of a

gatekeeper role for the outside director (as some have

argued)-[11]- and (2) focusing the liability provisions of

the federal securities laws so they encourage the performance of

clearly specified responsibilities, but expose the board to no

greater liability than is necessary.  That choice has not yet

been made and now falls to the Commission.

     (2)  Adopting Company Registration Via the Backdoor.

     We are concerned that the recommendations of the Advisory

Committee could be adopted in a selective, piecemeal fashion that


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[11]-    See, e.g., Green, supra n.1.


==========================================START OF PAGE 64======

yields greater deregulation but little or no qualitative

improvement in our disclosure system.  If there were to be

significant deregulation of the existing shelf registration

system without the concomitant adoption of mandatory disclosure

enhancements or the proposed Form 8-K filing obligation, this

would be the net result.

     Even if company registration is adopted as a voluntary opt-

in system, there may be inadequate incentives for issuers to

elect it.  Inevitably, issuers will compare company registration

with shelf registration.  Here, one of the principal attractions

of company registration over shelf registration is that it gives

the issuer greater flexibility by permitting the issuer in effect

to register and sell all its outstanding shares without

substantive restrictions.  In contrast, Rule 415 permits a shelf

registration statement in the case of an "at the market offering

of equity securities" to register no more that "10% of the

aggregate market value of the registrant's outstanding voting

stock held by non-affiliates of the registrant."-[12]-

Although this limitation seems significant at first glance, the

staff's interpretation of this provision has minimized its actual

impact.  For example, we have been informed by the staff that it

does not read the 10% ceiling on shelf registration to apply to a

fixed commitment underwriting, even when the offering is done at

the last closing price of the issuer's stock on a stock exchange.

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[12]-    See Rule 415(a)(4)(ii), 17 C.F.R.
               230.415(a)(4)(ii).


==========================================START OF PAGE 65======

In such a case, we were told, the offering will not be deemed an

"at the market" offering.  As a result, the relative incentive to

opt into a voluntary company registration system dissipates to

the extent this ceiling on shelf registration is relaxed.

Indeed, while an offering under company registration will

sometimes be subject to staff review (if it is in excess of a

specified percentage of the company's outstanding shares), no

such review will occur under the current system if the offering

is properly structured and the company has filed an unallocated

shelf registration statement.-[13]-  We point to this

example not to protest it, but simply to illustrate how weak the

incentives may be to elect into a voluntary company registration

system, especially in light of the growing use of unallocated

shelf registration statements.

     In contrast, the regulatory requirements associated with

company registration are real.  Chief among these are the

mandatory Form 8-K filing obligation, the certification

requirement, and the senior management report.  Although the Form

8-K filing may serve to promote a current review of developments

subsequent to the corporate issuer's last filing under the

Securities Exchange Act of 1934's periodic disclosure system (and


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[13]-    If the Commission adopts its proposed rule to make
               reporting of probable and material acquisitions
               the same under the Securities Act of 1933 and the
               Securities Exchange Act of 1934, an unallocated
               shelf registration statement will seemingly give
               more predictable market access than would be
               available under company registration.



==========================================START OF PAGE 66======

this could reduce corporate liability), it is undeniable that

many issuers will view this requirement (and the other new

mandatory features associated with company registration) as

increased burdens, particularly because any periodic report that

is incorporated by reference into the registration statement will

carry 11 liability.  In contrast, a prospectus supplement does

not carry 11 liability (nor will it create 12(2) liability for

the corporation's directors because they are not in privity with

the buyers).  Hence, this disparity between the legal status of a

Form 8-K filing and a prospectus supplement may cause corporate

counsel to prefer shelf registration to company registration.

     We see only one answer to this problem:  level the playing

field by extending the new requirements to shelf registration as

well.-[14]-  In our judgment, these requirements are

justified because they should enhance the quality of disclosure

to the secondary market.  We realize that this proposal will not

be popular in some quarters.  Still, unless it is implemented,

the prospect is remote in our judgment that many issuers will

adopt company registration.




---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[14]-    We recognize that the Advisory Committee Report
               does recommend that the Form
     8-K filing obligation be extended to shelf registration as
     well as to company registration, but we are concerned that,
     unless highlighted, this recommendation may receive
     inadequate attention.

==========================================START OF PAGE 1======

                            APPENDIX A
            THE IMPACT OF THE CURRENT REGULATORY SYSTEM
           ON INVESTOR PROTECTION AND CAPITAL FORMATION


I.   Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

II.  Direct and Indirect Costs and Uncertainties Resulting From
     the Registration Process for Public Offerings  . . . . . . .

  A.  Costs of Registration - The Offering Process  . . .

     1.  Direct Costs Associated with the Public Offering Process


     2.  Delay and Uncertainty Caused by Commission Staff Review


     3.  Residual Costs Associated With Registering Equity
         Securities On Shelf Registration Statements --
         Pre-offering Filing Fees, Short-Selling and Market
         Overhang  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .


  B.  Indirect Costs Associated with the Current Regulatory
      Scheme  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

     1.  Securities Act Concepts Designed to Ensure the
         Registration of Public
         Offers and Sales Can Produce Unnecessary Costs and
         Uncertainties and Reduce Flexibility in Structuring
         Financing Transactions  . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

               ù    Gun-jumping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
               ù    Integration and General Solicitation
                    Doctrines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
               ù    Constraints on Resales - Statutory
                    Underwriters and Affiliates  . . . . . . .

     2.  Mandatory Prospectus Disclosure Requirements Do Not Meet
         Investor Needs in the Most Efficient Manner . . . . .

III.  Changes in the Markets and Offering Processes, and the
      Effect on Investor Protection . . . . . . . . . . . .

  A.  Attractiveness of Public, Private and Offshore Markets


==========================================START OF PAGE 2======

  B.  Blurring of Distinctions Between Public, Private and
      Offshore Markets  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

  C.  Growth of Secondary Markets and Changes in Offering
      Techniques  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

  D.  Changes in Gatekeeper Role  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

ADDENDUMS TO APPENDIX A

Figure 1: Aggregate Net Issuance of Securities by Domestic Non-
          Financial Businesses,
          by Year

Figure 2: Total Value of Public Offerings of Equity vs. Trading
          Volume in Existing Markets, by Year

Figure 3: Value of Underwritten Public Offerings and Private
          Placements of Equity,
          by Year

Figure 4: Percent of Issuers Offering Additional Common Stock, by
          Year and Type of Filing

Figure 5: Distribution of Waiting Periods, by Review, for Offers
          of Additional Common Stock, 1990-94

Figure 6: Fraction of Offers Within Various Size Limits, for
          Underwritten Offers of Common Stock, 1992-94



List of Tables

Table 1   Typical Expenses In Underwritten Public Offers of
          Common Stock in 1993-95

Table 1b  Typical Expenses in Underwritten Public Offers of
          Common Stock in 1993-95, for Repeat Offers of $20 to
          $200 million by Domestic Issuers, by Value of Offer

Table 2   Typical Experience of Filers of Registration Statements
          for Underwritten Public Offers of Common Stock, January
          1994 through December 1995

Table 3   Typical Change in Stock Price from Filing to Effective
          Date, for Underwritten Public Offers of Additional
          Common Stock by 990 NYSE/Amex/Nasdaq issuers, 1993-94,
          by Pre-Offer Market Capitalization, and by Whether the
          Filing is Reviewed by the SEC


==========================================START OF PAGE 3======

Table 4   Relative Importance of Shelf Registration as a Vehicle
          for Securities Sales, by Class of Security and Year


                            APPENDIX A

           THE IMPACT OF THE CURRENT REGULATORY SYSTEM
           ON INVESTOR PROTECTION AND CAPITAL FORMATION

I.   Introduction

     The Committee, in the course of its deliberations,

identified costs associated with the current regulatory process

and disclosure requirements relating to public offerings of

securities, secondary market trading and corporate reporting.

The Committee then investigated the extent to which the benefits

derived from the existing regulatory structure continue to

justify the identified costs.  Although significant progress has

been made by the Commission over time to streamline the capital

formation process, particularly through the adoption of the

integrated disclosure system and shelf registration, domestic

capital formation through public securities offerings continues

to be hampered by costs and uncertainties associated with the

registration process.  These costs include both direct and

indirect costs created by the registration process, including

costs resulting from the increasingly complex, and often

ambiguous, legal distinctions that have evolved to protect that

process.

     The current regulatory system crafted during the era of the

Great Depression does not fully and most efficiently meet the

needs and realities of today's markets, which are increasingly

complicated by modern financing techniques, technological

advancements, globalization, and changes in investor profiles and

demands.  These developments bring into question whether all


==========================================START OF PAGE 2======

types of companies should be subject to the current Securities

Act's transactional registration requirements each time they

desire to raise capital in the public markets.  After concluding

that the current structure was imposing unnecessary costs, while

not fully taking into account the needs of today's investors, the

Committee determined to recommend a shift in the focus of the

regulatory structure from the current transactional system to a

company registration system that would reduce these costs while

enhancing investor protection.

II.  Direct and Indirect Costs and Uncertainties Resulting From
     the Registration Process for Public Offerings

     The current registration scheme imposes indirect and
     direct costs.  The indirect costs include uncertainty
     and delay arising from the possibility of Commission
     staff review (including the possibility of losing a
     market window), market overhangs, short-selling and
     related activities, and publicity constraints.  Direct
     costs include legal, accounting, underwriting, printing
     and filing fees.

     A.   Costs of Registration - The Offering Process

          1.   Direct Costs Associated with the Public Offering
Process

     The public offering process can be costly for issuers.  For

smaller companies and newer entrants to the capital markets, the

fees paid to the Commission, state regulators, accountants,

lawyers, underwriters, and financial printers amount to a larger

percentage of offering proceeds than for more seasoned issuers.

However, the absolute amount of these direct costs also can be

significant for more seasoned issuers.  Generally, direct costs

are higher for offerings of common stock compared to bonds.  From

January 1990 through December 1994, it is estimated that the


==========================================START OF PAGE 3======

direct costs of raising capital in public offerings averaged 2.2%

of proceeds for straight debt, 3.8% for convertible bonds, 7.1%

for repeat offerings of equity by seasoned issuers, and 11.0% for

initial public offerings of equity.-[1]-

     Table 1 below, prepared by the Committee staff, shows the

breakdown of the components of the direct costs of public

offerings, focusing on offerings of common stock from January

1993 to December 1995.  Underwriter's compensation (spread) is

the largest component of floatation costs, typically amounting to

5.3% of proceeds in repeat offerings and 7% of proceeds in

initial public offerings.  Systematic underpricing, as measured

by the discount from market price, constitutes the second largest

component, typically amounting to 1.2% of proceeds in repeat

offerings and 7.1% in initial public offerings.  Summing these

costs and all other direct fees (for lawyers, accountants,

printers, and regulators), the total cost of raising capital

through public offerings of common stock typically amounts to

7.3% of proceeds in repeat public offerings and 16.9% in initial

public offerings.  Table 1 also provides data on floatation costs

broken down according to the type of filing used to register the

stock, and shows that typical costs are lowest for issuers using

Form S-3 shelf offerings (5.0%) and highest (almost 20 - 30%)

among the small-business filers that use Form

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[1]-     Inmoo Lee, Scott Lockhead, Jay Ritter and Quanshui
               Zhao, The Costs of Raising Capital, Journal of
               Financial Research, Vol. XIX, No. 1, pp. 59-74
               (Spring 1996).


==========================================START OF PAGE 4======

SB-2.-[2]-










































---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[2]-     Form SB-2 is a short-form registration statement
               available to small businesses.  One reason, seen
               in Table 1, that the offering costs for SB-2
               filers is a higher proportion of proceeds is that
               the typical SB-2 offer yields just $6 million in
               proceeds, compared to $78 million for shelf
               offerings.


==========================================START OF PAGE 5======


__________________________________________________________________________________________                                                                                              
                                                Table 1
                Typical Expenses In Underwritten Public Offers of Common Stock in 1993-95
                                                  

                            Registration Number  Median   Median Median  Median   Sum
                             Form Used            Value   Under-   Fees  Discount
                                                   of     writer   (a)       
                                                  Offer   Spread          from 
                                                 (millions               Market
                                                  dollars)
                                                                          Price
                                                                           (b)
                 Initial    SB-2          408       $6.1   10.0%    7.4%  11.5%  28.9%
                Offer of
                 Common
                Stock by
                Domestic
                 Issuer

                            S-1           1201      30.1     7.0     2.3   7.1    16.4
                            S-2, S-11     100      131.7     6.5     1.8   1.1    9.4

                            Sub-Total     1709      24.0     7.0     2.8   7.1    16.9

                 Repeat     SB-2           99        7.9     9.0     4.5   5.4    18.9
                Offer of
                 Common
                Stock by
                Domestic
                 Issuer
                            S-1           468       32.0     5.5     1.3   2.4    9.2

                            S-2, S-11     192       20.4     6.0     1.7   2.3    10.0
                            S-3, Non-     751       59.1     5.0     0.6   0.7    6.3
                           shelf

                            S-3, Shelf    136       77.6     4.6     0.4   0.0    5.0
                           (c)
                            Sub-Total     1646      44.8     5.3     0.8   1.2    7.3

                Overseas    F-1, F-2,     214       65.1     5.1     2.1   1.3    8.5
                 Issuer    F-3

                  Total                   3569     $32.5    6.8%    1.8%  2.8%   11.4%





               Source: Securities Data Corp.  Includes firm commitment underwriting
               only.
               Notes: (a) Fees include SEC and state filing fees, listing fees, legal
               fees, accounting fees, printing costs, and other miscellaneous fees. 
               (b) The discount from market captures underpricing of offers, measured
               here by the first-day return, calculated as the percentage change from
               the offer price to the market price at the close of trading on the
               offer date.  (c) Since there can be multiple offers (takedowns) from
               shelf registrations, calculations for this category are based on the
               first takedown of common stock.



__________________________________________________________________________________________                                                                                              

                                       Table 1b
                  Typical Expenses In Underwritten Public Offers of Common Stock in
                1993-95, for Repeat Offers of $20 to $200 million by Domestic Issuers,
                                          by Value of Offer

                  Value  Registration   Number  Median  Median  Median  Median   Sum
                of Offer Form Used               Value  Under-   Fees  Discount
                (million                          of    writer   (a)       
                dollars)                         Offer  Spread          from 
                                                (millions              Market 
                                                 dollars)               Price
                                                                         (b)
                                                    

                  $20.0  S-1              167     $32.4    5.5%    1.2%    2.3%   9.0%
                    to
                  $49.9
                         S-3, Non-Shelf   226      34.7     5.5     0.8     1.2    7.5

                         S-3, Shelf       28       33.8     5.0     0.7     0.0    5.7

                  $50.0  S-1              99       62.1     5.0     0.7     1.1    6.8
                    to
                  $99.9

                         S-3, Non-Shelf   250      66.9     5.0     0.5     0.7    6.2
                         S-3, Shelf       49       72.2     5.3     0.5     0.0    5.8

                 $100.0  S-1              31      125.9     4.5     0.3     1.4    6.2
                   to
                 $199.9

                         S-3, Non-Shelf   135     128.1     4.0     0.3     0.5    4.8
                         S-3, Shelf       30      130.8     3.5     0.3     0.0    3.8





                Source: Securities Data Corp.  Includes firm commitment underwriting
                only.
                Notes: (a) Fees include SEC and state filing fees, listing fees, legal
                fees, accounting fees, printing costs, and other miscellaneous fees. 
                (b) The discount from market captures underpricing of offers, measured
                here by the first-day return, calculated as the percentage change from
                the offer price to the market price at the close of trading on the
                offer date.



      Floatation costs are higher for small business issuers for

reasons unrelated to regulation, but a differential regulatory


==========================================START OF PAGE 6======

burden is the best explanation for the lower floatation costs

experienced by S-3 issuers as compared to S-1 issuers.  For

repeat offerings of common stock by seasoned issuers, S-1 issuers

incur costs totalling approximately 9.2% of proceeds, whereas S-3

(non-shelf) issuers incur costs totalling approximately 6.3% of

proceeds, and S-3 (shelf) issuers incur costs totalling 5.0% of

proceeds.  These differences are only partly attributable to the

larger offer size seen in offerings on Form S-3.  Table 1b below

reports typical offering costs for various sized offers, and a

pattern of lower costs for offerings utilizing Form S-3 is found

within each size-based subgroup.

Table 1b - see accompanying link

==========================================START OF PAGE 7======



      The single largest determinant of the lower costs seen in

the S-3 shelf filings is the ability to distribute the securities

at the current market price upon takedown, rather than at a

discount to the market price as seen in offerings utilizing Form

S-1 or Form S-3 non-shelf.  These cost savings are indicative of

the benefits of "just-in-time" financing techniques that would be

available to company-registered issuers.  It is the Committee's

hope and expectation that an increase in an issuer's flexibility

to go to market in a more streamlined manner could result in

further reductions in the direct costs of public offerings.

Lower direct costs could translate into lower costs of capital in

numerous ways.  Allowing for the adoption of just-in-time capital

techniques, whereby companies can access the market exactly when

they want and for the exact amount they want, will help eliminate

the discount from the market price currently experienced in non-

shelf public offerings of common stock.  In addition, by

extending the benefits of the streamlined offering process and

creating greater flexibility regarding the delivery of disclosure

documents to investors, underwriting, legal and printing costs

should be reduced further.


==========================================START OF PAGE 8======

          2.   Delay and Uncertainty Caused by Commission Staff

Review

     The time consumed by the registration process represents an

indirect cost for issuers.   Under the current system, no sales

of securities are allowed until the Commission has declared a

registration statement to be effective.  During this waiting

period, the length of which may be affected by whether the

Commission staff reviews the document, issuers may miss a desired

market window.

     Under the current Commission staff's selective review

criteria, all registration statements for initial public

offerings (IPOs) are reviewed by the staff.  In addition,

pursuant to internal selective review criteria, the staff may

choose to review any other registration statement filed with the

Commission, including shelf registration statements when

initially filed to register securities for the shelf.  Prior to

filing a registration statement, even the most seasoned issuer

will not know whether its registration statement will be

reviewed, or the length of the time delay resulting from the

review process if there is a staff review.  Issuers trying to

sell securities, other than off a shelf registration statement

previously declared effective, consequently cannot predict in

advance exactly when they will be able to go to market.-[3]-

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[3]-     For shelf offerings, the shelf registration
               statement may not be used until declared effective
               by the staff.  And, as a practical matter, most
               initial takedowns off a shelf occur shortly after
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 9======

Often, they will prepare two different time schedules when

planning a public offering -- one assuming Commission review, and

the other assuming no review -- and the difference between these

two timetables can be substantial.-[4]-

     If a registration statement is reviewed, the staff does not

comment on the merits of an offering.  Rather, the staff

evaluates the adequacy of the issuer's disclosures.  Staff review

encompasses the disclosure in the registration statement as well

as in the company's Exchange Act reports and any other documents

on file with the Commission.  Under shelf registration, however,

the staff does not review prior to its use the prospectus

supplement containing transactional information that is used in

taking down securities off the shelf for public sale.

     After receiving staff comments, issuers may respond to the

issues raised in the comment letter by revising disclosures in

the registration statement and other corporate disclosures

(including possibly Exchange Act reports) to address the staff's

concerns, by explaining in a supplemental letter to the staff why


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[3]-(...continued)
               the registration statement becomes effective.
               Thus, the staff review process may still pose a
               real impediment to shelf takedowns.  However,
               because the issuer may register up to the amount
               of securities that it expects to issue in the next
               two years, and there generally is no post-
               effective staff review of takedown prospectuses,
               theoretically this delay does not have to occur
               frequently.

     -[4]-     Transcript of May 8, 1995 Advisory Committee
               Meeting at 227 (statement of Gerald Backman).


==========================================START OF PAGE 10======

revisions are not necessary, or both.  After the issuer resolves

the concerns raised by the staff, the registration statement is

declared effective.  In the extreme, where an issuer misses a

market opportunity while responding to the staff's inquiries, the

company will have expended significant funds preparing for an

unsuccessful offering (although, for a shelf issuer where

registration statement has been declared effective, the issuer

can use the effective shelf at a subsequent time).  The mere

prospect of such uncertainty and delay may cause an issuer to

forego a registered offering.

     Table 2 below provides a Committee staff analysis of recent

issuer experience with staff review, covering the frequency of

review and the average length of waiting periods.  These results

are given for registration statements of underwritten offerings

of common stock that were declared effective during 1994 and

1995.  During that period, all initial public offerings received

a full review.  In addition, pursuant to selective review, less

than one in six Form S-3 shelf and non-shelf registration

statements were reviewed, and approximately one-third of all

other registration statements for repeat offerings were reviewed.


==========================================START OF PAGE 11======

                                       Table 2
               Typical Experience of Filers of Registration Statements for Underwritten
                  Public Offers of Common Stock, January 1994 through December 1995

                      Registration Number  Average   Average Number of  Percent Average
                        Form Used           Amount      Days before    Reviewed  Number
                                          Registered     Effective:     by SEC  of times
                                         ($millions)                            Amended
                                                     

                                                    Spent  Spent Total
                                                       at at the
                                                      the Issuer
                                                      SEC

              Initial       SB-1 &  122     $20.3     42.6 61.1  103.7   100%     3.3
              Offer of       SB-2 
               Common
              Stock by
              Domestic
               Issuer
                       S-1          641      66.4     38.9 39.3  78.1     100     3.2
                       S-11         42      198.8     45.5 60.0  105.5    100     4.0

               Repeat  SB-2         64       24.2     23.8 44.5  68.2    54.7     2.4
              Offer of
               Common
              Stock by
              Domestic
               Issuer
                       S-1          310      70.3     16.7 35.4  52.2    33.5     1.8

                       S-2, S-11    79       67.7     15.6 36.5  52.2    24.1     1.9
                       S-3, Non-    416     111.1      9.3 22.8  32.1    13.9     1.2
                       Shelf

                       S-3, Shelf*  486     284.1     17.5 36.3  53.7    16.0     1.1
              Foreign  F-1, F-2,    117     205.4     17.0 45.3  62.4    78.6     2.4
               Issuer  F-3

             Source: SEC Division of Corporation Finance.  Includes firm commitment
             underwriting only.  Excludes regional office filings.
              
             * Includes shelf offerings of common stock by the issuer and unallocated
             shelf offerings that are not exclusively     debt and/or preferred stock;
             does not include Commission staff pre-review -- which is never done -- of
             the
               takedown prospectus; with regard to shelf registration statements, staff
             review is limited to the registration
               statement when initially filed.


      The typical time period between the filing and the

effectiveness of the registration statement was less than three

months for an initial public offering and less than two months

for repeat offerings.  Waiting periods may be longer when the

staff's review and comments are extensive and require substantial


==========================================START OF PAGE 12======

revisions to the registration statement before being declared

effective, thereby introducing uncertainty into the capital

formation process.  Staff review also reduces the predictability

of waiting periods, i.e., the length of the waiting period will

vary more where the document is reviewed than when not reviewed.

The degree to which waiting periods vary in length is illustrated

in Figure 5 in the Addendum to this Appendix A, which is a

histogram showing the relative frequency with which waiting

periods of various lengths were observed among underwritten

offers of additional common stock during 1993 and 1994.  As shown

in Figure 5, the distribution of the length of waiting periods is

more tightly clustered around the average waiting period in the

absence of a staff review.  The length of the waiting period also

is influenced significantly, however, by factors separate from

the Commission review procedure, such as whether the disclosure

in the registration statement when initially filed was

significantly deficient, whether the issuer delayed or

significantly altered the structure of the financing after the

registration statement was filed, and whether the issuer's

Exchange Act reports had been recently reviewed by the

staff.-[5]-

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[5]-     Even if a document is not reviewed by the
               Commission staff, issuers can and do amend
               registration statements prior to effectiveness.
               On average, non-shelf registration statements that
               are not reviewed are amended at least once prior
               to effectiveness (compared to approximately three
               amendments if reviewed).  Although shelf
               registration statements are amended less often
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 13======

     The risk that disclosed information is erroneous, incomplete

or fraudulent is itself a significant uncertainty that can impose

costs on the capital formation process.  Thus, a potential

benefit of the retention of Commission review of transactional

disclosure documents arises from efforts by the Commission staff

to compel issuers to disclose more fully information that would

impact market perceptions of the value of the securities to be

issued.

     The Committee strongly believes that staff review is

important where the transaction involves IPOs or major

restructurings.  In these cases, the issuer in essence is

beginning the disclosure process anew because the bulk of the

information already available to the public, if any, is not as

useful as in the case of a seasoned company doing a routine

financing.  In addition, the coverage by analysts and the

efficiency of the markets in reviewing and absorbing the

information and in pricing securities is less effective in these

transactions than with routine repeat offerings by seasoned

companies.  By retaining staff review in these instances,

corrective revisions of preliminary prospectuses prior to closing

can enhance the quality of the disclosure provided to investors,

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[5]-(...continued)
               than non-shelf registration statements after
               filing with the Commission, non-reviewed shelf
               registration statements are amended prior to
               effectiveness .5 times versus 2.4 times for
               reviewed shelf registration statements (although
               presumably some of these amendments in the latter
               category are voluntary).


==========================================START OF PAGE 14======

prevent later and more disruptive corrective disclosure, and

reduce an issuer's exposure to litigation.  In the case of Form

S-3 eligible issuers doing routine offerings, however, where the

market following these issuers is better informed and efficient,

the benefits of any review process obviously are less

certain.-[6]-  Simply put, the efficacy of the continuous

disclosure reporting scheme under the Exchange Act, including the

review by the staff of operating and financial information filed

on Form 10-K and other reports, may render unnecessary the

separate pre-review by the staff of registration statements and

other transactional filings by reporting companies.

     Some argue that the possibility of Commission review of

seasoned issuer transactional filings provides significant

deterrent value that serves to increase the quality of public

disclosures.  They argue these issuers voluntarily provide

negative material disclosure without the benefit of an actual

review, at least partially due to the possibility that they might

be reviewed.  Others argue that the primary motivator in ensuring

proper disclosure is the fact that the issuer is subject to

liability for market fraud and other civil liability and

government enforcement actions for improper disclosures.  In this

respect, strict liability under Section 11 for material

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[6]-     In fact, the Division of Corporation Finance
               appears to acknowledge this in that it does not
               review takedown prospectuses in the context of
               shelf registrations and reviews only approximately
               14 to 16 percent of Form S-3 (shelf and non-shelf)
               registration statements.


==========================================START OF PAGE 15======

misstatements undoubtedly serves to ensure appropriate compliance

with the dictate of full and fair disclosure.

     In the Committee's view, it is inherently difficult to

measure or quantify the incidence of or avoided costs related to

false or misleading statements that are never made, either

because of the possibility of staff review or the threat of

liability.  The staff of the Committee analyzed stock-price

evidence in an effort to quantify the benefit to investors

provided by the review process with respect to transactional

filings by reporting companies.  If the information generated by

the staff review is predominantly negative, and if stock prices

generally reflect publicly available information, then one could

expect Commission reviews, at least in certain instances, to be

associated with declines in stock prices relative to the market,

on average, over the course of the review.  Table 3 below

provides evidence regarding the impact of Commission reviews on

filings for underwritten public offerings of additional common

stock by Nasdaq, NYSE and Amex-listed issuers during 1993 and

1994.  The evidence in Table 3 shows no statistically significant

difference in the average change in stock prices relative to the

market according to whether or not filings are reviewed.

     Even if this data is construed as demonstrating that no new

material information is generated by staff review of these

transactional filings, that result should not be surprising.  If

the continuous disclosure requirements (including the threat of

liability) and staff review of periodic reports are working as


==========================================START OF PAGE 16======

intended, then no material company-related information should be

disclosed during the pre-effective review process.

     Moreover, the statistical test was only available for repeat

offers by more seasoned issuers, and was only conducted for

exchange-listed and Nasdaq issuers.  Therefore, no evidence was

considered on the value added by staff review in initial public

offerings or in the case of the smallest companies, where the

value added by staff review would be expected to be greater.


__________________________________________________________________________________________                                                                                              

                                        Table 3
                   Typical Change in Stock Price from Filing to Effective Date, for
                                             Underwritten
                   Public Offers of Additional Common Stock by 990 NYSE/Amex/Nasdaq
                                           Issuers, 1993-94,
                   by Pre-Offer Market Capitalization, and by Whether the Filing is
                                          Reviewed by the SEC
                                    Percentage Change in Issuer Stock Price
                                         Less Corresponding Percentage Change in
                                                   the Market Overall

                                            Medians              Means
                           Market          No   Review   No    Review  Difference
                       Capitalization    Review        Review             (t-
                                                                       statistic)
                     Under $100 Million  -7.0%  -8.9%   -6.9%   -7.4%    -0.5%
                                                                         (0.21)
                       $100 Million or   -1.8%  -1.2%   -1.3%   0.5%     +1.8%
                            More                                         (1.16)
                          Difference                    -5.6%   -7.9%
                          (t-statistic)                (5.17)  (2.28)

                  Source: Securities Data Corp. and Center for Research on
                  Securities Prices.   Includes firm commitment underwriting only. 
                  Net-of-Market stock price changes are calculated by subtracting
                  the change in the CRSP value-weighted portfolio of all exchange-
                  listed stocks for exchange-listed issuers, or the change in the
                  value-weighted portfolio of all Nasdaq stocks for issuers traded
                  on Nasdaq.  Percentages changes are calculated over the period
                  from one day before the filing date through the date the filing
                  is declared effective. A t-statistic in excess of 1.96 indicates
                  a difference in means that is statistically significant by
                  conventional (i.e., 5%) standards.

==========================================START OF PAGE 17======

     On balance, and consistent with the thrust of the

Commission's initiatives, the Committee believes that the cost

and uncertainties created by the current Commission staff review

process of transactional filings might be eliminated for most

issuances by large seasoned companies without any adverse loss of

deterrent effect, as long as those transactional disclosures, as

well as the company's periodic and other filed reports, remain

subject to staff review on a routine basis after the transaction,

as well as remaining subject to Securities Act liability.  The

possibility that a company's periodic and other filed reports as

well as transactional disclosure could be reviewed after the

completion of the offering should be as effective as the

deterrence currently provided by the possibility of review prior

to going to market.

          3.   Residual Costs Associated With Registering Equity
               Securities On Shelf Registration Statements --
               Pre-offering Filing Fees, Short-Selling and Market
               Overhang

     Recognizing the costs associated with the traditional

registration process and staff review, the Commission over the

last fifteen years has acted to alleviate delays in going to

market by adopting the shelf registration process.  This process

allows seasoned companies to register securities in advance for

sale at a later date.  Shelf registration gives a company the

flexibility to enter the market quickly by offering the

previously registered securities "off the shelf," either in one

offering or in several tranches.  When the company decides to do

such a "takedown," it files with the Commission, and delivers to


==========================================START OF PAGE 18======

investors, a prospectus supplement describing the terms of the

securities and the specific offering.  Issuers are permitted to

use the prospectus supplement to market the securities prior to

their sale.  Although it may be reviewed subsequent to the

offering, the prospectus supplement is not subject to Commission

staff review prior to its use.  Shelf registration also can be

used for secondary distributions by selling shareholders who wish

to time their sales to coincide with favorable market price

movements.

     As originally adopted, shelf registration required the

delineation of the specific amount of each class of security to

be registered.  In 1992, the Commission amended the rule

governing the shelf procedure to allow "unallocated" or

"universal" shelf registration where companies may register an

aggregate dollar amount of one or more classes of securities

without having to specify the amount of each class of security

that is registered.-[7]-

     Table 4 below reports on recent usage of shelf registration

by corporate issuers of additional securities (i.e., repeat

offerings).  During the period from January 1992 through December

1995, on a value-weighted basis, shelf registration was used for

approximately one-half of all underwritten offers of preferred

stock and approximately 40 percent of all underwritten offers of

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[7]-     Simplification of Registration Procedures for
               Primary Offerings, Securities Act Rel. 6943 (July
               16, 1992) [57 FR 32461 (July 22, 1992)] (the
               "Primary Offerings Procedures Release").


==========================================START OF PAGE 19======

corporate debt, but only approximately ten percent of all

underwritten offers of common stock.  While sellers of additional

common stock are still less likely to use a shelf registration

than are sellers of preferred stock and debt, the year-by-year

changes reported in Table 4 show that sellers are increasingly

using the shelf registration process to sell common stock.  In

1992, takedowns from shelf registrations amounted to three

percent of all underwritten offers of additional common stock.

In 1994 and 1995, fifteen percent of the total value of

additional underwritten common stock issues came from shelf

registrations.-[8]-  Indeed, a recent Wall Street Journal

article pointed out not only the increase in recent years in the

number of shelf registration statements that include equity, but

also the recent use of shelf takedowns to sell large amounts of

equity in what are essentially "big block trades." -[9]-



                                        Table 4
                Relative Importance of Shelf Registration as a Vehicle for Securities
                                 Sales, by Class of Security and Year
                Class of      Cumulative Volume             Shelf Takedowns,
                Security      of Public Offers,                  by Year
                                   1992-95                 (% of Class Total)
                                (billions of
                                  dollars)


                                

          //   Michael Santoli, Block Trades Test Traditions On Wall
               Street, Wall St. J., February 9, 1996, at B12B, col. 3
               ("Santoli") ("Shelf filings that cover equity have steadily
               become more common, rising 18% to 110 in 1995 after climbing
               26% in 1994"). 





                               Shelf     Class                        1994     1995 
                             Takedown    Total     1992    1993

                Common         16.8      156.1         3     9          15      15
                Stock

                Preferred      44.0       89.4        38    47          60      65
                Stock                                         

                Corporate      661.1     1648.7       48    45          39      33
                Debt                                          

               Source: Securities Data Corp.  Excludes best efforts deals, private
               placements, initial public offerings, and all sales of asset-backed
               securities.

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[8]-     Of the $9.4 billion in common stock sold using
               shelf registration from January 1992 through
               December 1994, the Committee staff estimates that
               at least $7.6 billion was sold using the
               unallocated shelf process.

     -[9]-     Michael Santoli, Block Trades Test Traditions On
               Wall Street, Wall St. J., February 9, 1996, at
               B12B, col. 3 ("Santoli") ("Shelf filings that
               cover equity have steadily become more common,
               rising 18% to 110 in 1995 after climbing 26% in
               1994").


==========================================START OF PAGE 20======


     One significant deterrent to the use of the shelf

registration process has been issuers' fear of a dilutive "market

overhang."  Overhang often depresses the trading price of a

company's stock once a registration statement is filed disclosing

the issuer's plans to issue additional common stock.  Generally,

this market overhang effect seems more pronounced for smaller

issuers.  Committee member Dr. George Hatsopoulos submitted a

compilation of repeat (mostly non-shelf) offerings of common

stock under $50 million completed in the five-year period ending

August 9, 1994 (1401 transactions) that showed an average decline

of the issuer's stock price by six percent from the time of

filing to the time of the public offering.-[10]-  A

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[10]-    Documents for Advisory Committee Meeting, May 8,
               1995, Tab C (Letter dated May 4, 1995 from George
               N. Hatsopoulos to Commissioner Steven M.H.
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 21======

comparable analysis is reported in Table 3 above for repeat

offerings of common stock by companies with pre-offer market

capitalization (rather than offer size) of more or less than $100

million.  Among smaller issuers, net-of-market stock price

declines averaged approximately seven percent.  Among larger

issuers, there was no significant decline in stock prices on

average, indicating that the market overhang effect appears less

pronounced among the class of issuers that initially would be

eligible for the company registration pilot.

     Some or all of the decline in the market price of smaller

issuers could be due to anticipation of the dilutive effect of

the new offering.  The higher average floatation costs reported

for smaller issuers in Table 1 above are consistent with this

possibility.  The market also may view a registration statement

for possible future sales of common stock as a signal that, in

management's view, the price of the stock has peaked.  The

evidence in Table 3 above, that price declines are concentrated

among the smaller issuers, is consistent with this view, since

smaller companies generally are less closely followed by

analysts, and the investment community is generally less well

informed about managements  opinions.

     For these reasons, disclosure of an issuer's intent to issue

a significant amount of equity can be material to investors

particularly with respect to smaller companies.  Dr. Hatsopoulos,

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[10]-(...continued)
               Wallman) ("Hatsopoulos Letter").


==========================================START OF PAGE 22======

however, raised concerns that prior public notice of an issuer's

impending sale of additional common stock provides market

arbitragers with an opportunity to sell the stock short, possibly

exacerbating the anticipated price decline.-[11]-  As

stated by Dr. Hatsopoulos,

     [o]nce an offering is announced, [the arbitragers] sell
     the company's stock short with the intent to cover
     their short at the offering.  Because of fear for such
     an activity, we decided many times in the past to do
     offerings offshore and register the shares after
     completion.-[12]-

It has been reported elsewhere that short sellers tend to be

active in the shares of companies once the company files a

registration statement for a public offering of common stock,

presumably because the pendency of an added supply of common

stock reduces the likelihood that the short seller will be caught

in a squeeze.-[13]-  Ultimately, both the company and the

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[11]-    A market participant has described the phenomenon
               as  a foolproof way to make money.  The market has
               created a self-fulfilling prophesy about what will
               happen when you file: the price goes down, the
               short interest goes up, buyers go to the
               sidelines, and the deal comes at a much, much
               lower price.   Bernstein, Some New Buyers Emerge
               From Gloom, BioCentury, The Bernstein Report on
               BIOBusiness, May 6, 1995, at A3.

     -[12]-    Hatsopoulos Letter, supra n.10, at 4.

     -[13]-    It is estimated that short interest during the
               period between filing date and offer date is
               approximately three times greater than it is in
               the three months before the filing date, based on
               a sample of 474 offerings of additional common
               stock by exchange-listed issuers.  See Assem
               Safieddine and William J. Wilhelm, Jr., "An
               Empirical Investigation of Short-Selling Activity
               Prior to Seasoned Equity Offerings," December
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 23======

existing shareholders suffer as a result of adverse effects on

the market price of the company's stock, which could

significantly raise the cost of equity capital for issuers.

     It was particularly because of these issuer concerns with

potential market overhang that the Commission adopted the

unallocated shelf procedure to facilitate the use of shelf

registration for delayed offerings of common stock and

convertible securities.-[14]-  The recent upward trend in

the percentage of all underwritten offerings of common stock that

are made using the shelf registration process suggests that the

1992 introduction of the unallocated shelf procedure has met with

some success.  However, the continuing need to specify an

aggregate dollar amount of securities to be offered apparently

has perpetuated market overhang concerns.  Industry participants

advised the Committee staff that they still recommend against use

of even the unallocated shelf for common stock offerings, except

where the issuer is large enough to be less susceptible to market







---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[13]-(...continued)
               1995, Unpublished Paper, Boston College.  SEC
               rules prohibit short sales of equity securities in
               advance of public offerings, but only when the
               short sales are covered with securities sold in
               the offering.  See Exchange Act Rule 10b-21 [17
               CFR 240.10b-21].

     -[14]-    See Primary Offerings Procedures Release, supra
               n.7.


==========================================START OF PAGE 24======

overhang or where the issuer already has disclosed their

intention to raise significant equity capital.-[15]-

     Although some market participants indicated potential

interest in advance notice to the market of significant equity

offerings, the Committee concluded that simultaneous notice to

the market through the filing of a Form 8-K, as well as

disclosure of the issuer's financing activities in other reports,

should adequately serve to protect the interest of investors

without requiring issuers -- at least seasoned issuers -- to

signal their intentions months in advance.  Indeed, in many

instances under the company registration system, public notice of

a specific offering would occur earlier than required today under

shelf offerings, where transactions are disclosed in prospectus

supplements first filed with the Commission up to two business

days after their use.  In the Committee's view, the long-term

market overhang effect could be reduced, or even eliminated,

under a company registration system that does not mandate the

advance filing of a registration statement covering a specified

dollar amount of securities, while appropriate notice to the

market of an offering can be expedited through the company

registration Form 8-K filing requirement.


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[15]-    Transcript of May 8, 1995 Advisory Committee
               Meeting at 146 (describing staff discussions with
               representatives of financial executives and
               underwriters); Documents for Advisory Committee
               Meeting, July 26, 1995, Tab E (Letter dated July
               21, 1995 from Michael Holladay, General Attorney
               of AT&T, to the Committee).


==========================================START OF PAGE 25======

     There are other limitations to the current unallocated shelf

process that would be eliminated as a result of the

implementation of a company registration system.  First, a shelf

may not be used until the shelf registration statement is

declared effective by the staff, perpetuating much of the

uncertainty and delay that the shelf system was adopted to

address.  Based upon information available to the staff, as of

December 31, 1994, approximately 58% of the initial takedowns of

securities off an unallocated shelf that included common stock

occurred within 60 days of the initial filing of the Form S-3

registration statement.  Approximately 39% occurred within 40

days of the filing.  In roughly 50% of the offerings, half the

time between the filing of the registration statement and the

initial takedown occurred prior to the effective date.

     Second, the filing fee for shelf registration is non-

refundable and payable at the time of registration rather than

upon the actual takedown of securities (unlike the "pay-as-you-

go" structure of company registration).   Third, in most cases,

the issuer only may register on the shelf an aggregate dollar

amount of securities that it reasonably expects to be offered and

sold within the next twenty-four months.  Moreover, in the case

of at-the-market offerings of equity securities,-[16]- the

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[16]-    An "at-the-market" offering is an offering of
               securities into an existing trading market for
               outstanding shares of the same class at other than
               a fixed price on or through the facilities of a
               national securities exchange or to or through a
               market maker otherwise than on an exchange.
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 26======

offering must be conducted by an underwriter and the amount of

any voting stock that is registered for this purpose may not

exceed ten percent of the aggregate market value of the

registrant's outstanding voting stock held by non-affiliates.

Company registration also would create more flexibility regarding

prospectus delivery than the current shelf system.  Shelf issuers

are required to deliver a final prospectus no later than delivery

of the confirmation, and are restricted in the use of selling

materials or term sheets absent prior or simultaneous delivery of

the prospectus.  Finally, company registration would make the

streamlined offering process available in connection with

material acquisitions, whereas the current shelf registration

system generally does not.






















---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[16]-(...continued)
               Securities Act Rule 415(a)(4)(i) [17 C.F.R.
               230.415(a)(4)(i)].



==========================================START OF PAGE 27======

     B.   Indirect Costs Associated with the Current Regulatory

Scheme

          1.   Securities Act Concepts Designed to Ensure the
               Registration of Public Offers and Sales Can
               Produce Unnecessary Costs and Uncertainties and
               Reduce Flexibility in Structuring Financing
               Transactions

     Gun-jumping.  Any improper soliciting activities prior to,

or during, the registration process  (generally referred to as

"gun-jumping" or "beating the gun")-[17]- violate the

registration requirements of the Securities Act.  These

restrictions apply to both large, seasoned public companies that

have been publicly reporting for years, as well as small, non-

public companies contemplating an initial public offering.  If

the Commission staff determines that gun-jumping has occurred,

the effective date of the registration statement may be delayed

in an effort to mitigate the effects of the improper publicity on

the market.-[18]-  Although the Commission's policies in

this area are not intended to restrict the ordinary flow of

information to investors and analysts, the difficulties of

drawing clear distinctions between permitted and prohibited

market communications have led some reporting companies to limit

their ordinary course disclosures to the marketplace while


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[17]-    See generally Stanley Keller, Basic Securities Act
               Concepts Revisited, INSIGHTS, May 1995, at 5 (the
               "Keller Article").

     -[18]-    Gun-jumping also can afford purchasers a right of
               rescission under Section 12(a)(1) of the
               Securities Act.


==========================================START OF PAGE 28======

contemplating or conducting a public offering.-[19]-  Thus,

although the gun-jumping doctrine may serve to protect purchasers

in the offering by hindering circumvention of the registration

requirements, it also may chill or delay the disclosure of some

company-related information that is beneficial to the

marketplace.  The Committee questioned whether the chilling

effect of the gun-jumping doctrine serves investor protection

when the issuer is required to supply the markets with extensive

public disclosures on an ongoing basis through its Exchange Act

filings.

     Integration and General Solicitation Doctrines.  In addition

to the statutory "gun-jumping" restrictions, certain technical

distinctions and concepts have evolved to prevent issuers from

evading the protections of Securities Act registration by

publicly distributing unregistered securities through private

placements, or through affiliates acting as conduits to the

public.  Such distinctions and concepts have injected a

significant degree of legal uncertainty into the capital

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[19]-    Although not necessarily representing the current
               views of the Commission or the Commission staff,
               this cautious approach is based upon longstanding
               Commission pronouncements in this area. See
               Guidelines for the Release of Information by
               Issuers Whose Securities Are in Registration,
               Securities Act Rel. 5180 (August 6, 1971) [36 FR
               16506 (August 21, 1971)] (although companies are
               free to publish factual information while in
               registration, they must refrain from making
               "predictions, projections, forecasts, or opinions
               with respect to value").  See also Securities Rel.
               5009 (Oct. 7, 1969) [34 FR 16870] and 4697 (May
               28, 1964) [29 FR 7317].


==========================================START OF PAGE 29======

formation process, thereby generating additional costs.  The

Committee also questioned whether such distinctions are necessary

in the case of a seasoned issuer for which the same level of

information is continuously provided to the markets as would be

provided through the registration process.

     Under the federal securities laws, in certain circumstances,

separate offerings that could each independently meet the

conditions for an exemption from registration may be deemed to be

"integrated" into a single offering for which no exemption is

available.  The integration test applied by the

Commission-[20]- is intended to prevent issuers from

circumventing the registration requirements by dividing a single

plan of financing into separate offerings in order to obtain an

exemption that would not be available for the entire transaction.


There are a few safe harbors that offer some level of comfort by

assuring non-integration of certain exempt offerings separated by

at least six months from another offering.-[21]-  If an

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[20]-    The SEC applies a five-factor test to determine
               whether separate offerings are to be integrated,
               or combined into a single offering.  Integration
               may be required when:  (1) the offerings are part
               of the same financing plan; (2) the offerings are
               made for the same general purpose; (3) the same
               class of security is issued in each of the
               offerings; (4) the offerings are made at or about
               the same time; and (5) the same kind of
               consideration is to be received in each of the
               offerings.  See Non-Public Offering Exemption,
               Securities Act Rel. 4552 (November 6, 1962) [27 FR
               11316 (November 16, 1962)].

     -[21]-    See Securities Act Regulation D [17 C.F.R.
               230.502]; Securities Act Rule 147 [17 C.F.R.
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 30======

issuer is unable to comply with a safe harbor, depending on the

facts, its otherwise exempt offerings may be integrated,

resulting in a Section 5 violation.

     A private offering also may lose its exempt status if, under

the integration test, it is integrated with a registered offering

and considered a single public offering.-[22]-  A private

placement of the same security that is the subject of a

registration statement might avoid integration, however, if the

same transaction were structured differently, e.g., if the

registered security was sold off a shelf registration

statement.-[23]-  Needless to say, some of these

distinctions have been condemned as "form over substance" and as

"metaphysics."-[24]-



---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[21]-(...continued)
               230.147].

     -[22]-    A completed non-public offering under 4(2) will
               not lose its exempt status as a result of a
               subsequent registered offering of the same class
               of securities.  See Securities Act Rule 152 [17
               C.F.R. 230.152].  A 4(2) offering will be deemed
               completed when the purchasers' investment decision
               is finalized, meaning consummation of the
               transaction is no longer subject to any conditions
               within the purchaser's control.  See Black Box,
               Inc., SEC No-Action Letter [1990 Transfer Binder]
               Fed. Sec. L. Rep. (CCH)   77,256 (June 26, 1990).

     -[23]-    See Documents for Advisory Committee Meeting, May
               8, 1995, Tab H (Memorandum dated April 26, 1995
               from William J. Williams, Jr. to the Advisory
               Committee).

     -[24]-    See, e.g., Gerald S. Backman and Stephen E. Kim, A
               Cure for Securities Act Metaphysics: Integrated
               Registration, INSIGHTS, May 1995, at 18.


==========================================START OF PAGE 31======

     Companies that tend to raise capital more frequently can be

unduly burdened by the integration concept.  Companies that want

to conduct multiple exempt offerings within a compressed time

frame often are unable to wait the necessary six months to rely

on a safe harbor from integration.  Also, issuers that use

securities as consideration for multiple small acquisitions run

the risk of having those offerings integrated -- even in

situations where the acquisitions have been negotiated on a face-

to-face basis between sophisticated parties.

     A separate concern arises from the prohibition on general

solicitations in private offerings.  The general solicitation

doctrine is intended to prevent a broad-based offer of securities

without the mandated protections of the Securities Act

registration process. Therefore, public dissemination of

information regarding an anticipated or pending private offering

may be deemed to be a general solicitation, which would adversely

impact an issuer's ability to rely on a valid exemption from

registration under the Securities Act.

     However, since an unregistered distribution or placement of

a large amount of a public company's securities, particularly

common stock, can have a material effect on the issuer, and can

result in significant dilution of existing shareholders,

information about financing activities can be important to the

market and the company's existing shareholders.  The Commission

has attempted to provide some guidance to help issuers

distinguish between acceptable market disclosure and prohibited


==========================================START OF PAGE 32======

general solicitations.-[25]-  Nevertheless, news about

private placements is widely disseminated.  In fact, third

parties routinely publicize information about pending private

placements, including information that would be outside the

permitted scope of the safe harbor if attributed to the

issuer.-[26]-  Ratings are now routinely published

concerning planned private offerings.-[27]-  Thus, the

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[25]-    In 1994, the Commission enacted a safe harbor
               permitting reporting issuers to disclose publicly
               certain limited information regarding proposed
               unregistered offerings. Information that is more
               pertinent to the offering process, such as the
               underwriter's name, may not be disclosed.  See
               Securities Act Rule 135c [17 C.F.R. 230.135c], as
               adopted in Simplification of Registration and
               Reporting Requirements for Foreign Companies; Safe
               Harbors for Public Announcements of Unregistered
               Offerings and Broker-Dealer Research Reports,
               Securities Act Rel. 7053 (April 19, 1994) [59 FR
               21644 (April 26, 1994)].  In addition, the
               Commission has proposed to amend its annual and
               quarterly report forms to mandate disclosure of
               unregistered placements of common equity (and
               common equity equivalents) in an issuer's periodic
               reports. See Streamlining Disclosure Requirements
               Relating to Significant Business Acquisitions and
               Requiring Quarterly Reporting of Unregistered
               Equity Sales, Securities Act Rel. 7189 (June 27,
               1995) [60 FR 35656 (July 10, 1995)].

     -[26]-    For instance, publications such as the Private
               Placement Letter provide detailed information on a
               weekly basis regarding rumored and completed
               private placements, often naming the investment
               banking firm(s) acting as placement agent or
               underwriter and discussing ranges of pricing
               information.

     -[27]-    See Anne Schwimmer, S&P to Rate 144A Bond Deals
               Just Like Public Offerings; But Tricky Questions
               Still Remain For the Public/Private Hybrid,
               Investment Dealers' Digest, March 4, 1996, at 12,
               stating that "Standard & Poor's has begun to
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 33======

boundaries of the general solicitation doctrine are breaking down

since the very information prohibited under the doctrine is

routinely being released to both the market and potential

offerees prior to completion of the private placement.  Indeed,

the Commission recently solicited comments on the continued

viability of the prohibition against general solicitation in

private offerings.-[28]-

     The general solicitation concept has other consequences that

burden an issuer's flexibility in structuring transactions

without furnishing any counterbalancing investor protections.

For instance, the Commission staff takes the position that the

filing of a registration statement covering a specific securities

offering (as contrasted with a shelf registration), even without

offering activity, may constitute a general solicitation for that

securities offering.-[29]-  Consequently, with limited

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[27]-(...continued)
               publicly release ratings on many Rule 144A private
               placements -- hammering home the market's view
               that most of these private placements are de facto
               public bonds behind the private veneer."  Moody's
               Investors Service already rates 144A deals.

     -[28]-    Exemption for Certain California Limited Issues,
               Securities Act Rel. 7185 (June 27, 1995)[60 FR
               35638 (July 10, 1995)].

     -[29]-    See Circle Creek AquaCulture V, L.P., SEC No-
               Action Letter (March 26, 1993)("The staff also is
               unable to concur in your view that the prior
               registered offering would not constitute a
               "general solicitation" for purposes of rule 502(c)
               of Regulation D"); Letter from John J. Huber,
               Former Director of the Division of Corporation
               Finance, to Michael Bradfield, Former General
               Counsel of the Board of Governors of the Federal
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 34======

exceptions, a private offering of the same or similar security

undertaken while a non-shelf registration statement is pending or

immediately following the registered offering could be tainted by

the earlier general solicitation resulting in a Section 5

violation.  This result may occur even if the issuer decides to

abandon the public offering and withdraw the registration

statement.

      The Commission staff also has viewed the solicitation of

offerees based on the private offering exemption to be

inconsistent with a subsequent filing to register the sale of the

privately offered securities to the same investors.-[30]-

Viewed as a single transaction, the offer was made before the

filing of the registration statement and therefore constitutes

gun-jumping.  Such a scenario may arise where the issuer seeks to

"test the waters" by soliciting indications of interest in a

contemplated offering or the issuer files the registration

statement after the purchasers are committed to purchase to avoid

giving them restricted securities (rather than registering the

resale of the securities acquired by the purchasers, as in so-

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[29]-(...continued)
               Reserve System (March 23, 1984) ("The filing of a
               registration statement constitutes an offer to the
               public and thus a general solicitation of
               investors which precludes reliance on the
               exemption provided by Section 4(2)").

     -[30]-    See Summary of Capital Raising, Acquisition and
               Other Activity Involving the Division of
               Corporation Finance, THE SEC SPEAKS IN 1996, Vol.
               1, at 146 (the "Current Issues Outline"); Keller
               Article, supra n.17, at 9.


==========================================START OF PAGE 35======

called "PIPES" transactions).-[31]-  Section 5, in the view

of the staff, requires that the offer and the sale both be either

private or public.-[32]-  Otherwise, the registration of

the sale to investors solicited privately "would deprive public

purchasers from those investors of the protection of

registration."-[33]-

     It is questionable whether the validity of exemptions from

registration should depend on slight gradations in the structure

of transactions, especially where the transactions do not differ

in their economic substance.  Because in some instances there are

no bright-line tests for determining when separate offerings will

be integrated, some argue that issuers often incur considerable

expense and delay in procuring legal opinions on this point and

in structuring transactions to satisfy formulaic and formalistic

interpretations.  Consequently, the Committee concluded that the

integration and general solicitation concepts often needlessly

complicate a company's capital-raising activities.  Since in the

case of seasoned issuers, the registration process often does not

provide any additional disclosure concerning the issuer to the

markets, preservation of these concepts can only be justified by

the need to ensure the sanctity of the transactional registration


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[31]-    "PIPES" refers to "private investment, public
               equity." Keller Article, supra n.17,
     at 7.

     -[32]-    See Current Issues Outline, supra n.30.

     -[33]-    Keller Article, supra n.17, at 6.


==========================================START OF PAGE 36======

requirements.  The recommended pilot would address these issues -

- at least for those issuers initially eligible for the pilot --

by treating all offers and sales by a registered company as

registered for disclosure and liability purposes, regardless of

whether made on a public or private basis.  Once company

registration is extended to all issuers (with whatever additional

protections, if any, are needed for investors), these concerns

could be addressed directly for smaller issuers as

well.-[34]-

     Constraints on Resales - Statutory Underwriters and
Affiliates.  Although Section 4(1) of the Securities Act provides

an exemption from registration for sales of securities by persons

other than an "issuer, underwriter or dealer," under the current

system registration may be required when "restricted" securities

(securities issued in a private placement) are resold by

investors.  Furthermore, the registration requirements place

restrictions on the ability of a person who controls or is

controlled by or under common control with the company, i.e., an

"affiliate," to resell both restricted and unrestricted

securities.-[35]-  This restriction also extends to persons

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[34]-    Until such time as the company registration system
               completely replaces the current system, other
               initiatives may address certain of these issues.
               See, e.g., the proposal for "pink herring"
               registration of offers, as described in the Report
               of the Task Force on Disclosure Simplification to
               the Securities and Exchange Commission (March 5,
               1996) ("Task Force Report"), at p.31.

     -[35]-    To ensure that routine trading transactions
               between individual investors do not trigger the
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 37======

or entities that are affiliates of a company that was acquired by

the issuer in exchange for the issuer's securities.-[36]-

Consequently, this restriction may hinder a public company in

using its securities for business acquisitions.  These

constraints arise from the broad interpretation of the statutory

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[35]-(...continued)
               disclosure obligations associated with registered
               public offerings, Section 4(1) of the Securities
               Act [15 U.S.C. 77d(1)] provides an exemption from
               registration for transactions by a "person other
               than an issuer, underwriter or dealer."
               Purchasers from the issuer who sell their
               securities nevertheless may be deemed to be
               "statutory underwriters," and hence unable to rely
               on Section 4(1), if they are found to have acted
               as links in a chain of transmission of securities
               from the issuer to the public.  Section 2(11) [15
               U.S.C. 77b(11)] provides that persons who
               control, or are controlled by, or under common
               control with the issuer shall be considered "the
               issuer" for the purposes of determining who is an
               underwriter.  Thus, distributions of outstanding
               securities can trigger the application of the
               underwriter concept to require registration if the
               sale is by or on behalf of an affiliate of the
               issuer.  The statutory provision applies even
               where the affiliate acquired the shares in the
               open market or in a registered offering by the
               issuer.

     -[36]-    When an issuer offers securities in exchange for
               other securities in certain business combinations,
               or in certain asset acquisitions, the offer and
               subsequent exchange may be deemed an  offer  and
                sale  for the purposes of the Securities Act.
               Securities Act Rule 145 [17 C.F.R. 230.145].  Any
               affiliate of the acquired company who receives
               securities of the acquiror company and
               subsequently resells those securities in public
               transactions without registration may be deemed an
               underwriter of such securities unless they are
               sold in compliance with the quantity limitations
               and other restrictions of Rule 144 (except the
               holding period requirement).  Rule 145(d) [17 CFR
               230.145(d)].


==========================================START OF PAGE 38======

definition of "underwriter" set forth in Section 2(11) of the

Securities Act and are intended to protect the integrity of the

registration scheme against the risk of an issuer's indirect

distribution of securities to the investing public through

affiliates or private placement participants.  If such a

distribution is deemed to occur through the conduit of a

statutory underwriter, and the issuer is relying on a private

placement exemption, loss of the Section 4(1) exemption by a

seller may cause the issuer to lose its exemption as well.

     Despite Commission efforts in adopting and refining Rules

144 and 144A to provide guidance in this area and to limit the

restraints on resales to only those situations where necessary to

provide investor protection,-[37]- significant burdens and

uncertainties remain.  The Committee examined whether

restrictions on resales continue to make sense in today's

markets, particularly where the issuer files periodic reports

under the Exchange Act.  For these issuers, requiring separate

registration of the resales generally does not provide any

information that has not already been assimilated by the market

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[37]-    The Commission has provided detailed safe harbor
               protections under Rule 144 for resales of
               restricted securities and affiliate sales that are
               subject to various conditions, including holding
               periods, limitations on selling methods, and
               volume restrictions.  Securities Act Rule 144 [17
               CFR 230.144].  Similarly, under Rule 144A, the
               Commission has provided a safe harbor for resales
               of restricted securities to certain large
               sophisticated institutions, known as qualified
               institutional buyers, or "QIBs," subject to non-
               fungibility limitations and other requirements.
               Securities Act Rule 144A [17 CFR 230.144A].


==========================================START OF PAGE 39======

from the company's Exchange Act reports.  In such instances, the

costs of monitoring compliance with Rule 144 by control persons

and the diminished liquidity of shares held by any officer,

director or substantial shareholder deemed an affiliate, do not

appear to be justified.  In addition, the Committee viewed the

resale restrictions imposed on the affiliate of an acquired

company who receives securities in an acquisition as reducing the

incentives for the use of securities as consideration in

acquisitions.  As a consequence, both acquirors and acquirees

could incur unnecessary costs, including potentially adverse tax

consequences that may result if the parties resort to an

acquisition for cash instead.

     The burdens created by these resale restrictions do not

impact solely on the issuer and its affiliates.  Institutional

investors subject to regulatory capital requirements and

liquidity standards, as well as other fiduciaries, must monitor

and limit the amount of restricted securities in their portfolio.


They also must monitor their resales to ensure compliance with

Rule 144 and Rule 144A requirements.  The institution's

monitoring can become unduly complicated if it also holds

registered securities of the same issuer, particularly where the

securities are of the same class.  It was hard for the Committee

to justify segregation of the same securities based upon the

method of issuance, especially since the subsequent purchaser of

either the registered security or the non-registered security

would rely on the same body of publicly available information to


==========================================START OF PAGE 40======

make its investment decision, regardless of which security was

purchased.

     Company registration should eliminate the need for these

restrictions on resales.  The pilot, by eliminating most of the

incentives for issuing restricted securities in exempt offerings

and by narrowing the applicability of these resale restrictions

to a much smaller group of those who are otherwise affiliates and

underwriters, will significantly curtail the potentially

unnecessary application of resale restrictions, including in the

context of acquisitions.  In this way, the pilot company

registration system will provide a means for issuers to avoid the

costs and risks associated with complying with these legal

concepts adopted to police the transactional registration

process.

          2.   Mandatory Prospectus Disclosure Requirements Do
               Not Meet Investor Needs in the Most Efficient

               Manner

     The requirement that a prospectus be delivered to investors

in connection with an offering has traditionally been viewed as

one of the most important protections of the Securities Act.  In

practice, however, many have begun to doubt the usefulness of

delivery of a mandated disclosure document, particularly where

full information concerning the issuer is readily available

through the issuer's Exchange Act's filings.  The delivery

requirement does not appear to justify the costs in terms of the

usefulness of the information provided.  Instead of providing

information of the kind and in the amount sought by investors,


==========================================START OF PAGE 41======

issuers often provide legalistic disclosure documents that are

difficult to read, hard to understand, prepared with litigation

in mind, and delivered after the investment decision is

made.-[38]-    Although there are no explicit Commission

mandated disclosure requirements in Rule 144A placements other

than from an antifraud perspective, investor demand has resulted

in the use of 144A offering circulars oriented towards providing

useful information to the prospective purchasers prior to their

investment decision.  This experience with Rule 144A demonstrates

that meaningful disclosure will be provided even in the absence

of an express delivery requirement, and in fact, may result in

better and more meaningful disclosure delivered prior to, not

after, the investment decision is made. -[39]-

     Under the current process, after the filing of the

registration statement but before it is declared effective, the

underwriter may use the waiting period to solicit indications of

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[38]-    Transcript of May 8, 1995 Advisory Committee
               Meeting at 156 (statement of Dr. Burton Malkiel).
               See also Documents for Advisory Committee Meeting,
               September 29, 1995, Tab E (Letter dated September
               27, 1995 from The Association for Investment
               Management and Research to Commissioner Steven
               M.H. Wallman); Task Force Report, supra n.34, at
               17.

     -[39]-    Ironically, the current "all or none" requirements
               that impose disclosure and delivery obligations in
               registered offerings, but not in exempt offerings,
               has the effect of causing issuers to seek capital
               in the less regulated markets where investors have
               fewer legal remedies. Arie L. Melnik & Steven E.
               Plaut, Disclosure Costs, Regulation, and Expansion
               of the Private-Placement Market, 10 Journal of
               Accounting, Auditing, & Finance 23 (1995).


==========================================START OF PAGE 42======

interest or otherwise market the securities.  Other than the

preliminary prospectus, no written materials explaining the

offering may be distributed to investors before the registration

statement is declared effective.  Following effectiveness of the

registration statement, the final prospectus containing the

information mandated by Section 10 of the Securities Act must be

sent or given to investors before or at the time written selling

materials are sent or given, as well as before or at the time the

purchaser is sent or given the written confirmation of sale.

Because these restrictions apply only to written statements, not

oral selling efforts, the current system may actually encourage

oral solicitations over written solicitations.-[40]-  The

prospectus delivery requirements thus make it difficult to

deliver term sheets or computational material or otherwise

provide useful information in writing to investors prior to the

availability or finalization of all mandated

information.-[41]-  Moreover, in those instances where no

preliminary prospectus or selling materials are distributed, the

only prospectus that would ever be received by investors would be

the final prospectus, which is not required to be delivered until

the confirmation of sale.  In fact, if the registered securities

are listed on an exchange, the prospectus delivery requirement

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[40]-    Linda C. Quinn, Reforming the Securities Act of
               1933-A Conceptual Framework, INSIGHTS, January
               1996, at 25.

     -[41]-    See Kidder Peabody Acceptance Corp. I, SEC No-
               action Letter (available May 17, 1994).


==========================================START OF PAGE 43======

may be satisfied merely by the issuer or underwriter delivering

copies of the prospectus to the relevant exchange for the purpose

of redelivery to members of the exchange upon their

request.-[42]-

     Company registration will eliminate the often formalistic

and unnecessary burden of physically delivering a formal

prospectus and will provide issuers with the ability to decide

what information to deliver to investors in connection with the

marketing of a securities offering.  This additional flexibility

promises to provide investors with more relevant information in a

more timely manner than if across-the-board prospectus delivery

requirements continued to be imposed.-[43]-  The proposed

company registration system is crafted to achieve this goal by

requiring information to be provided to the market earlier than

under the current system, by permitting the provision of the




---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[42]-    Securities Act Rule 153 [17 C.F.R. 230.153]. In
               addition, Securities Act Rule 174 [17 C.F.R.
               230.174] exempts transactions in securities of a
               reporting company from the requirement under
               Section 4(3) of the Securities Act [15 U.S.C.
               77d] that dealers deliver a prospectus to
               subsequent secondary market purchasers of the
               registered securities for a period of time after
               the registration statement has been declared
               effective.

     -[43]-    In the words of one Advisory Committee member, "I
               am thoroughly convinced that a one-page prospectus
               would actually give investors more information and
               more protection and not less."  Transcript of May
               8, 1995 Advisory Committee Meeting at 157-158
               (statement of Dr. Burton Malkiel).


==========================================START OF PAGE 44======

information to be more flexibly structured, and by requiring the

information to be subject to statutory liabilities.


==========================================START OF PAGE 45======

III. Changes in the Markets and Offering Processes, and the
     Effect on Investor Protection

     The increasing blurring of the lines between public,
     private and offshore markets, the general shift of
     investment volume from the primary markets to the
     secondary trading markets, and the historical reform of
     the public offering process to facilitate capital
     formation have resulted in new offering and investment
     practices.  These changes have raised concerns
     regarding the effectiveness of the regulatory process
     and traditional "gatekeeping" functions.  Investor
     protection may be adversely impacted where the burdens
     of the registration process cause issuers to raise
     capital in the private and offshore markets absent the
     protections of registration.

     A.   Attractiveness of Public, Private and Offshore Markets.


 Despite significant Commission efforts over the years to

streamline the registration process, the domestic private

placement market, as well as offshore markets, remain an

important source of capital for U.S. companies.  In the

Committee's view, the ready availability of the private and

offshore markets as alternatives to the registered public markets

as sources of capital, as well as the interrelationship of these

markets, must shape the regulatory policy for public offerings if

the regulatory scheme is to meet its investor protection

purposes.

     Although difficult to quantify because public disclosure of

such information is limited, it is thought that legal and

accounting fees are not likely to be as high in transactions

effected in non-public and offshore markets as compared to non-


==========================================START OF PAGE 46======

shelf offerings made in the public market.-[44]-  Non-

registration, however, also may involve significant costs.

Historically, securities have been offered in the private

placement market at significant discounts to prevailing market

prices, representing a significant cost of raising capital for

issuers.-[45]-  One reason for this discount is that

investors in private placements (and certain other exempt

offerings and offshore offerings) often must accept a "holding"

period of illiquidity as "the price of the issuer's outflanking

the Commission's registration procedures."-[46]-  In

return, investors demand and receive a discount from the

prevailing price of the equivalent securities trading in the

public markets.  In fact, the Committee staff estimates that the

typical discount from market value seen in private placements of

common stock by NYSE, AMEX, and Nasdaq issuers is approximately

20 percent.-[47]-

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[44]-    Documents for Advisory Committee Meeting, May 8,
               1995, Tab D (Memorandum for Members of the
               Advisory Committee on the Capital Formation and
               Regulatory Processes dated April 25, 1995 from
               Edward Greene and Larry Sonsini to Commissioner
               Steven M.H. Wallman).

     -[45]-    See Documents for Advisory Committee Meeting,
               March 6, 1995, Tab F (Memorandum dated March 1,
               1995 from Professor John Coffee to the Advisory
               Committee).

     -[46]-    Id., at 2.

     -[47]-    Based on the median discount observed in 67
               private placements reported by Securities Data
               Corp. in the period January 1992 - December 1994,
               where a selling price was disclosed.  In many
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 47======

     The offshore markets also are being accessed in lieu of the

domestic public markets.  In the 1980s, the increasing

globalization of the world's securities markets, coupled with the

growth and speed of the transactions in the Euromarkets, along

with U.S. companies' increasing interest in diversifying their

shareholder base and the ease of entry into foreign capital

markets, led to a significant increase in offshore offerings of

securities by U.S. issuers.  In order to clarify the reach across

national boundaries of the registration requirements of Section 5

for companies raising capital abroad, the Commission adopted

Regulation S in 1990.  In doing so, the Commission made clear

that offers and sales of securities occurring outside the United

States are not subject to the registration requirements of

Section 5.-[48]-

     Industry participants have advised the Committee staff that

U.S. companies resort to the offshore markets for a number of

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[47]-(...continued)
               cases, however, a selling price was not disclosed.

               This discount is many times larger than
               corresponding discounts observed in public
               offerings and reported in Table 1 above, where the
               typical discount is 7.1% for IPOs and 1.2% for
               repeat offers.

     -[48]-    Regulation S provides safe harbors for primary
               offerings and resale transactions abroad that
               comply with certain conditions, including
               prohibitions on resales back into the United
               States for certain periods of time.  See
               Regulation S under the Securities Act [17 C.F.R. 
               230.901 to 230.904].  See also Problematic
               Practices Under Regulation S, Securities Act Rel.
               7190 (June 27, 1995) [60 FR 35663 (July 10, 1995)]
               (the "Regulation S Release").


==========================================START OF PAGE 48======

reasons, including the desire to avoid the Commission and state

blue sky registration requirements, or even to minimize the

potential risk of loss of exemptions available for private

placements.  Some companies also use offshore offerings in

connection with acquisitions because of the costs and other

burdens of complying with Commission and U.S. GAAP requirements

governing presentation of the acquired company's reconciled pro

forma financial statements.-[49]-

     B.   Blurring of Distinctions Between Public, Private and

Offshore Markets.

     The inability to partition markets based on their regulated

or unregulated status suggests that application of regulatory

protections should be focused on the issuer rather than any

particular transaction.  By eliminating distinctions based upon

the circumstances under which a security was originally issued,

and instead improving the disclosure publicly disseminated by the

issuer on an ongoing basis, investors in all the markets for the

issuer's securities would benefit.

     As stated by Stanley Keller at the May 8, 1995 Committee

Meeting, for all practical and economic purposes, the public and

private markets are merging.-[50]-  Any distinctions

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[49]-    See Streamlining Disclosure Requirements Relating
               to Significant Business Acquisitions and Requiring
               Quarterly Reporting of Unregistered Equity Sales,
               Securities Act Rel. 7189 (June 27, 1995) [60 FR
               35656 (July 10, 1995)].

     -[50]-    See Transcript of May 8, 1995 Advisory Committee
               Meeting at 208 (statement of Stanley Keller).


==========================================START OF PAGE 49======

between the two markets have become blurred.  The traditional

delineations between registered securities and restricted

securities have become confused through the use of strategies to

minimize the impact of the resale restrictions on privately

placed securities.  For instance, holders of securities subject

to resale restrictions, including affiliates, holders of

restricted securities issued in private placements, and offshore

purchasers in Regulation S offerings, are resorting to various

hedging techniques (including short sales and equity swaps) to

avoid or reduce the economic impact of such

restrictions.-[51]-

     In addition, under certain conditions, issuers may resort to

the use of "A/B exchange offers" to give purchasers of non-

registered securities the benefits of a freely tradeable security

without having to delay the offering by undergoing the

registration process at the original offering stage.-[52]-

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[51]-    See Managing the Managers, The Economist, February
               10, 1996, at 19.

     -[52]-    Under the current system, privately placed
               securities may be registered for resale if the
               issuer is willing to agree to pay that expense.
               Resale registration often occurs promptly after
               the closing of the private placement.  In the
               resale registration statement, resellers must be
               named as selling shareholders.  Therefore, they
               could be subjected to statutory underwriters'
               liability under circumstances where it may not be
               feasible or economical for them to make a
               reasonable investigation of the issuer's public
               disclosures.  There also is a prospectus delivery
               obligation.  Pursuant to a line of no-action
               letters, the so-called "A/B exchange offer" allows
               certain restricted securities to be converted into
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 50======

In the case of issuers who are already reporting issuers prior to

the issuance of the restricted securities, the structure of this

process seems to be an unnecessary formalism devised to ensure

technical compliance with the transactional mandates of the

Securities Act.-[53]-  Further, while difficult to defend

on a legal or economic basis, the Commission's line-drawing

prohibiting the use of the A/B exchange offer for common equity

of domestic issuers, like the non-fungibility requirement of Rule

144A, appears necessary solely to prevent the wholesale

undermining of the current registration scheme, not to protect

purchasers of the securities in the trading markets.



---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[52]-(...continued)
               freely tradeable securities through the mechanism
               of a registered exchange offer of an identical
               security without all of the holders being
               classified as underwriters.  See Exxon Capital
               Holding Corporation, SEC No-Action Letter
               (available May 13, 1988).  See also Shearman &
               Sterling, SEC No-Action Letter (available July 2,
               1993).  The A/B exchange offer procedure is
               available only for nonconvertible debt securities,
               certain types of preferred stock, and initial
               public offerings or initial listings in the U.S.
               of common stock of foreign issuers.  See Keller
               Article, supra n.17, at 6.  This procedure is not
               available for common stock of domestic issuers, or
               of foreign issuers who already are reporting
               companies, nor is it applicable to market
               professionals who continue to be considered
               statutory underwriters.

     -[53]-    At the May 8, 1995 Advisory Committee meeting, Mr.
               Keller described this process as  really like
               taking a rubber stamp and just stamping on [the
               security]  registered.    Transcript of May 8,
               1995 Advisory Committee Meeting at 208 (statement
               of Stanley Keller).


==========================================START OF PAGE 51======

     Distribution practices and pricing also reflect a

convergence in public and private markets.  What used to be

thought of as public offerings are being done privately under

Rule 144A.  Bearing close resemblance to public offerings, Rule

144A placements often are facilitated by investment banking firms

and accompanied by detailed offering circulars making extensive

disclosures regarding the offering as well as the company and its

financial condition.  In the traditional private placement arena,

the movement is towards more standardized documentation, which

minimizes the opportunities for investors to negotiate terms or

to conduct individual due diligence.-[54]-  Some investment

banks even have combined or closely aligned different practice

groups (both public and private) in order to compete for business

in a competitive marketplace.-[55]-

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[54]-    See ACIC Designs Pamphlet to Make Private Market
               User Friendly, Corporate Financing Week, February
               20, 1995, at 6.  See also Private Placement
               Process Enhancements, American College of
               Investment Counsel, Transaction Process
               Enhancement Committee (January 1995).

     -[55]-    See Kimberly Weisul, Integrating Private and
               Public Product at Merrill; 'The Lines Continuously
               Blur' Between Two Teams Sitting 30 Feet Apart on
               Merrill's Trading Floor, Investment Dealers'
               Digest, August 28, 1995, at 19.  In addition, the
               same article states that Goldman, Sachs & Co. also
               is well-noted for the close collaboration between
               its private and public teams.  See also Ronan
               Donohue, The Private Market's Creative Drive; The
               Private Placement Market Has Become So Creative
               That the Exotic is Commonplace, Investment
               Dealers' Digest, March 4, 1996, at 14 ("Donahue"),
               stating that "most investment banks have moved to
               house 144A activity under the capital markets
               umbrella with all the fervor of syndicate selling
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 52======

     Likewise, on the buy side, the line between debt issued

under Rule 144A and the public bond market also has become

thin.-[56]-  Due to the active participation of mutual

funds as both buyers and sellers of Rule 144A debt securities,

liquidity is readily available, even without subsequent

registration.-[57]-  In fact, participants in the market

have come to view the designation of a security as a "Rule 144A

security" as more of a technicality rather than as a distinction

of any economic consequence.-[58]-

     Further evidence of the blurring of the private and public

markets is provided by recent news articles discussing the

shrinking of the traditional pricing premium on debt offerings in

both the traditional private placement market and the Rule 144A




---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[55]-(...continued)
               and screen-based trading.  At Salomon,
               underwritten 144As are executed like public deals
               . . . . Merrill Lynch has practically amalgamated
               the two activities, as has Goldman Sachs."

     -[56]-    See, Donahue, supra n. 55, at 24, stating that
               "further evidence emerged during the year that the
               fine line between the 144A and the public bond
               market is becoming almost gossamer."

     -[57]-    Mutual Funds Are Key to 144A Bond Liquidity,
               Private Placement Letter, September 18, 1995, at
               12.

     -[58]-    As stated by a trader, "I bought a couple of 144As
               yesterday and, quite frankly, forgot they were
               144As. . . . The forms came across my desk to
               remind me. . . . Other than to comply with
               technical restrictions, we don't even really think
               of 144A as a category." Id.


==========================================START OF PAGE 53======

market.-[59]-  With regard to the private placement market,

"ferocious competition has driven down both spreads for investors

and fees for intermediaries."-[60]-  Likewise, as the Rule

144A market for the securities of domestic issuers has grown, the

market has become more efficient and liquid, thereby reducing the

illiquidity premium.  The liquidity provided by both registration

rights and the A/B exchange offer technique also could be

contributing to the narrowing of spreads in the Rule 144A market.


However, the regulatory burdens for equity are still significant

(with U.S. issuers of common equity generally not being able to

avail themselves of the beneficial treatment under Rule 144A or

A/B exchange offers), thereby still imposing significant costs on

issuers.



---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[59]-    See Anne Schwimmer, Should Retail Investors Buy
               Private Placements?;  "After Three Years, You Can
               Sell It to Grandma," Investment Dealers' Digest,
               August 28, 1995, at 11. See also Anne Schwimmer,
               144A Bond Market Surges with Volume and Liquidity;
               Reaches Critical Mass after Years of False Starts,
               Investment Dealers' Digest, August 21, 1995, at
               12; Rosalyn Retkwa, Private Placements Push for
               Strategic Part in Corporate Finance Picture,
               Corporate Cashflow Magazine, December 1995, at 26.

     -[60]-    Welcome to the Free-for-All; Private Placement
               Bankers Adjust to a Radically Changing
               Marketplace, Investment Dealers' Digest, August
               28, 1995, at 14.  See also Private Placements
               Becoming Cheap Alternative to Public Markets,
               Corporate Financing Week, April 17, 1995, in which
               market participants state that "[p]rivate
               placement yield spreads have tightened and fees
               have shrunk to the point where it is often cheaper
               for issuers with less than $100 million of debt to
               tap the private versus the public market."


==========================================START OF PAGE 54======

     In addition, the increasing use of the offshore markets by

U.S. issuers has raised regulatory concerns regarding the

effectiveness of rules separating the offshore and domestic

markets, particularly where the only trading market for the

security is in the United States.-[61]-  Due to the resale

restrictions on Regulation S securities, upon issuance, they are

not supposed to trade freely with any comparable securities in

the United States.  Consequently, the Regulation S securities,

particularly equity, usually are priced at a discount to the U.S.

market price.  Non-U.S. investors may attempt to capture this

spread, however, by creating short positions in the United States

with the intent to cover the position with the lower priced




---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[61]-    The legal risk of flowback of securities issued
               offshore into the domestic public markets
               increases substantially with equity offerings by
               U.S. issuers of listed securities, particularly
               where there is no market for the securities
               outside the United States.  See Edward F. Greene
               and Jennifer M. Schneck, Recent Problems Arising
               Under Regulation S, INSIGHTS, August 1994, at 2
               (the  Greene/Schneck Article ).  Any such flowback
               without a valid exemption would expose the issuer
               to Commission and private litigation based on the
               failure to register the securities.  While it is
               possible to register for resale securities
               initially offered outside the United States
               through the use of a "flowback" registration
               statement, unless the entire offshore distribution
               is registered for flowback, there would be
               practical difficulties in determining which of the
               securities were registered under the Securities
               Act given the fungibility of securities in the
               secondary markets.  See Ronald R. Adee, Flow-back
               Registration Statements, INSIGHTS, April 1988, at
               10.


==========================================START OF PAGE 55======

Regulation S securities.-[62]-  In the alternative, a non-

U.S. investor with a valid exemption from registration can sell

the Regulation S securities back into the United States upon

expiration of the Regulation S holding period, which can span as

little as 40 days.  Thus, the securities placed outside the

United States in reliance on Regulation S may be traded back into

the United States, in some cases almost immediately, with no

investor protection under the Securities Act for any subsequent

purchasers in the United States.

     Recent press reports reveal another motive for offshore

offerings.-[63]-  Despite technical compliance with

Regulation S's resale restrictions, some issuers reportedly have

used the rule to effect an indirect illegal distribution to U.S.

investors by, among other things, placing unregistered securities

temporarily offshore to evade registration

requirements.-[64]-  Similarly, holders of restricted

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[62]-    Greene/Schneck Article, supra n.61, at 6.

     -[63]-    See, e.g., Jaye Scholl, Easy Money:  How Foreign
               Investors Profit at the Expense of Americans, An
               Invitation to Scamsters?, Barron's, April 29,
               1996, at 31; Laurie Cohen, Rule Permitting
               Offshore Stock Sales Yields Deals That Spark SEC
               Concerns, Wall Street Journal, April 26, 1994, at
               C1;  Linda C. Quinn, SEC Division of Corporation
               Finance Expresses Concern, INSIGHTS, April 1994,
               at 36.

     -[64]-    As stated by the Commission in the recent release
               regarding problematic practices under Regulation
               S,

                  it has come to the Commission's attention that
some
                  market participants are conducting placements
of

(continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 56======

securities have attempted to used the resale safe harbor of

Regulation S to "wash" or remove the resale restrictions on those

securities.  The premise that the federal securities laws can be

administered on a geographical basis is being further undermined

by the ability of issuers to place offers on the Internet, which

"shows no respect for those boundaries."-[65]-  These

developments have raised concerns regarding the effectiveness of

the restrictions under Regulation S in policing the integrity of

the Securities Act registration process.

     The effects of the merging of the public, private and

offshore markets on the operation of the current Securities Act

concepts and protections are grounds for significant concern.  It

seems clear that these concepts are no longer capable of

achieving their purpose of protecting investors, and are imposing

substantial costs on issuers.  In the case of seasoned issuers,

the benefits of attempting to preserve these distinctions are


                  -[64]-(...continued)
                  securities purportedly offshore under
Regulation S
                  under circumstances that indicate that such
securities
                  are in essence being placed offshore
temporarily to
                  evade registration requirements with the result
that
                  the incidence of ownership of the securities
never
                  leaves the U.S. market, or that a substantial
portion
                  of the economic risk relating thereto is left
in or is
                  returned to the U.S. market during the
restricted
                  period, or that the transaction is such that
there was
                  no reasonable expectation that the securities
could be
                  viewed as actually coming to rest abroad.

               Regulation S Release, supra n.48, [60 FR at
35664].

     -[65]-    Michael Salz, Small Stock Issuers Find a New
               Market on the Internet, Wall Street Journal, May
               14, 1996 at 132 (quoting K. Robert Bertram,
               Pennsylvania Securities Commission).


==========================================START OF PAGE 57======

unclear, given the significant costs and reduced investor

protection that comes from them.  Rather, with regard to seasoned

issuers, the Committee concluded that investor protection would

be better served by a regulatory model that no longer attempts to

preserve any artificial distinctions among these markets.

Instead, the new regulatory model would provide for Securities

Act protections for all sales to purchasers in the United States

(regardless of whether the securities were first offered abroad),

and would extend the type of discipline and quality of disclosure

traditionally enjoyed by the primary markets to the company's

continuous reporting, for the benefit of all the markets for the

seasoned issuer's securities.

     C.   Growth of Secondary Markets and Changes in Offering
Techniques.  Due to the explosive growth of trading in the

secondary markets as compared to the primary issuance market,

today most investors look to the Exchange Act for protection,

rather than the Securities Act.  As shown in Figure 2 in the

Addendum to this Appendix A, with regard to common stock, the

U.S. capital markets have shifted -- on a relative basis -- from

a primary role as a source of capital to a venue predominantly

for secondary trading.  As shown in Figure 2, the secondary

trading markets for common equity have grown exponentially in

comparison to the primary issuance market, with over $5,500

billion in secondary trading versus $155 billion in primary

issuances in 1995.  The registered primary issuance market for


==========================================START OF PAGE 58======

common stock has remained relatively stagnant as a source of

capital since 1933.-[66]-

     From a liability perspective, this shift is significant

since the key liability provisions of the Securities Act offer

protections only to purchasers of securities in the primary

offering, not those purchasing an identical security in the

secondary markets.-[67]-  Moreover, since some believe

Exchange Act reports "tend to be taken less seriously, and to be

of lower quality," than documents prepared specifically for use

in registered offerings,-[68]- the ultimate effect on

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[66]-    Figures 1 and 2 to the Addendum to this Appendix
               A.  In addition, as shown in Figure 1, there has
               been a substitution in the primary markets of
               corporate debt for equity since 1983.

     -[67]-    Although a secondary market purchaser who
               purchases securities that were originally
               registered under the Securities Act technically
               would be able to bring a claim under Section 11 of
               the Securities Act for material misstatements or
               omissions in the registration statement, the
               statute of limitations has begun to run with the
               initial sale by the issuer and such purchaser must
               be able to trace the securities purchased in the
               secondary market back to the original registration
               statement in order to maintain the Section 11
               claim.  Also, claims under Section 12(a)(2) of the
               Securities Act for material misstatements or
               omissions in the prospectus may only be brought
               against those in privity with the purchaser or who
               otherwise engage in soliciting activities. Pinter
               v. Dahl, 486 U.S. 622 (1988).

     -[68]-    See Milton H. Cohen, The Integrated Disclosure
               System -- Unfinished Business, 40 Bus. Law. 987,
               992 (1985) ("Cohen, Unfinished Business")
               (describing general agreement that the Exchange
               Act reports are not of the same quality as the
               Securities Act documents).  Industry participants
               have informed the Committee staff that this
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 59======

investor protection is potentially far-reaching for both the

primary and secondary markets that price and function on the

basis of those reports.

     Even when investors do participate in public offerings of

securities, thereby receiving the protection of the Securities

Act, the prospectus delivery and disclosure requirements have

much less significance in the case of seasoned issuers because

the company-related mandatory disclosure is incorporated by

reference from the issuer's Exchange Act reports rather than

physically delivered directly to purchasers.  When Congress

adopted the Securities Act in 1933, it envisioned that

prospective investors would receive a single disclosure document

containing all material information necessary to make an informed

investment decision prior to making such decision.-[69]-

Integrated disclosure and shelf registration have led to an

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[68]-(...continued)
               conclusion is still valid today.  See Transcript
               of July 26, 1995 Advisory Committee Meeting at 178
               (statement of Roland Machold: "I used to write
               prospectuses myself and I can remember the first
               thing you did was throw away the 10-K and start
               from scratch.  And I think that still goes on. The
               10-K is filled out by clerks and the offering
               circular is filled out by people who have
               concerns").  See also Documents for Advisory
               Committee Meeting, September 29, 1995, Tab E
               (Letter dated August 1, 1995 from Robert S.
               Merritt, Chief Financial Officer, and Joseph J.
               Kadow, Vice President and General Counsel, Outback
               Steakhouse, Inc. to Brian T. Borders, President,
               Association of Publicly Traded Companies)(stating
               that Exchange Act disclosures could be improved).

     -[69]-    See H.R. Rep. No. 85, 73d Cong., 1st Sess., at 8
               (1933).


==========================================START OF PAGE 60======

increasing percentage of the primary issuances of securities by

seasoned companies being made through the streamlined Form S-3

process,-[70]- where less of the disclosure mandated by the

Securities Act is actually being delivered to investors.

Instead, and appropriately, greater reliance is placed on the

integrity of the Exchange Act reports to ensure a fair pricing of

securities by repeat issuers.

     Recent rule changes adopted by the Commission to facilitate

prospectus delivery in light of the movement to a three business

day standard settlement time frame ("T + 3"),-[71]- and

interpretive guidance issued by the Commission to assist issuers

in the use of electronic rather than paper delivery of documents

to investors under the federal securities laws,-[72]-

preview the rapid changes occurring in the procedures used in

securities offerings.  Already, market participants are permitted

to deliver the statutory prospectus information in more than one

document.  Also, such documents may be delivered to investors at


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[70]-    For information regarding the history of repeat
               issuances of common equity by seasoned issuers on
               Form S-3 over the last ten years, see Figure 4 in
               the Addendum to this Appendix A of the Report.

     -[71]-    See Securities Act Rule 434 [17 C.F.R. 230.434],
               as adopted in Prospectus Delivery; Securities
               Transactions Settlements, Securities Act Rel. 7168
               (May 11, 1995) [60 FR 26604 (May 17, 1995)]; Rule
               15c6-1 [17 C.F.R. 240.15c6-1].

     -[72]-    See Use of Electronic Media for Delivery Purposes,
               Securities Act Rel. 7233, Exchange Act Rel. 36345
               (October 6, 1995) [60 FR 53458 (October 13,
               1995)].


==========================================START OF PAGE 61======

separate intervals and in varying manners, including electronic

delivery.  Consequently, actual delivery of a final printed

integrated prospectus to investors prior to or with the

confirmation may soon become a relic of the past.

     As a result of these market and regulatory changes, the

traditional transactional registration process may no longer be

directly relevant to investors purchasing the securities of

seasoned issuers.  Since so much of the information deemed

necessary for an investment decision is being provided through

the public filing of Exchange Act reports with the Commission,

the Committee believed that the original goals of the Securities

Act would be better served by the adoption of new disclosure

practices and procedures that should have the beneficial effect

of focusing the participants in the capital formation process on

enhancing the quality of the disclosure in these reports.

     D.   Changes in Gatekeeper Role.  According to Milton H.

Cohen, the superiority of Securities Act disclosure is related

directly to the "in terrorem" effect of the statutory liability

provisions of the Securities Act on the issuer's directors,

underwriters, accountants, and other  gatekeepers  charged with

responsibility for the issuer's disclosure in connection with a

public offering.-[73]-  Under the traditional offering

process, ordinarily there would be ample time available before

the filing of a registration statement, and again before

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[73]-    See Cohen, Unfinished Business, supra n.68, at
               989.


==========================================START OF PAGE 62======

effectiveness of that registration statement, for these

gatekeepers to exercise their investigatory responsibilities.

The lead underwriter normally participates in the drafting of the

registration statement and undertakes significant investigation

of the company, its business and its management in connection

with an offering.  This due diligence obligation has developed

largely in response to the underwriter's exposure to liability

for false or misleading disclosures in the registration

statement.  Supporters of the current liability system point out

that it imposes policing responsibilities on those parties best

equipped to judge the accuracy and completeness of registration

disclosures.  This disincentive to carelessness created by the

liability structure ultimately benefits investors and the markets

as a whole.

     Many in the underwriting and legal communities believe that

it has become increasingly difficult for underwriters to

discharge their due diligence responsibility in the context of

the streamlined offering process afforded by integrated

disclosure and shelf registration.  According to a recent report

on due diligence by the American Bar Association's Task Force on

Due Diligence,-[74]- the informational convergence between

the Securities Act and the Exchange Act as a result of integrated


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[74]-    American Bar Association Committee on Federal
               Regulation of Securities, Report of the Task Force
               on Sellers' Due Diligence and Similar Defenses
               Under the Federal Securities Laws, 48 Bus. Law.
               1185 (May 1993).


==========================================START OF PAGE 63======

disclosure, and the severe time constraints imposed by shelf

registration, make it difficult, if not impossible, for

underwriters in a shelf takedown to perform a traditional, in-

depth due diligence analysis of the issuer, especially since the

bulk of the required company-related disclosure will be satisfied

through incorporation by reference.  Underwriters claim to be

hampered in their due diligence efforts because they typically do

not help prepare the issuer's Exchange Act reports.-[75]-

Thus, with respect to seasoned issuers using the shelf process,

the current system may be suffering from an erosion of the

underwriter's traditional performance of due diligence, one of

the key safeguards against fraud under the Securities Act

liability paradigm.

     With the increasing use of the shelf process to conduct

offerings of equity securities, the difficulties highlighted in

the ABA Due Diligence Report may become further exacerbated.

This trend is evidenced by recent reports of large takedowns of

common equity off a universal shelf being directly placed in what

are essentially block trades, as contrasted with the usual

underwritten offering approach.-[76]-  Underwriting firms

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[75]-    Documents for Advisory Committee Meeting, November
               21, 1995, Tab E (Letter dated November 2, 1995
               from the Securities Industry Association to the
               Advisory Committee, at 5-7)(the "SIA Letter").

     -[76]-    Santoli, supra n.9 ("efforts to sell stock
               directly are another sign of Wall Street's eroding
               role as gatekeeper and disseminator of
               information, a process that gathers force with
               each new application of communications technology
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 64======

assert that the shift in the focus of disclosure to the periodic

reports filed under the Exchange Act, as well as the streamlining

of the registration process through the adoption of shelf

registration, without a commensurate change in the statutory

liability structure or the gatekeeper function, is fundamentally

unfair and should be addressed.-[77]-

     Members of the board of directors likewise may have cause

for concern under the current liability scheme.  Substantial

portions of the Securities Act disclosure requirements are now

being satisfied with information incorporated by reference from

Exchange Act periodic reports.  Board members do not tend to pay

as much attention to the preparation of information in a

company's periodic reports as they would if such information was

being prepared directly for a public offering

document.-[78]-  Nor are board members positioned to review

either the Exchange Act filings or offering documents in an

environment of frequent offerings conducted with minimal advance





---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[76]-(...continued)
               to the investment business").

     -[77]-    SIA Letter, supra n.75, at 7-10.

     -[78]-    See Transcript of May 8, 1995 Advisory Committee
               Meeting at 166 (statement of Mr. Roland M.
               Machold).  See also Joseph McLaughlin, Integrated
               Disclosure, Shelf Registration and Other Due
               Diligence Challenges in the Public Offering
               Process, PLI CONDUCTING DUE DILIGENCE 1995 (March
               14, 1995), at 2.


==========================================START OF PAGE 65======

planning and little opportunity for a due diligence

review.-[79]-

     Finally, the increased significance of the secondary markets

is cause to question the wisdom of focusing the gatekeeper

function on episodic transactions.  Indeed, a significant portion

of the reporting companies whose securities are actively traded




---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[79]-    During the February 22, 1996 Advisory Committee
               meeting, Professor Coffee gave the following
               "illustrations:"

          I had a conversation [with an outside director] on the
          board of a company that has been, for the last six
          months, making daily sales of its equity securities to
          an underwriter through universal shelf registration.

          His problem, as he said throwing up his hands, is there
          is no way in the world that we can conduct daily due
          diligence.  There is nothing in the system that tells
          us how we can do it or what we can do to comply with
          this kind of world.

          He went on to describe to me a case ... of a very major
          insurance company that has been told by its
          underwriters that it would be very attractive to it to
          be able to use the underwriter to make daily small
          sales in a manner that would not move the market.

          Again, selling equity securities through the market
          maybe three or four times a week in small quantities,
          but the board of directors and the lawyers of that
          large insurance company are very, very concerned that
          kind of process of constant sales would expose the
          directors to difficulties because there would be no way
          that they could, on a constant basis, fulfill their due
          diligence responsibilities.

     Transcript of February 22, 1996 Advisory Committee Meeting
     at 51-52.   Professor Coffee observed that one of the
     intended effects of company registration -- small, frequent
     equity offerings not planned very many days in advance --
     would present the same concerns.  Id. at 52.


==========================================START OF PAGE 66======

in the public markets never access these markets for new

capital.-[80]-  Consequently, apart from the important

discipline of the annual audit, these companies are never

subjected to the type of investigation by others contemplated by

the Securities Act.

     The company registration system, by contrast, will help

alleviate some of these concerns by permitting and encouraging

more and better due diligence by those in the position to be most

knowledgeable, without lowering liability standards.  By

providing incentives and mechanisms for increased and enhanced

ongoing oversight of a company's disclosures to the market, and

by requiring all material development disclosure, including

transactional disclosure, to be filed as part of the registration

statement at the time of the offering, investor confidence in

both the primary and secondary trading markets should be

heightened, thereby ultimately lowering a company's cost of

capital.

                    *         *         *

     The increasing inapplicability of traditional transactional

registration concepts in today's undifferentiated markets, the

growth of the secondary markets, the regulatory shift to reliance

on Exchange Act reports, as well as the persistent concerns with

the quality of that disclosure and adequacy of gatekeeper due

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[80]-    See Figure 4 in the Addendum to this Appendix A of
               the Report (only 4-6% of NYSE, AMEX and Nasdaq
               companies made underwritten offerings of
               additional common stock each year since 1985).


==========================================START OF PAGE 67======

diligence in the context of today's expedited offering process,

all point to the conclusion that the existing Securities Act

protections and processes needed to be re-examined.  Investor

protection and capital formation would be better served by a

regulatory system that operates to improve the quality and

reliability of a company's continuous disclosure while

eliminating costly transactional registration requirements and

restrictions that no longer serve to protect investors.  Improved

disclosure can be accomplished in a number of ways, including by

having senior management and the board of directors focus on and

improve the procedures under which the company's reports are

prepared, and through the adoption of measures to ensure more

timely disclosure of significant developments, as well as through

greater auditor involvement.  Measures to reorder and rationalize

the gatekeeper and monitor function to focus on the integrity of

the company's reports on an ongoing, rather than an episodic

basis, will preserve and reinforce the protections afforded by

outside oversight of a company's disclosures.


==========================================START OF PAGE 1======


                            APPENDIX B
      ESSENTIAL ELEMENTS OF THE COMPANY REGISTRATION SYSTEM



     I.   Disclosure

          A.   Disclosure and Prospectus Delivery Under the
               Company
               Registration System

               1.   Company Registration Statement

               2.   File and Go

               3.   Prospectus Delivery

          B.   Role of the Commission and Other Gatekeepers or
               Monitors

               1.   The Commission Review Process

               2.   The Underwriter

               3.   The Auditor

     II.  Company Eligibility

     III. Transactions Covered

          A.   Affiliate and Underwriter Resales

               1.   Sales of Restricted Securities

               2.   Sales by Affiliates

          B.   Exclusions

          C.   Offshore Offerings

          D.   Preservation of Transactional Exemptions

          E.   Limited Placements

     IV.  Disclosure Enhancements Under the Recommended Company
          Registration Model

          A.   Mandatory Disclosure Enhancements

               1.   Enhanced Involvement by Senior Management


==========================================START OF PAGE 2======

                    a.   Top Management Certifications

                    b.   Management Report to the Audit Committee

               2.   Improvements in the Content and Timeliness of
                    1934 Act
                    Reporting

                    a.   More Timely and Informative Reports
                         on Form 8-K

                    b.   Form 10-K Risk Disclosure

          B.   Conclusion

     V.   Liability and Due Diligence Under Company Registration

          A.   Liability Under Company Registration

               1.   Other Liability Approaches Considered

               2.   Preservation and Expansion of Statutory
                    Liability

          B.   Due Diligence Under Company Registration

               1.   Underwriters

               2.   Outside Directors

          C.   Conclusion

     Addendum to Appendix B -- Comparison of Company Registration
and Shelf Offering Systems

==========================================START OF PAGE 1======

                            APPENDIX B

      ESSENTIAL ELEMENTS OF THE COMPANY REGISTRATION SYSTEM

I.   Disclosure

     Company registration would further the traditional
     goals of the disclosure requirements under the federal
     securities laws -- to provide investors with the
     information necessary to make an informed investment
     decision and to deter fraud and overreaching.  While
     company registration would maintain and in some cases
     expand the level of information about companies and
     their offerings that currently is made available to the
     markets through Commission filings, such information
     would be required to be made public earlier than under
     the current system, thereby benefitting investors in
     both the primary issuance market and the secondary
     trading markets.  At the same time, company
     registration would afford companies offering their
     securities to the public the flexibility to tailor the
     disclosure documents delivered to investors to the
     nature of the transaction and the demands of the
     offering participants.  Company registration also would
     maintain and reinforce the roles of outside gatekeepers
     and monitors and their due diligence functions in
     fostering the reliability of that information to meet
     the realities of today's markets.

     The primary goals of disclosure under the federal securities

laws are to provide investors and the marketplace with

information necessary to make informed investment decisions, and

to deter fraud.  Capital allocation decisions are best made on

the basis of well-informed private decision-making by market

participants.  In an oft-quoted passage, Justice William Douglas,

who once served as Commission Chairman, stated:

     The truth about the securities having been told, the
     matter is left to the investor. . . . The requirement
     that the truth of the securities be told will in and of


==========================================START OF PAGE 2======
     itself prevent some fraudulent transactions which
     cannot stand the scrutiny of publicity.-[1]-

     Full and fair disclosure is the key to an efficient capital

allocation process.  Under the current regulatory scheme for

public offerings, disclosure of information material to

investment and voting decisions is effectuated in two principal

ways.  First, information is made public through the filing of a

disclosure document with the Commission.  This information then

is available to investors, either directly by investors accessing

the information themselves, or indirectly through intermediaries

such as investment advisers, research analysts, and other

investment professionals who analyze and redistribute that

information to the investing public.  The requirement under the

Securities Act that a registration statement be on file with the

Commission before the offering process commences is an example of

this form of disclosure.  This method of information

dissemination is also the principal means by which the trading

markets are provided with current information about issuers.  The

annual report on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q and

current reports on Form 8-K are examples of this method of

disclosure.

     Second, information is disseminated directly to investors by

the issuer of the securities.  The Securities Act requirement to

deliver a prospectus to an investor no later than the time the


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[1]-     William O. Douglas, Protecting the Investor, 23
               Yale L. Rev. 521, 523-24 (1934).


==========================================START OF PAGE 3======
confirmation of the sale is sent falls into this category, as do

the requirements for delivery of a proxy statement and annual

report to shareholders in connection with an election of

directors, or an offer to purchase in connection with a tender

offer.  Prospectuses that are filed publicly with the Commission

likewise serve to inform the trading markets.

     Experience has demonstrated that actual delivery of

information to investors -- as opposed to delivery of such

information to the markets through a Commission filing --

frequently is not necessary to convey information and deter

fraud.  Public disclosure of information concerning the issuer

through Exchange Act filings, and its consequent ready

availability, serve as an efficient means to facilitate informed

assessments of the issuer's business prospects and financial

condition and the security being offered.  Public disclosure also

serves to deter many of the more unsavory practices witnessed

before the adoption of the Securities Act, such as self dealing

by insiders and underwriters.  Finally, the public availability

of information also can serve to counteract overzealous selling

efforts.

     Milton Cohen, in his seminal article "Truth in Securities

Revisited," established a blueprint for rationalizing the two

securities acts with respect to prospectus delivery:

     This is, indeed, an area for pragmatic and not merely
     logical answers, and I believe that the best approach
     in a coordinated law will be to introduce a greater
     degree of pragmatism -- primarily in distinguishing
     continuous registrants from others but also in


==========================================START OF PAGE 4======
     distinguishing among different types of transactions. .
     . .

     First, a prospectus of a continuous registrant should not be
     required to contain information that is of no different
     significance or greater materiality to an offeree in a
     distribution than to any other investor or potential
     investor in securities of the same issuer.  Second, a
     prospectus that is not required to be delivered in time to
     affect investment decisions should not be required at all,
     unless serving a purpose not adequately served by public
     filing alone . . . .-[2]-

     The Wheat Report, published in 1969, also reflected a

recognition that the traditional prospectus delivery requirements

mandated under the Securities Act may not be the most efficient

means to disseminate information relevant to an investment

decision.  First, the unsophisticated investor may not be able to

understand and make use of the information contained in the

prospectus without the benefit of a market

intermediary.-[3]-  Second, in any event, because the use of

a preliminary prospectus is not mandated, investors often do not

receive prospectus information until delivery of the

confirmation.  In addition, requiring an issuer that was subject

to the continual reporting requirements of the Exchange Act to

put information regarding the company, as contrasted with the

specific offering, in the prospectus was recognized as


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[2]-     Milton H. Cohen, "Truth in Securities" Revisited,
               79 Harv. L. Rev. 1340, 1386 (1966).

     -[3]-     See Disclosure to Investors, A Reappraisal of
               Administrative Policies Under the 1933 and 1934
               Acts, Report and Recommendations to the SEC from
               the Disclosure Policy Study, at 53 (March 27,
               1969) (the "Wheat Report").


==========================================START OF PAGE 5======
duplicative and unnecessary, at least in those instances where

the issuer was widely followed by the analyst community.

     Based upon the conclusions of the Wheat Report, as well as

the recommendations of the Commission's Advisory Committee on

Corporate Disclosure published in 1977,-[4]- the Commission

moved to integration of the disclosure requirements of the

Securities Act and the Exchange Act.  Under the integrated

disclosure scheme implemented in 1982, seasoned issuers can avoid

providing prospectus disclosure duplicative of company

information that already has been provided in its Exchange Act

reports through incorporation by reference of that information

into the prospectus.  Under this approach, critical company-

specific information required under the prospectus disclosure

provisions of the Securities Act is made available to investors

through the public filing of a company's periodic reports, but is

not required to be repeated in the prospectus delivered to

purchasers in the offering.  Instead, the short-form prospectus

physically delivered must provide information specific to the

transaction, but generally can refer the investor to the filed

reports for information regarding the seasoned company's

business, management, financial condition and similar matters.




---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[4]-     Wheat Report, supra n.3; Report of the Advisory
               Committee on Corporate Disclosure to the
               Securities and Exchange Commission, 95th Cong.,
               1st Sess. (Comm. Print 1977 ) (the "1977 Advisory
               Committee Report").


==========================================START OF PAGE 6======
     Thus, for more than a decade, with respect to the core

financial and operating information regarding seasoned issuers,

the Commission has deemed the prospectus disclosure objectives of

the Securities Act to be satisfied by reliance on the public

filing of this information and its incorporation by reference

into an offering document, without any physical delivery of such

information to investors.  In addition, and as discussed more

fully below, technological innovations are facilitating

inexpensive electronic access to filed documents by the market

and by investors and their intermediaries, thereby raising

further questions regarding the continued need for delivery of

disclosure documents directly to investors in the context of

public offerings.


==========================================START OF PAGE 7======
     A.   Disclosure and Prospectus Delivery Under the Company

Registration System

     Company registration would improve upon the crucial
     disclosure goals of the current filing and prospectus
     delivery requirements by requiring that mandated
     disclosure be made public, or delivered to investors,
     at an earlier point in time than under the current
     system.  So long as all mandated information already
     has been publicly disclosed, company registration would
     create greater flexibility regarding the prospectus
     information to be delivered directly to investors.
     Such information would be provided based upon the
     issuer's and underwriter's assessment of the
     informational demands of the markets and participants
     in the offering.-[5]-

          1.   Company Registration Statement

     Under the company registration scheme, to become company-

registered, an eligible company would file a Form C-1

registration statement disclosing its plans to sell securities

from time to time in the indefinite future on a company-

registered basis.  The Form C-1 would be kept current by

incorporating all existing and future Exchange Act reports into

the Form C-1.  The Form C-1 would contain a generic description

of the type of securities the issuer anticipated issuing, as well

as a general discussion of its financing plans.  In essence, the

registration statement would not be a single document, but rather

a composite of the initial Form C-1, all existing and

subsequently filed Exchange Act reports incorporated into that

registration statement, as well as any post-effective amendments


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[5]-     A comparison of the proposed company registration
               system and the current short-form shelf
               registration system is included in an addendum to
               this Appendix B.


==========================================START OF PAGE 8======
thereto.  Only a nominal registration fee would be required to be

paid at the time of the Form C-1's filing, accompanied by an

undertaking by the issuer to pay a fee upon each sale of

securities under the Form C-1.   This approach would create a

"pay-as-you-go" system.

     Once a company is registered, no further registration

process would be necessary to offer securities.  To accomplish

that result during the pilot under the current statutory scheme,

the Form C-1 would serve as a registration statement for purposes

of Section 5 of the Securities Act and register generically all

types of securities and offerings (including affiliate resales)

contemplated at the time of the company's registration.  The

issuer is given discretion to the extent it wishes to include all

or just some of its securities on the Form C-1, depending on the

degree of participation.  Even under full participation in the

system, a registered company may exclude non-convertible debt

sold only to institutional buyers -- but not equity securities

(including equity convertibles) or debt sold to retail buyers --

from the system.  With respect to those companies electing to

take full advantage of the system,-[6]- all subsequent sales

of securities by registered companies and their affiliates would

be deemed covered by the Form C-1 registration statement, and

thus would be registered for purposes of the Securities Act.  If

the company had outstanding restricted securities at the time it


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[6]-     See infra p. 34-40.


==========================================START OF PAGE 9======
became company-registered, the company could effect a transition

to the company registration system by specifically registering

any or all of its outstanding restricted securities for resale on

the Form C-1 (and paying a fee at that time), or merely allow the

restricted securities to retain their restricted status until the

expiration of the Rule 144 restricted periods.-[7]-

     All purchasers of securities from the issuer or its

affiliates, therefore, regardless of the nature of the

transaction, would receive freely tradeable securities, as well

as the benefit of all statutory remedies that now attach to

information disseminated in connection with a registered offering

of securities.  Thus, investor protection would be preserved and

extended to a broader class of transactions, while regulatory

concepts that are no longer necessary under a company

registration system to protect investors -- such as gun-jumping

and restricted securities -- would be eliminated.

          2. File and Go

     Under the company registration system, a registered company

could go to market in most transactions without encountering

regulatory delays.  Sales would be permitted immediately upon, or

shortly following, the public filing of mandated disclosure

regarding the transaction and any recent material developments


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[7]-     In the case of privately placed debt securities,
               the issuer also would have to execute a qualified
               indenture at the time it registers its outstanding
               debt to satisfy the requirements of the Trust
               Indenture Act, absent an exemption.


==========================================START OF PAGE 10======
concerning the company not previously disclosed in filings, along

with the payment of the fee.

     As noted previously, the Committee considered, but

determined not to review specific line-item disclosure

requirements applicable to public offerings in connection with

its development of a company registration scheme.  Accordingly,

the transactional information that must be on file at the time of

an offering would be essentially the same as that required

today.-[8]-  Transactional information would be required to

be filed at the time of the offering to provide notice of the

transaction, pay the fee and provide other information material

to the transaction to the extent the information was not

previously disclosed in the Form C-1 (including in any post-

effective amendments to, or Exchange Act reports incorporated


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[8]-     Thus, for example, in financings, in addition to
               updating its company-related disclosure (to the
               extent necessary), the issuer would need to have
               on file with the Commission at the time of an
               offering the transactional information required by
               the following disclosure items under Regulation S-
               K, to the extent applicable:

     Item 202: Description of the Securities
     Item 503: Summary Information, Risk Factors and Ratio of
               Earnings to Fixed Charges
     Item 504: Use of Proceeds
     Item 505:      Determination of Offering Price
     Item 506: Dilution
     Item 507: Selling security holders
     Item 508: Plan of distribution
     Item 509:      Interests of Named Experts and Counsel

     Similarly, in the case of business combinations, the
     information called for by current Form S-4 would be filed
     with the Commission.


==========================================START OF PAGE 11======
into, the Form C-1).  As an example, the Form C-1 could describe

the plan of distribution or possible alternative plans of

distribution, and the filing at the time of the transaction need

only disclose which offering technique is being employed.

Similarly, use of proceeds could be generically disclosed in the

Form C-1 and updated as necessary at the time of the transaction.


Summary financial information and pro forma data would only be

required where not previously disclosed and where material to

investors.

     In the case of offerings under the company registration

system of equity securities over a de minimis threshold (e.g.,

three percent), the transactional information (which would be, at

a minimum, the fact that the transaction is occurring) would be

required to be filed with the Commission on a Form 8-K no later

than at the time of the transaction.  The Committee also

recommends that this Form 8-K filing requirement be applied to

takedowns off the shelf under the current system.  The purposes

of this filing, which is not required today for short-form shelf

offerings, is to ensure that this information is disclosed to the

market at the time of the offering, to ensure that it is

incorporated into the registration statement (and thus within the

coverage of Section 11 liability),-[9]- and to provide a

document prepared at the time of the offering that will

facilitate the due diligence inquiries of underwriters and other


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[9]-     See infra pp. 63-64.



==========================================START OF PAGE 12======
gatekeepers or monitors.  The Commission may wish to consider

devising some minimal integration period for measuring offerings

against the de minimis threshold (e.g., two or three business

days) to provide clarity as to the filing

requirement.-[10]-  Separately, if the issuer's filings

need to be updated with material company developments (except in

a "limited placement, see Section III.E below), the issuer must

disclose those developments in a Form 8-K filed in advance of the

transaction.  That filing also could serve as the transactional

Form 8-K filing if the appropriate information is included.  If

this material updating information is to be provided to investors

solely by incorporating it by reference into the prospectus (see

next section below), then it will have to be on file a sufficient

amount of time for the market to have absorbed the information

before a sale is made.

     In de minimis equity offerings and in all debt offerings

covered by the Form C-1 (see supra p. 5-6), the issuer would have

a choice with respect to the appropriate means to effect the

filing of the requisite transactional and material developments

disclosure.  It could include that information in a Form 8-K, as

described above; alternatively, the company could include all of

the required disclosure in the prospectus supplement that is


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[10]-    This prompt filing requirement at the time of sale
               may require the Commission to make accommodations
               to accept Form 8-K filings with respect to
               transactions taking place outside of normal
               business hours.


==========================================START OF PAGE 13======
delivered to investors, and simultaneously filed with the

Commission.  Consequently, in these de minimis equity offerings

and debt offerings, the company registration model was made

consistent with current practice under shelf registration in that

the prospectus supplement would not be subject to Section 11

liability, because it is not deemed part of the registration

statement,-[11]- except that company registration would

require the prospectus supplement to be filed with the Commission

at an earlier point in time than under the current

system.-[12]-

     As noted, the transactional filing at the time of the

offering could disclose any material changes in the registrant's

affairs that have occurred since the latest filing (which could

be a Form 8-K filed shortly before the offering) updating the

company registration statement.  Where necessary to avoid

misleading investors, for example, this information would include

an update of the company's MD&A disclosure.  Where the updating

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[11]-    See infra p. 63-64.

     -[12]-    Under current Rule 424(b)(2) [17 C.F.R.
               230.424(b)(2)], a prospectus supplement prepared
               in connection with a shelf offering must be filed
               no later than the second business day following
               the earlier of the determination of the offering
               price or its first use.  Thus, under the current
               system, the information in the prospectus
               supplement may not be disclosed to the secondary
               trading markets for as many as two days after its
               dissemination to investors in the offering.
               Company registration would accelerate the required
               filing of the prospectus supplement by at least
               two days since the prospectus supplement would be
               required to be filed simultaneously with its use.


==========================================START OF PAGE 14======
information represents a fundamental change in the information

previously disclosed regarding the issuer in Commission filings,

consistent with current requirements for shelf

offerings,-[13]- that information must be provided either

by means of a post-effective amendment or an Exchange Act report

filed in lieu thereof.  A prospectus supplement would not suffice

for this purpose.

     Thus, the company registration system not only would

maintain the level of information currently required to be

disclosed in Commission filings concerning a particular

transaction, but also would reinforce the existing obligation of

a company offering securities to the market to ensure that its

public disclosures are current and complete in every material

respect,-[14]- and would accelerate the public disclosure

of such information to investors in both the primary and

secondary markets.

          3.   Prospectus Delivery

     The company registration system also would address the need

to disseminate a statutory prospectus to participants in an

offering.  A principal goal of the Committee has been to recast

the prospectus from what in many cases is its current function --

a document prepared to comply with regulatory requirements and to


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[13]-    See, e.g., Item 512(a)(1)(ii) of Regulation S-K
               [17 C.F.R.  229.512(a)(1)(ii)].

     -[14]-    See Shaw v. Digital Equipment Corp., 82 F.3d 1194
               (1st Cir. 1996).


==========================================START OF PAGE 15======
provide the issuer with a defense in the event of litigation,

which often is not sent to investors until after the investment

decision is made -- into a tool to convey meaningful information

at the time of the investment decision.

     The system would continue to require transactional

information to be physically delivered as part of the prospectus

in those circumstances where it may be argued that delivery of

that information might serve to facilitate an investor's

evaluation of the issuer and the security.  For example, if the

company is issuing a new security, the company registration

system would require that the terms of the new security, along

with the specific risks of investing in the security, be

delivered to potential investors.  However, the company

registration system also would provide the flexibility for

issuers to file the information with the Commission without

physical delivery to investors, where delivery is not necessary

for that purpose and such information already has been disclosed

to the markets through a public filing with the Commission.

     More significantly, company registration would allow for the

use of a meaningful summary prospectus, the content of which

would be dictated primarily by the informational demands of

investors, rather than by regulatory mandates and litigation

concerns.-[15]-  Since in almost all but the smallest

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[15]-    The AIMR suggested that the Committee recommend
               that every offering of securities be accompanied
               by an offering circular that would include the key
               terms of the offering, but "no boilerplate or
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 16======
equity offerings the company would be required to file with the

Commission all mandated transactional and updating disclosure

prior to any sales of securities, thereby enhancing investor

protection through the earlier disclosure of this information to

the markets than under the current system, issuers would be

granted the flexibility and the responsibility to decide what

information should physically be delivered to investors.  The

Committee expects that the disclosure contained in the prospectus

delivered to investors, whether this prospectus is a document

that resembles a traditional prospectus, selling materials, or

the confirmation of sale, will be that information the issuer

deems most relevant and material to the potential investors.

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[15]-(...continued)
               legalese."  See Documents for Advisory Committee
               Meeting, September 29, 1995, Tab E (Letter dated
               September 27, 1995 from the AIMR to Commissioner
               Wallman, at 3).  Though not mandated, the
               Committee anticipates that the elimination of the
               prospectus delivery requirement in routine
               transactions will promote the use of such short-
               form offering documents.  See also John C. Coffee,
               Jr., Re-Engineering Corporate Disclosure:  The
               Coming Debate Over Company Registration, 52 Wash.
               & Lee L. Rev. 1143, 1159 (1995) ("Coffee, Re-
               engineering Disclosure"), discussing the impact of
               shelf registration on the disclosure in
               prospectuses:

          Of course, the prospectus largely deteriorated
          into a legal fiction as a result of [the
          transition to shelf registration].  Only the one
          or two page summary table at the front of the
          typical Form S-3 registration statement is today
          coherent to the average investor.  Shelf
          registration and incorporation by reference really
          implied that disclosure to the market through
          [Exchange Act] filings replaced disclosure to
          individual investors through prospectuses.


==========================================START OF PAGE 17======
Since all mandated disclosure must either be filed with the

Commission or delivered to investors at or prior to any sale of

securities (and must be filed no later than any sale in a non-de

minimis equity offering), the market and all investors will

receive the information at the same time, or at an earlier point

in time than under the current system.  In addition, the issuer

and other offering participants will have the same, or greater,

liability for such information, as under the current system.  The

fact that all the mandated information is publicly available

allows the issuer to include only the  information most useful to

an investor's understanding in the document physically delivered

to investors, presented in a plain-English format that is readily

accessible and understandable by the investor.

     The desired flexibility regarding prospectus delivery would

be achieved under the pilot in a manner consistent with current

prospectus delivery requirements of the Securities Act.  Under

company registration, issuers would be permitted to use

incorporation by reference in a manner similar to that now

available to seasoned companies to omit core, company-specific

information from the prospectus delivered to investors.  Subject

to certain exceptions, a registered company could, but need not,

use incorporation by reference to meet its prospectus delivery

obligation with respect to the mandated transactional information

as well.  It can do so by incorporating, rather than physically

delivering, all or portions of that information from any filed

document such as a Form 8-K (whether mandated or filed solely for


==========================================START OF PAGE 18======
this purpose).  This incorporation by reference could be into a

document serving as the prospectus that is delivered at the time

of confirmation of sale.  Just as they currently have with

respect to material company information, these issuers thus would

have the flexibility to include all, some, or even none of the

transactional information in the prospectus delivered to

investors.

     In "routine transactions," the confirmation of sale itself

could serve as the prospectus, so long as it expressly

incorporates the necessary information on file with the

Commission.  Broker-dealer firms would satisfy their prospectus

delivery obligations with respect to the distributed securities

and aftermarket transactions in the same fashion.-[16]-

     This flexibility in the informational content of the

prospectus to be delivered represents a further extension of

current law.  Since the adoption of incorporation by reference,

the Commission has allowed company-related disclosure (which

comprises a large portion of the mandated disclosure in a public

offering) to be incorporated, rather than repeated in full, in

the prospectus without any apparent loss of investor protection.

Permitting transactional information in some instances also to be

incorporated by reference amounts to a further incremental step.

Just as issuers today often include a "recent developments"

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[16]-    See Section 4(3) of the Securities Act [15 U.S.C.
               77(e)(3)]; Rules 174 and 434 under the Securities
               Act [15 C.F.R. 230.174 and 230.434]; Rule 15c2-8
               under the Exchange Act [17 C.F.R. 240.15c2-8].


==========================================START OF PAGE 19======
section in shelf takedown prospectuses, the Committee anticipates

that issuers will continue to use their judgment in including any

transactional information in the prospectus to the extent that

public filing alone of such information might not afford adequate

notice to a potential investor.

     The Committee believes that delivery of a prospectus as a

marketing device in equity offerings likely would remain the

common practice under the company registration system.  Use of

the prospectus would continue to depend on factors such as the

nature and name recognition of the issuer, the size of the

offering relative to the issuer's public float, the retail or

institutional nature of the targeted investors, the price

expectations of the issuer relative to the current market value

and whether or not the public filing of the disclosure is

effective dissemination to the potential investors.  Because

market forces reasonably can be relied upon to ensure the

delivery of the appropriate level of information (at least in the

case of seasoned issuers), a substantial argument could be made

that there is no need to mandate prospectus delivery in any

instance.-[17]-


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[17]-    In other jurisdictions such as Australia that have
               eliminated mandated specified line item disclosure
               requirements in favor of a general materiality
               standard, often prospectuses continue to contain
               most, if not all, of the same disclosure as when
               specific disclosure requirements were mandated.
               See Documents for Advisory Committee Meeting, June
               15, 1995, Tab F (Study of Foreign Regulatory
               Processes).


==========================================START OF PAGE 20======
     The Committee nevertheless concluded that physical delivery

of a formal prospectus containing the transactional information

should be required in certain circumstances.  For the purposes of

the pilot, the issuer will be required to deliver (rather than

incorporate) the transactional information as part of the

prospectus in the case of substantial offerings of equity

securities (i.e., "non-routine" transactions).  Those offerings,

because of their size, are likely to alter substantially the

information previously provided to the market and to involve

significant oral and written selling efforts.-[18]-

Accordingly, during the pilot, traditional prospectus delivery

would be retained for offerings of voting securities in an amount

in excess of (or potentially representing in excess of, in the

case of warrants and convertible securities) 20 percent of the

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[18]-    The Committee considered a suggestion that the
               prospectus delivery requirement be imposed
               whenever "special selling efforts" were employed
               in the marketing of the offering.  See Documents
               for Advisory Committee Meeting, July 26, 1995, Tab
               E (Letter dated June 27, 1995 from Richard
               Phillips to Commissioner Wallman). Special selling
               efforts could be evidenced by brokers'
               compensation beyond ordinary commissions and fees,
               as well as the distribution of selling materials.
               Although various members of the Committee agreed
               that heightened disclosure and liability should
               accompany special selling efforts (see Transcript
               of July 26, 1995 Advisory Committee Meeting at
               256-57, 260), the Committee was concerned that the
               use of these concepts to identify transactions
               that require prospectus delivery would perpetuate
               existing confusion engendered by the use of that
               concept in other contexts under the federal
               securities laws, and that a simpler approach of
               the type recommended could satisfy the perceived
               needs to the same extent.  Id. at 260-264.


==========================================START OF PAGE 21======
current market value of the issuer's voting securities held by

non-affiliates.  As today under shelf registration, the

prospectus normally would be filed with, but would not be subject

to prior review by, the Commission.-[19]-

     After reviewing data on the distribution of recent public

offerings of equity as a percentage of an issuer's outstanding

capital, the Committee chose 20 percent as the minimum delivery

threshold.-[20]-  In setting this threshold, the Committee

sought to provide registered companies with flexibility to

conduct a transaction (or series of transactions) that increase a

company's public float by an amount that could be sold into the

market without use of a formal prospectus -- for example, through

regular trading transactions or placements of blocks -- without

preparing a traditional prospectus.  In these latter "routine"

transactions, investors least expect the information

traditionally provided in a prospectus to make an investment

decision.-[21]-  Rather, absent unique circumstances

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[19]-    The one exception would be extraordinary
               transactions in equity securities, exceeding 40
               percent of the issuer's existing capital base,
               which would require the filing of a post-effective
               amendment to the company registration statement
               and would be subject to staff review.

     -[20]-    See Documents for Advisory Committee Meeting,
               November 21, 1995, Tab D.

     -[21]-    See Coffee, Re-engineering Disclosure, supra n.15,
               at 1145 (stating Milton Cohen's view that
               "[b]ecause the [Exchange] Act creates a system of
               continuous, periodic disclosure, the existence of
               this system profoundly reduces the need for
               transaction-specific disclosure at the time when
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 22======
regarding the transaction, investors will tend to focus on the

company-related disclosure already disseminated to the market and

reflected in the company's stock price.  In other words,

consistent with the guideline articulated by Milton Cohen, the

appropriate delivery threshold would allow those transactions

that today involve delivery of a prospectus only at the time of

the confirmation, and not as part of the marketing process, to

proceed without any formal delivery of a prospectus.-[22]-

Conversely, where transactional disclosure is required to be

delivered in a prospectus, the Committee feels strongly that it

should be delivered to investors in sufficient time to influence

and inform their investment decision.  The Committee therefore

determined that any prospectus required to be delivered in these

substantial equity offerings should be delivered prior to the

time the investor determines to purchase.-[23]-

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[21]-(...continued)
               an issuer later seeks to sell its securities.
               Logically, a corporate issuer seeking to sell
               securities under a continuous disclosure system
               would only be required to disclose any additional
               material information that it had not previously
               disclosed pursuant to the continuous disclosure
               system.")

     -[22]-    Cohen, supra n.2, at 1386; see also Linda C.
               Quinn, Reforming the Securities Act of 1933 - A
               Conceptual Framework, INSIGHTS at 25 (January
               1996) (the "Quinn Speech").

     -[23]-    Cf. Rule 15c2-8 under the Exchange Act [17 C.F.R.
               240.15c2-8] (prospectus required to be delivered
               48 hours prior to sending the confirmation of sale
               in IPOs which may still be after the investor
               agrees to the sale).  The Committee recognizes
               that the prospectus delivered at the time of sale
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 23======
     Because of the Committee's belief that it should be

investors' informational needs that dictate the need for a

prospectus as a selling document and the content of that

prospectus,-[24]- and that the elimination of regulatory

mandates with respect to seasoned issuers would not result in

less useful information being provided to investors, the

Committee was comfortable in establishing a generous threshold in

order to preserve maximum issuer flexibility.-[25]-

Nevertheless, the determination of the appropriate threshold is

best made with the benefit of the comment process that

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[23]-(...continued)
               in these non-routine transactions will resemble
               preliminary prospectuses (i.e., "red herring") in
               that price-related and other current information
               normally would have to be omitted and provided on
               a supplemental basis. That information would
               otherwise be available, in any event, through the
               filing of the transactional Form 8-K at the time
               of sale.

     -[24]-    The Committee has been informed on an anecdotal
               basis that disclosure documents in Rule 144A
               placements closely resemble prospectuses in
               registered offerings, even though there are no
               Commission-specified disclosure requirements in a
               Rule 144A placement other than under a general
               antifraud standard.

     -[25]-    Based upon data reflecting market capitalization,
               rather than public float, approximately 68 percent
               of underwritten repeat offerings of common stock
               in 1992-1994 would fall below the 20 percent
               recommended threshold for mandatory prospectus
               delivery.  Thus, prospectus delivery would not
               have been required in over two-thirds of such
               offerings.  If the threshold were lowered to 10
               percent, prospectus delivery would have been
               eliminated for only 30 percent of such
               transactions. See Figure 6 in the Addendum to
               Appendix A of the Report.


==========================================START OF PAGE 24======
accompanies Commission rulemaking proceedings, and could be

significantly lower or greater than 20 percent-[26]- and

involve factors other than a percentage of the public

float.-[27]-  Indeed, this threshold could be increased and

combined with the extraordinary transaction tier with resulting

simplification of the system.  While not formally recommended for

the pilot, the Commission may wish to consider whether similar

thresholds should be developed for offerings of senior non-voting

equity securities as well as non-investment grade debt.

     Where required to deliver a prospectus, the issuer still

would be permitted to take advantage of incorporation by

reference of company information to the same extent as permitted

today, and still would be allowed to include any additional

information it deems material in the prospectus.  Similarly,

delivery of the statutory prospectus could be accomplished in the

same manner as permitted today, provided the prospectus was





---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[26]-    In France, Germany and the United Kingdom, no
               prospectus is required if the offering is for less
               than 10 percent of an existing class listed on an
               exchange and certain other conditions are met.
               See Documents for Advisory Committee Meeting, June
               15, 1995, Tab F (Study of Foreign Regulatory
               Processes).

     -[27]-    See, e.g., Exchange Act Rel. 37094 (April 11,
               1996) [61 FR 17108 (April 18, 1996)] (proposing
               use of Average Daily Trading Volume as basis for
               applicability of proposed Regulation M).  See also
               NYSE Listed Company Manual, 312(c)(i) (July
               1989).


==========================================START OF PAGE 25======
received in time to influence the investment

decision.-[28]-  Thus, in these circumstances, the

prospectus would be expected to contain, at a minimum, the same

level of information found in a prospectus used today by a

seasoned issuer in an offering conducted on Form S-3.  Other

circumstances in which physical delivery of transactional

information, rather than incorporation by reference, would be

necessary, include:

          Information Necessary To Avoid Misleading Investors
          Just as, and to the same extent as, under the current
          shelf system, reliance on incorporation by reference
          into the prospectus or selling materials would not be
          appropriate where statements appearing in the
          physically delivered materials would be rendered
          misleading by the absence of information appearing only
          in filed documents.-[29]-  Similarly,
          incorporation by reference of material developments
          that have not been disclosed sufficiently in advance of
          the use of the prospectus to allow the market to access
          and absorb the information would not be appropriate.

          Use of Selling Materials  Under the current system, to
          the extent written selling materials that do not
          satisfy prospectus disclosure requirements are
          distributed to investors in the course of the offering,
          a prospectus containing the mandated information has to
          be delivered prior to or simultaneous with the
          materials.-[30]-  Under company registration, an

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[28]-    See, e.g., Rules 430A and 434 under the Securities
               Act [17 C.F.R. 230.430A and 230.434].

     -[29]-    See Proposed Revision of Regulation S-K and Guides
               for the Preparation and Filing of Registration
               Statements and Reports, Securities Act Rel. 6276
               (December 23, 1980) [46 FR 79 (January 2, 1981)] .

     -[30]-    Section 5(b) of the Securities Act [15 U.S.C.
               77e(b)] prohibits the use of any prospectus to
               sell a security even after the registration
               statement is declared effective, unless the
               prospectus contains all the information mandated
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 26======
          issuer could avoid delivery of two different documents
          by either including or incorporating by reference the
          required information into the selling materials and
          treating the selling materials as the statutory
          prospectus.  That approach would require the materials
          to be filed and subject them to liability under Section
          12(a)(2) of the Securities Act (whereas generally such
          documents are subject only to fraud liability under the
          current system).

     The Committee recommends that, after a period of time, the

Commission revisit the circumstances under which physical

prospectus delivery requirements should be retained.-[31]-

Under the current system, prospectuses frequently are not

provided to investors until after an investment decision is made,

do not carry the appropriate level of liability, and do not

inform the market at an appropriate time.  Under company

registration, these issues are resolved through enhanced and


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[30]-(...continued)
               by the Act and Commission rules.  Selling
               materials are excluded from the definition of
               prospectus under Section 2(10) of the Act [15
               U.S.C. 77b(10)] only if their delivery is
               accompanied or preceded by a statutory prospectus.



     -[31]-    The Commission views delivery through electronic
               means as satisfying the delivery or transmission
               requirements of the federal securities laws if
               such distribution results in the delivery to the
               intended recipients of the required information --
               the means are not relevant.  See Use of Electronic
               Media for Delivery Purposes, Securities Act Rel.
               7233 (October 6, 1995) [60 FR 53458 (October 13,
               1995)]; see also Use of Electronic Media by
               Broker-Dealers, Transfer Agents, and Investment
               Advisers for Delivery of Information; Additional
               Examples Under the Securities Act of 1933,
               Securities Exchange Act of 1934, and Investment
               Company Act of 1940, Securities Act Rel. 7288 (May
               9, 1996) [61 FR 24644 (May 15, 1996)].


==========================================START OF PAGE 27======
accelerated transactional filing requirements.  Consequently, it

may be possible to dispense with a physical prospectus delivery

requirement in all but extraordinary circumstances.-[32]-

     For the present, however, the Committee was not prepared to

conclude that delivery of prospectus information to the market at

large through filed documents is an adequate substitute for

physical delivery to all investors in all cases, and thus

determined to recommend that delivery of a traditional prospectus

still be required to be made to non-accredited investors in non-

routine transactions.  The Committee was concerned that

individual investors may not have access to alternative

information sources for obtaining information on file with the

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[32]-    A number of countries do not require that the
               prospectus be delivered to offerees and purchasers
               other than by publication.  France, Germany and
               the United Kingdom call for either the publication
               of the prospectus, with investors offered an
               opportunity to request additional information, or
               merely the publication of the availability of the
               prospectus, including specification of the place
               where investors may go to obtain a prospectus.  In
               addition, subject to certain conditions, in
               Germany and the United Kingdom, for repeat
               offerings of less than 10 percent of the market
               capital of a previously listed security, the
               prospectus requirement has been eliminated.  If
               such securities also are to be listed, the
               relevant exchange still must approve the
               additional listing application, but no disclosure
               document is required as part of the applications
               process.  However, the United Kingdom does require
               publication of the number and type of securities
               to be listed as well as the circumstances of their
               issuance.  France has a similar exemption, but
               imposes far more conditions on its use.  See
               Documents for Advisory Committee Meeting, June 15,
               1995, Tab F (Study of Foreign Regulatory
               Processes).


==========================================START OF PAGE 28======
Commission, even if access to such filed information is  provided

earlier via these sources than the more traditional means used

under the current system.-[33]-  In all instances, physical

prospectus delivery would not be required to be made to

accredited investors.  Such investors would benefit under company

registration from access to information required to be filed with

the Commission earlier than it is now required to be provided to

any investor under the current Form S-3 primary shelf offering

process.  Moreover, such accredited investors are in a position

to have such information delivered directly to them if they so

prefer.




























---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[33]-    See Transcript of May 8, 1995 Advisory Committee
               Meeting at 233-236.


==========================================START OF PAGE 29======
     B.   Role of the Commission and Other Gatekeepers or

Monitors

     Outside gatekeepers -- the regulators, lawyers,
     underwriters, accountants and other professionals --
     are critical to the integrity of the securities
     markets.  Current offering procedures allow an issuer
     to market securities with little notice and without
     adequate opportunity for meaningful review and
     investigation at the time of the offering by the
     traditional gatekeepers.  The Committee thus explored
     means to enhance their roles.  Company registration
     will facilitate the due diligence process by reordering
     and rationalizing the gatekeeping functions in a manner
     that will improve their effectiveness in ensuring the
     dissemination of quality disclosure to the market, not
     only in connection with public offerings, but on a
     continuous basis as well.  Company registration would
     make the necessary adjustments to this traditional
     function by encouraging ongoing monitoring of the
     issuer's disclosures by the parties in the best
     position to perform that function.

          1.   The Commission Review Process

     As noted, neither the Form C-1 nor the transactional

disclosure filed with the Commission and publicly disseminated at

the time of the offering normally would be subject to staff

review prior to the commencement of the offering.  This approach

would not reflect a significant change in current Commission

administrative practice.  The Commission already has shifted a

significant part of its gatekeeping function to reviewing company

related and financial information in Exchange Act reports,

although a public offering remains a selection factor even for

seasoned issuers.  As reported in Table 2 to Appendix B, only

approximately 16 percent of filings by seasoned issuers on Form


==========================================START OF PAGE 30======
S-3 are reviewed by the staff.-[34]-  With regard to

securities sold off an already effective shelf registration

statement, prospectus supplements disseminated upon takedown are

never subject to staff pre-review.

     Some have argued that the mere possibility that an offering

could be selected for review remains an important deterrent to

inadequate or misleading disclosure practices.  The Committee

concluded, however, that this deterrent effect comes at the cost

of significant uncertainty in the timing of securities offerings

that often lead even seasoned issuers to resort to alternative

capital-raising techniques that generally offer less investor

protection.  Even with the adoption of the universal shelf

system, issuers still are drawn to alternative markets.  This is

apparently due in part to issuer demand for immediate access to

the market, which could be delayed by the potential review of the

Form S-3 shelf registration statement.

     In the Committee's view, the significant deterrent to the

sale of securities with less than complete and accurate

information would be preserved for these seasoned issuers through

Commission staff review of transactional documents at the time it

reviews the company's Exchange Act reports, just as is currently


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[34]-    In FY 1995, of the 3900 reporting companies
               reviewed, two-thirds were reviewed in an Exchange
               Act, rather than transactional, context.  Of the
               reporting issuer reviews in a transactional
               context, approximately half included a review of
               the registrant's Exchange Act reports.  See Quinn
               Speech, supra n.22, at 30 n.21.


==========================================START OF PAGE 31======
the practice regarding takedown prospectuses for offerings of

securities off already effective shelf registration statements.

As with the current system, the presence of significant financing

or acquisition activity should remain a factor considered by the

Commission staff in determining whether to select an issuer for

review.  The prospect that the Commission staff could issue

significant comments and insist on material revisions to

disclosures already relied upon in connection with an offering of

securities (a possibility that also exists today) should provide

adequate incentive to ensure that the company's disclosure is of

the highest quality.

     The Committee nevertheless determined, at least for purposes

of the pilot, that extraordinary distributions of equity

securities by registered companies should remain potentially

subject to staff pre-review.  Offerings of voting securities

exceeding 40 percent of the existing public float should be

required to be filed on an amendment to the Form C-1 registration

statement that would not become effective absent acceleration by

the staff.  In addition, the likelihood of staff review of proxy

materials in connection with extraordinary transactions will

continue to ensure that transactional reviews take place in those

cases where investor rights are most likely to be

affected.-[35]-   For this reason, the Committee considered

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[35]-    The New York Stock Exchange requires, as part of
               its listing requirements, shareholder approval for
               the issuance of stock with voting power equal to
               or in excess of 20 percent of the voting power
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 32======
limiting staff pre-review to mergers, acquisitions, and other

types of restructurings, but not straight financings.  However,

the Committee determined that such a distinction would be

difficult to administer.  Moreover, significant financings can

cause a fundamental change in the nature of the company depending

on the use of proceeds and, at the extreme, could resemble an

initial public offering by a new enterprise.   If other criteria

exist for identifying circumstances where staff review of a

transaction may be particularly beneficial to investors (for

example, offerings by distressed issuers), yet afford issuers

predictability regarding whether the filing will be reviewed,

they should be explored.

     There remains a concern that an issuer planning an offering

under the company registration system will discover during the

planning process that the staff has selected its Exchange Act

filings for review.  The issuer then would have to determine

whether to delay the offering, and thus risk the closing of a

market window, or go to market with the risk that the staff may

have significant comments that may require revisions to existing

disclosure or additional disclosure.  Issuers face this dilemma

today in deciding whether to proceed with a shelf offering after

learning that the staff has commenced a review of its Exchange

Act filings.  To address this concern in part, the Committee

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[35]-(...continued)
               outstanding, in other than public offerings for
               cash.  NYSE Listed Company Manual, 312.03(c)(i)
               (July 1989).


==========================================START OF PAGE 33======
believes that the Commission could establish a procedure under

which issuers could seek a review, possibly on a nonpublic basis,

when planning to go to market.-[36]-  By requesting a

review prior to the offering, registered companies would benefit

by minimizing the chance that the staff would select their

filings for review on the eve of a planned offering.  Such a

procedure may be particularly useful where a transaction poses

novel disclosure and accounting issues.

     2.   The Underwriter

     The Committee was advised of the concerns of the

underwriting community that the adoption of a company

registration scheme -- and the wider use of the shelf

registration system, particularly for equity and non-investment

grade debt -- could further erode their ability to conduct

effective due diligence.  Consideration was given to what

measures, if any, are necessary to ensure ample opportunity for

underwriter due diligence.  These measures could serve either as

a "speed bump" to ensure that underwriters are engaged early

enough in the offering process to provide an adequate opportunity

to review the issuer's disclosures or as a "focal point" to

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[36]-    This process could be similar to that afforded
               confidential merger proxies, as well as Securities
               Act filings of foreign issuers when necessary to
               preserve the confidentiality of a transaction
               prior to the marketing of the offer consistent
               with home country practice. See Exchange Act Rule
               14a-6(e)(2) [17 C.F.R. 240.14a-6(e)(2)].  See
               also Transcript of June 15, 1995 Advisory
               Committee Meeting at 39 (statement of Edward
               Greene).


==========================================START OF PAGE 34======
concentrate attention on due diligence responsibilities.  One

suggestion required the issuer to hire or select the underwriters

eligible to participate in the offering at least three days prior

to the offering in the case of underwritten offerings of more

than 10 percent of the issuer's voting securities.-[37]-

The Committee concluded that this suggestion would impose an

artificial burden on the offering process, and that the parties

are in a best position to determine the amount of time necessary

to conduct adequate due diligence.  Consequently, the Committee

rejected the notion of a "speed bump" that artificially disrupts

the process.

     The Committee was informed by underwriters that the

requirement to file a Form

8-K at the time of the offering containing the transactional

disclosure and any material company-related updating disclosure

in connection with equity takedowns in excess of a certain

percentage of the equity outstanding would help to "focus" the

due diligence inquiries by underwriters.  This requirement also

would ensure that the market is informed of both the offering and

of the transactional and material updating information, and that

such information is subjected to the liability provisions of

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[37]-    In his 1985 article, Milton Cohen proposed to
               address this question by imposing a waiting period
               of at least five days, at least in equity
               offerings if not all offerings, unless the
               underwriter joins in a request for acceleration of
               that period. Milton H. Cohen, The Integrated
               Disclosure System -- Unfinished Business, 40 Bus.
               Law. 987, 994 (1985)("Cohen, Unfinished
               Business").


==========================================START OF PAGE 35======
Securities Act Sections 11 and 12(a)(2).  For these reasons, the

Committee recommends this type of Form 8-K filing for both

company registration and shelf registration equity offerings of a

non-de minimis amount.

     Moreover, the separate recommendations that information

regarding material developments either be delivered in a

prospectus or be on file prior to its incorporation by reference

into the prospectus, as well as the proposal to deliver the

prospectus prior to sale in the case of substantial equity

offerings, should provide the underwriter with sufficient

additional time to investigate the disclosures.

     Finally, the proposed guidance regarding due diligence

practices (discussed in greater detail below) likewise should

create incentives for issuers and underwriters to adopt

disclosure practices that involve the parties best able to ensure

the accuracy of the disclosures in the due diligence process.

The proposed guidance should assist the underwriter in performing

due diligence by identifying the parties to whom the underwriter

can turn with inquiries regarding specific aspects of the

issuer's disclosure.

     3.   The Auditor

     Under the company registration system, just as under today's

shelf registration system, an auditor's consent to the use of its

report, dated as of, or shortly before, the effective date of the

registration statement (as updated by the filing of audited

financial statements on Form 10-K) would have to be on file with


==========================================START OF PAGE 36======
the Commission at the time of the offering.-[38]-

Consistent with current practice with respect to the shelf, the

auditor could consent to incorporation of its audit report into

the company registration statement at the time the Form 10-K

containing the auditor's report is filed.  That consent, unless

withdrawn by the auditor, would be applicable to all offerings

pursuant to the Form C-1 until the issuance of a new set of

audited financial statements, or other filings are made that have

the effect of resetting the effective date of the registration

statement.  Alternatively, the auditor could determine that its

consent could be filed and currently dated for each specific

issuance of securities, or conditions could be attached to its

use, all as permitted under current practice.

     Consideration was given whether to mandate further auditor

review of the Form

10-Q's interim financial statements at the time of their filing,

rather than as part of the annual audit.  A special committee of

the AICPA recently called for greater association by independent

accounting firms with the non-audited information of their

corporate clients as a means to enhance the value of business


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[38]-    Auditors generally may not provide "prospective
               consents," or consents that are provided
               significantly in advance of the effective date of
               the registration statement.  Under Section
               11(b)(3)(B) of the Securities Act, the adequacy of
               an auditor's due diligence inquiry will be judged
               "at the time such part of the registration
               statement became effective . . . ."  [15 U.S.C.
               77k(b)(3)(B)].


==========================================START OF PAGE 37======
reporting to end-users.-[39]-  Many seasoned public

companies now engage their outside auditors to perform a review

of interim financial information in accordance with Statement on

Auditing Standards ("SAS") No. 71.-[40]-  Pursuant to this

standard, an independent accounting firm will make inquiry

regarding the company's internal control structure and any

significant changes therein since the most recent financial

statement audit or interim review to determine the possible

impact on the preparation of interim financial information, and

will apply analytical procedures to such information to "provide

a basis for inquiry about relationships and individual items that

appear to be unusual."-[41]-

     For purposes of the pilot, the Committee did not believe it

necessary to mandate use of SAS No. 71 reviews by registered

companies.  First, there already appears to be growing use of SAS


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[39]-    See generally Improving Business Reporting - A
               Customer Focus: Meeting the Needs of Investors and
               Creditors, Comprehensive Report of the Special
               Committee on Financial Reporting, American
               Institute of Certified Public Investors (1994)
               (the "Jenkins Committee Report").

     -[40]-    The Committee was informed that at least one major
               accounting firm requires a review of interim
               financial information as a condition to their
               accepting a SEC audit client.  See Transcript of
               September 29, 1995 Advisory Committee Meeting at
               192 (statements of Mr. Elliott).

     -[41]-    SAS No. 71.13.  Rule 436 under the Securities Act
               states that an independent accountant will not be
               deemed to have "expertized" a report on unaudited
               interim financial information [17 C.F.R.
               230.436(c)].



==========================================START OF PAGE 38======
No. 71 reviews by seasoned issuers.-[42]-  Moreover, for

larger, more seasoned companies, auditors do not visit the

company just once or even four times a year, but rather can be

there "virtually continuously."-[43]-  By clarifying that

SAS No. 71 reviews and any other more detailed reviews of interim

information are appropriate factors to be considered in

determining the proper scope of underwriter and outside director

due diligence, the Committee anticipates that there will be

adequate incentives to adopt the practice.-[44]-  As a

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[42]-    A recent survey of approximately 25 percent of the
               firm's SEC clients conducted by Price Waterhouse
               revealed that "most large companies -- i.e., those
               which would initially be eligible for the company
               registration process -- already have some kind of
               auditor involvement with their quarterly data."
               Letter from Arthur Siegel, Price Waterhouse LLP,
               to Steven M.H. Wallman, Securities and Exchange
               Commission, dated July 3, 1996 (the "Price
               Waterhouse Survey").

     -[43]-    Transcript of September 29, 1995 Advisory
               Committee Meeting at 192 (statements of Mr.
               Elliott).

     -[44]-    In debating whether any form of review of interim
               financials, or even non-financial information, by
               auditors should be mandated as a condition of
               opting into the company registration system, the
               Committee was concerned about imposing undue
               burdens on issuers in the form of additional
               costs.  In 1989, the Commission considered, among
               other matters, revising its rules to require
               interim financial information of registrants be
               reviewed by independent auditors before such
               information was filed with the Commission, and
               requested public comment on both the perceived
               need for such revisions and any incremental costs
               and benefits of imposing such requirement.  In a
               comment letter from Arthur Andersen & Co., the
               firm estimated that the incremental cost of
               mandating timely interim reviews to a majority of
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 39======
result, the auditor's gatekeeping function would be enhanced by

causing its reviews of interim financial information to occur on

a more current basis when corrections can be made in filed

reports before they are disseminated to the public, rather than

after the close of the fiscal year.-[45]-




---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[44]-(...continued)
               its clients who already had some form of timely
               review performed was in the range of 5-20 percent.

               For those clients that did not already have a
               timely review performed, incremental costs may be
               higher.  The larger the client, the lower the
               incremental cost in percentage terms.  In
               addition, Arthur Andersen stated that,
               notwithstanding the burden of additional cost, the
               benefits of mandating such reviews on smaller
               companies would be proportionately greater because
               of their generally less sophisticated accounting
               systems.  In Arthur Andersen's view, while the
               performance of interim reviews "would not detect
               reporting problems to the same extent of an audit,
               ... it would enhance the overall quality of
               smaller registrants' financial information and
               reduce the possibility of the issuance of
               misleading interim reports."  Letter from Richard
               Dieter, Arthur Andersen & Co., to Jonathan G.
               Katz, Secretary, Securities and Exchange
               Commission, dated September 12, 1989.

     A more recent survey conducted by Price Waterhouse estimated
     that, for those clients for which full, timely SAS 71
     reviews are not currently conducted, the average cost per
     quarter increase in annual audit fees if such reviews were
     to be conducted was
     2-7 percent of annual audit fees, assuming a report is
     issued only to management and the board of directors.  The
     average cost would increase to the extent the report was
     issued to underwriters or shareholders.  Price Waterhouse
     Survey, supra n.42.

     -[45]-    See Transcript of September 29, 1995 Advisory
               Committee Meeting at 193 (statements of then SEC
               General Counsel Simon Lorne).


==========================================START OF PAGE 40======
     The auditor also can serve an important function at the time

of the offering.  In many cases, the underwriter or its counsel

will discuss the issuer's financial statements with the issuer's

outside auditing firm, and will request comfort from that firm

with respect to financial information contained in the

prospectus.  Since mid-1993, the accounting profession has

followed the guidance prescribed in SAS No. 72 in this context.

An SAS No. 72 engagement relating to a registered public offering

may encompass either or both the audited financial statements and

unaudited financial data set forth in the prospectus.  The

auditor may provide positive assurance on compliance with

applicable Commission rules and regulations (such as Regulations

S-X or S-K) as to financial statements and schedules that the

accountant itself has audited.

     Finally, an auditor can perform an additional gatekeeping

function at the time of the offering when asked to furnish or

update a consent to the use of his or her report.  Prior to

providing such a consent, an auditor makes inquiries and performs

other procedures under SAS No. 37 to satisfy itself that events

subsequent to the date of the annual audited financial statements

do not indicate that adjustments to those statements are

necessary.

II.  Company Eligibility

     When fully implemented, the benefits of company
     registration would be extended to virtually all public
     companies that previously had conducted a public
     offering of their securities.  The concepts of company
     registration, however, will be tested under a pilot
     open only to certain seasoned companies.  The exact


==========================================START OF PAGE 41======
     criteria for participation in the system and what, if
     any, additional conditions would be necessary for
     smaller issuers, will be determined based on experience
     with the pilot.

     The Advisory Committee considered several approaches for

defining which companies would be eligible for company

registration.  The Committee's goal was to extend the benefits of

company registration to as many companies as possible, yet

preserve the current scheme in those instances where it has

proven cost-effective and beneficial to investors.  For the

reasons outlined below, for the purposes of the pilot, the

Committee ultimately settled upon the following eligibility

requirements: completion of an initial public offering, a two-

year reporting history, $75 million public float, and a class of

securities listed on the New York Stock Exchange, the American

Stock Exchange, or the Nasdaq-NMS stock market.

     The Committee believed that the current process for initial

public offerings ("IPOs") generally works well in assisting a

company in the transition from a private to a public company.

Although in many respects there may be ways to lower the

transaction costs and delays inherent in the "going-public"

process, the Committee determined that those issues should be

addressed separately from the consideration of a company

registration process.-[46]-  In the Committee's view, the

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[46]-    An example of such a measure would be the
               Commission's current proposal to allow issuers to
               "test the waters" in connection with an IPO.  See
               Solicitations of Interest Prior to an Initial
               Public Offering, Securities Act Rel. 7188 (June
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 42======
current filing and staff review process is instrumental in

assisting the private company to acquaint itself with the

disclosure obligations of a publicly owned company.  The delay

inherent in the process allows the company's advisers to help its

management put its books and records in order (including

obtaining audited financial statements) and resolve any insider

transactions or arrangements that may be inappropriate for a

public company.  In the Committee's view, there is no alternative

to full due diligence by all outside advisers and gatekeepers in

the context of an IPO.

     For these purposes, the Committee recommended that an IPO be

defined as the first registered offering of securities by an

issuer.-[47]-  Thus, even a company that has been subject

to reporting requirements for a period of time because its equity

is held by more than 500 record holders and it has more than $10

million in assets,-[48]- or it has securities listed on an

exchange,-[49]- would not be eligible for company

registration until it has made at least one registered offering

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[46]-(...continued)
               27, 1995) [60 FR 35648 (July 10, 1995)].

     -[47]-    A registered offering by a company that previously
               had conducted registered offerings and had been a
               reporting company, but thereafter went private and
               ceased reporting, would be considered an IPO for
               these purposes.

     -[48]-    Section 12(g) of the Exchange Act [15 U.S.C.
               78l(g)] and Rule 12g-1 [17 C.F.R. 240.12g-1].

     -[49]-    Section 12(b) of the Exchange Act [15 U.S.C.
               78l(b)].


==========================================START OF PAGE 43======
of securities under the Securities Act.  While a company filing a

Form 10 under the Exchange Act to register a class of securities

is subject to substantially the same disclosure requirements as a

Securities Act registrant, and a Form 10 normally is selected for

staff review, the level of professional outside involvement and

due diligence may be significantly less absent an offering of

securities and the potential application of the strict liability

provisions of Section 11 of the Securities Act.

     During the pilot, and perhaps in the initial stages of full

implementation, the company registration system would be

voluntary; eligible companies could opt in as they desired.  Once

this election is made, a company could opt out by withdrawing its

registration, but it would not be eligible to use the system

again for a specified period of time (two years is recommended).

This voluntary approach offers the benefit of providing a market

test for the system.

     Once experience is gained with company registration, the

benefits of company registration should be made available to

virtually all publicly traded companies to conduct repeat

offerings.  One of the advantages of the company registration

system is that, by virtue of the integral enhancements to the

disclosure process, the system will allow the extension of

streamlined access to the capital markets to companies currently

not eligible to use shelf registration.  Under the universal

shelf registration process, large companies currently have

significant flexibility.  Thus, if eligibility for company


==========================================START OF PAGE 44======
registration were limited to large companies, the benefit for

issuers aided by the system would not be as great as if the

system were extended to other issuers.  The Committee recognizes,

however, that extension of the system beyond S-3 eligible issuers

may require additional disclosure enhancements or conditions,

depending upon the experience with the pilot.  For example, any

smaller companies permitted to take advantage of the company

registration process that have little market following and

therefore a less efficient market for their securities might be

required to continue to comply with traditional prospectus

delivery requirements for all public offerings regardless of the

amount offered, or to undergo staff review of audited financial

statements prior to their use.

     Those determinations necessarily can be made only by the

Commission on the basis of experience gained under the pilot.

For that reason, the Committee concluded that the system should

be phased in gradually, starting with the pilot under which only

larger, more seasoned companies would be eligible to participate.


In this manner, the system could be tested and fine-tuned with

the help of those companies most experienced with the disclosure

responsibilities of public companies and with access to the most

experienced counsel and underwriters.

     Initially, the Committee considered using for pilot

eligibility the existing standards established by the Commission


==========================================START OF PAGE 45======
for eligibility to register securities on Form S-3.-[50]-

The Committee concluded, however, that additional criteria would

be useful at the pilot stage.  Because the company registration

system would place greater reliance on the quality of the

issuer's Exchange Act reports, the Committee determined that only

companies with a reporting experience of at least two years would

be eligible for participation in the system.  In the view of the

Committee, it often takes at least two years following an IPO for

a company and its management to become fully comfortable with the

disclosure obligations of a public company and to have all their

mechanisms for gathering and disseminating information in place

and properly functioning.-[51]-

     The Committee also concluded that initial pilot eligibility

should be limited to companies listed on the New York Stock

Exchange or The American Stock Exchange, or quoted in the

National Market System of the Nasdaq Stock Market.  Limiting the

eligibility to listed companies has the benefit of adding the

overlay of listing standards, including the agreement to provide


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[50]-    Eligibility for the shelf is generally limited to
               companies eligible to register securities on the
               Form S-3 short form registration statement.  S-3
               companies generally include only those that have a
               $75 million public float; one-year reporting
               history; and are current with respect to their
               reporting requirements and certain fixed
               obligations.  With respect to equity, the public
               float requirement is eliminated for secondary
               offerings.

     -[51]-    Transcript of September 29, 1995 Advisory
               Committee Meeting at 13-18.


==========================================START OF PAGE 46======
prompt disclosure to the markets of material developments.  Such

a criterion is useful at the pilot stage, because it would

minimize the amount of coordination with the states needed

because of the common exemption under state "Blue Sky" laws for

listed companies.  After incorporating each of these criteria,

based upon information available to the Committee staff, roughly

30 percent of all reporting companies should qualify for the

pilot.-[52]-

     To be eligible, a company must adopt the enhanced disclosure

practices discussed below.  During the pilot, noncompliance with

the issuer eligibility conditions or any of the disclosure

enhancements as of the time the issuer's Annual Report on Form

10-K update is filed would result in loss of eligibility to make

offerings pursuant to the company registration form.  Similarly,

the issuer must be current with respect to its Exchange Act

reporting obligations at the time of the offering.  Voluntary or

involuntary withdrawal from the system would render the issuer




---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[52]-    The Committee had considered whether eligibility
               should be limited to a senior class of S-3
               companies that have a public float of $150 million
               (the threshold used prior to 1992), rather than
               $75 million.  Based upon data available to the
               Committee staff, this increase over the S-3
               standard would reduce by one-third the percentage
               of reporting companies eligible for the system as
               compared to the S-3 standard.  Because the $150
               million level of capitalization may prevent a fair
               test for extending the system beyond S-3 eligible
               issuers, the Committee determined to retain the
               $75 million eligibility standard.


==========================================START OF PAGE 47======
ineligible to elect back into the system for a period of two

years.

     Consideration also was given to whether the degree of

research coverage by independent analysts should be an

eligibility criterion.  This criterion is not recommended by the

Committee in light of concerns with defining what constitutes

"research coverage."  Several commenters also suggested that

eligibility be limited to companies with an investment grade

rating for senior securities.  Because many companies do not

obtain ratings, or do so only on the basis of credit

enhancements, and may have different ratings for different

classes of senior securities, this factor was not believed to be

a useful determinant of the quality of the issuer's disclosures

or otherwise consistent with the concept of company registration.




     Further, consideration was given to whether eligibility

should be extended to closed-end investment companies.

Registered investment companies are subject to a different set of

reporting requirements under the Investment Company Act of 1940

and the rules and forms adopted thereunder.  In the Committee's

view, the company registration system may not be that useful for

these companies.  Accordingly, at least for the purposes of the

pilot, the Committee did not recommend inclusion of closed-end

funds, but left the issue to the Commission for any further

review it deemed necessary.


==========================================START OF PAGE 48======
     For similar reasons, foreign private issuers generally would

be eligible for the pilot if they file the same forms and meet

the same disclosure requirements as domestic companies.  Since

many foreign regulatory schemes do not require the filing of

quarterly reports and any required semi-annual reports generally

are based upon home country disclosure rules and

practices,-[53]- it is possible that participation by these

companies in the pilot may not be appropriate absent their

providing disclosure comparable to domestic companies.

Nevertheless, the Committee urges the Commission to consider

whether a practice analogous to the current practice of some

foreign issuers using the shelf on Form F-3 to provide reconciled

interim financials on Form 6-K on a semi-annual basis, and

incorporating those financials into the shelf registration

statement, would suffice for company registration.










---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[53]-    Under the foreign integrated disclosure system,
               reporting foreign private issuers file an annual
               report on Form 20-F.  All other interim financial
               information required to be made public under home-
               country law is based upon home-country disclosure
               rules and practices.  Consequently, foreign
               private issuers are not required to file quarterly
               financials on Form 10-Q or current reports on Form
               8-K in accordance with U.S. disclosure
               requirements.  See Exchange Act Rule 13a-16 [17
               C.F.R. 240.13a-16].


==========================================START OF PAGE 49======
III.      Transactions Covered

     All sales of securities by a registered company will be
     afforded the same legal status as a registered offering
     of securities under the current scheme, thereby
     eliminating or greatly reducing the need for resale
     restrictions and other artificial restraints, such as
     those necessitated by the concepts of gun-jumping,
     restricted securities, affiliate sales, integration of
     offers, general solicitation, and flowback of offshore
     offerings.  Under the voluntary pilot, companies would
     be provided the choice of obtaining these benefits by
     treating all offers and sales as covered by the company
     registration statement, or choosing to preserve the
     option to engage in exempt transactions at the cost of
     continued regulatory restrictions on resales.

     A.    Affiliate and Underwriter Resales

      With limited exceptions, the company registration system

would be available for all offerings of any securities by

eligible companies.  Similarly, sales by affiliates and by any

person acting for a registered company or its affiliates would be

covered by the Form C-1.  The Securities Act addresses resales of

securities primarily as a means to prohibit the distribution of

securities of issuers for which there is inadequate information

available to the public,-[54]- and to protect the integrity

of the transactional registration process.  This concern is

particularly important when the issuer is not yet a public

company and private sales and redistributions could serve as a

means of developing a trading market in the security without the

issuer being subjected to the registration process.  It has long

been recognized that this concern is of less importance where the


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[54]-    See Preliminary note to Rule 144 [17 C.F.R.
230.144].


==========================================START OF PAGE 50======
issuer already is a reporting company and is currently subject to

ongoing disclosure requirements.-[55]-

          1.   Sales of Restricted Securities

     A company registration system would further alleviate these

concerns by eliminating the notion of exempt private placements

and restricted securities altogether.  Under full company

registration, regardless of the nature of the transaction in

which securities were initially sold by the issuer or its

affiliates, there would be no need to impose resale restrictions

on outstanding securities.  All sales by registered companies and

their affiliates made under Form C-1 would have the same legal

status and carry the same or higher liability and investor

protections as registered offerings do today.  For that reason,

the provisions of Rule 144 governing resales of restricted

securities would not be necessary since all shares would be

registered if issued by a registered company.  A purchaser in the

secondary market would be better protected under the company

registration scheme, especially given the more current and

reliable information being provided by the issuer pursuant to the

various disclosure enhancements.

     Because all issuer and affiliate sales would be deemed to be

made under the






---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[55]-    See Cohen, supra n.2, at 1395.


==========================================START OF PAGE 51======
Form C-1 (where a company has opted into full company

registration-[56]-), an issuer cannot use indirect sales

through a conduit as a means to distribute securities without

registration and disclosure, nor as a means to escape liability.

All securities issued under the company registration system would

be subject to Section 11 liability for any misleading statements

or information in the issuers' public reports that are

incorporated by reference into the registration statement at the

time of original issuance by the issuer.  This liability would

run to any purchaser that can trace the security back to the

misleading registration statement.  Indeed, in the case where it

can be demonstrated that the seller was a mere "strawman" for the

issuer and was selling on its behalf, the resale itself will be

considered an issuer transaction made pursuant to the

registration statement.

     Since all securities would be deemed registered upon

issuance under company registration, the Committee has determined

that a safe harbor from the broad definition of "underwriter" in

Section 2(11) of the Securities Act should be adopted for

purposes of resales of securities issued by a registered company.


The safe harbor would limit the application of the underwriter
---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[56]-    As noted (supra p. 5-6), a registered company
               opting for full participation in the system would
               have the choice whether to sell non-convertible
               debt securities within the system.  However, no
               such choice would be available for equity
               securities and securities convertible to equity --
               all such securities issued by the fully
               participating company must be sold pursuant to the
               company registration system.


==========================================START OF PAGE 52======
concept to persons engaged in the business of a broker-dealer,

whether or not registered as such (including banks not required

to register as a broker-dealer), who participate in the

distribution of securities by an issuer or an

affiliate.-[57]- The Commission may wish to consider

whether it would be helpful to specify a time after which a

broker-dealer would no longer be deemed a participant in the

distribution (e.g., after it has sold out its allotment or the

expiration of six months, whichever is earlier), especially if

the Commission otherwise shortens the period in which a

distribution will be deemed to occur.  The purpose of this

provision would be to ensure that only the underwriting firms

participating in the offering incur responsibility under Section

11 liability and due diligence provisions, while providing more

certainty as to when resales may freely take place.



---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[57]-    The use of a narrower definition of underwriter
               for the purpose of resales of securities sold
               under the company registration system is
               appropriate, since it would only apply in the
               context of registered offerings.  Except in the
               case of broker-dealer firms in the business of
               underwriting securities, in the absence of
               arrangements with, or compensation for selling on
               behalf of, the issuer, and if certain other
               conditions are satisfied, nonaffiliated purchasers
               in a registered offering have not been considered
               to be underwriters under current interpretations
               of that definition, even when they purchase a
               substantial portion of the registered offering or
               immediately resell the securities following the
               offering.  See American Council of Life Insurance,
               SEC No-Action Letter, [1983 Transfer Binder] Fed.
               Sec. L. Rep. (CCH)   77,526 (May 10, 1983).


==========================================START OF PAGE 53======
     A final benefit of this more narrow definition of

underwriter would apply in the context of acquisitions.  Current

law deems affiliates of acquired companies to be underwriters

when they resell the registered company's securities received in

the acquisition.-[58]-  Registered companies participating

fully in the system, and thus entitled to take advantage of this

narrower definition of underwriter, could make acquisitions

without issuing restricted stock to the acquired company's

insiders.
































---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[58]-    See Securities Act Rule 145(c) [17 C.F.R.
               230.145(c)].


==========================================START OF PAGE 54======
          2.  Sales by Affiliates

     Under the current system, substantial affiliate resales

(those exceeding the limits set by Rule 144) have been subjected

to registration requirements, even with respect to nonrestricted

securities purchased by the affiliate in registered transactions

or in the open market.  Again, the primary purpose of this

provision was to ensure that companies do not create a public

market for their shares indirectly through sales by their

controlling or controlled persons when adequate information is

not available concerning the issuer.

     As in the case of restricted securities, the need to

preserve existing constraints on affiliate resales largely

disappears under a company registration scheme.  Since registered

companies would be subject to continuous reporting obligations,

and the issuer would be exposed to statutory liability for any

sales made by the issuer to an affiliate, or any subsequent

purchaser from the affiliate who can trace the securities back to

the company registration statement, there is little concern that

an affiliate may be acting as a conduit to facilitate the

distribution of unregistered securities without the protections

of the registration process.

     Similarly, resales by affiliates should not require

prospectus disclosure since the sale would not affect the

financial condition of the issuer.  The antifraud, beneficial

ownership, and Section 16 "insider" reporting and short-swing

profit rules, all promulgated under the Exchange Act, apply to


==========================================START OF PAGE 55======
ensure adequate disclosure of these transactions, to the extent a

sale by an affiliate impacts on the control of the issuer or the

available supply of its securities in the public markets, or is

indicative of possible insider trading.-[59]-

      The Committee proposes, therefore, that the class of

persons subject to the registration requirements and resale

limitations be significantly narrowed.  In the case of registered

companies taking full advantage of the company registration

system, those persons subject to resale restrictions would

include only holders of 20 percent of the voting power, or

holders of 10 percent of the voting power with at least one

director on the board, persons who can be presumed to be in a

position to exercise control.-[60]-  That presumption of a

control relationship would be rebuttable.-[61]-  Also

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[59]-    Milton Cohen expressed the view that delivery of a
               prospectus for affiliate sales was unnecessary in
               most instances.  Cohen, supra n.2, at 1395.  This
               concern could be further addressed under full
               company registration system by requiring
               affiliates to make prior disclosure of plans to
               make sales, similar to the notice provided on Form
               144 today.  A similar notice provision for 15%
               holders was proposed by the ALI Code.  See Federal
               Securities Code 510 (Am. Law. Inst.) (Proposed
               Official Draft 1978).

     -[60]-    A shareholder would not be deemed to hold a board
               seat merely as a result of its voting power
               derived pro rata as a holder of a class of
               securities.  Rather, the right to appoint a member
               of the board must be derived by independent
               agreement or arrangement with the issuer,
               management or other shareholders.

     -[61]-    While a finding of "control" will always depend
               upon an examination of all the facts and
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 56======
included would be the CEO and inside directors, as well as the

director representatives of the controlling shareholders.

     This class of persons subject to resale limitations is

significantly narrower than that prescribed by current law, which

under certain circumstances could encompass all executive

officers or directors, as well as significant

shareholders.-[62]-  The narrower class is justified in

light of the diminished concern with affiliates acting as

conduits for the distribution of issuer securities.-[63]-

This proposal affects solely the registration and resale

requirements, not any other provisions under the federal

securities laws, such as the "controlling person" liability







---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[61]-(...continued)
               circumstances, one significant factor in
               determining who controls the issuer for Securities
               Act registration purposes has been the ability to
               obtain the signatures necessary to complete the
               registration process.  See III L. Loss & J.
               Seligman, Securities Regulation 1111 (3d ed.
               1989);  Cohen, supra n.2, at 1393.

     -[62]-    See generally A.A. Sommer, Jr., Who's "In Control"
               -- the SEC, 21 Bus. Law. 559, 567-83 (1966).

     -[63]-    The Committee recognized that contractual and
               other relationships also can give rise to a
               control relationship.  However, the Committee
               believes that, given the inability to use conduits
               to avoid registration or liability under the
               company registration system, the narrower
               application of the resale restrictions is
               appropriate.


==========================================START OF PAGE 57======
provision under the Securities Act or the Exchange

Act.-[64]-

     The Committee considered requiring all sales by those

affiliates subject to resale restrictions under full company

registration, no matter how de minimis, to be registered under

the C-1 registration statement, thereby eliminating the need to

apply Rule 144 to these affiliate resales as well.  However, in

the Committee's view, that approach would be unnecessarily broad

and restrictive, since affiliates are currently permitted to sell

without registration if they comply with Rule 144. Accordingly,

affiliate sales meeting the applicable Rule 144 conditions need

not be made under the company registration statement.

     The current flexibility of Rule 144 should provide those

affiliates still subject to resale limitations under company

registration with ample opportunity to sell securities without

the necessity of obtaining the issuer's assistance in completing

the registration process, as well as the payment of a fee, at the

time of the resale.  Issuers certainly can oversee resales by

their CEO and inside directors to ensure compliance with these

requirements, and avoid sales at a time when the issuer has not

disclosed material developments to the market.  The same is true

in the case of significant shareholders who purchased from, or at




---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[64]-    Section 15 of the Securities Act [15 U.S.C. 77o];
               Section 20(a) of the Exchange Act [15 U.S.C.
               78t(a)].


==========================================START OF PAGE 58======
the invitation of, the issuer.-[65]-  In those instances,

an issuer can protect itself by obtaining a contractual agreement

from the affiliate not to resell without the issuer's permission.



     In those cases where the affiliate's investment in the

company was uninvited, the Committee considered whether special

provision should be made to allow the affiliate to sell under the

company registration system without the cooperation of the

issuer.  Unlike the case with current law, during the pilot, the

affiliate of a company participating fully -- with no private

placement exemption -- in the system cannot simply sell a large

block of the company's securities in one or more exempt private

placements, since that sale would be deemed registered for

purposes of the Securities Act.-[66]-  That registered sale

would require an updating of the issuer's disclosure at the time

of sale in order to comply with the Securities Act.  The

Committee did not want an issuer to be subjected to Securities

Act liability for a resale transaction that it could not control.


The Committee believed that it would be extremely rare that an


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[65]-    The issuer's cooperation often is required for an
               investor to obtain affiliate status through
               significant purchases of outstanding securities as
               a result of state takeover statutes and "poison
               pill" rights plans.

     -[66]-    As discussed below, under an option to elect a
               modified version of the company registration
               system, the issuer could preserve the option to
               conduct exempt private placements for itself and
               all affiliates.  See infra p. 42-45.


==========================================START OF PAGE 59======
issuer would object to an uninvited affiliate reselling into the

market in a broad-based distribution.  Consequently, the

potential for a significant shareholder of a registered company

to be locked into its investment by an uncooperative issuer seems

more theoretical than real.  In any event, a substantial

shareholder that could not secure the assistance of the issuer in

its resales may be able to demonstrate that it does not have the

requisite control over the issuer, and thus rebut the presumption

of control in the definition of affiliate.  Absent affiliate

status, the shareholder is free to resell without the

registration process and the corresponding Securities Act

liabilities.

     B.   Exclusions

     As noted, initial public offerings would continue to be

subject to a transactional registration-type regulatory process,

since only companies that have conducted a registered public

offering would be eligible to use the company registration

system.  In addition, securities not valued on the basis of the

issuing company's business and financial information, such as

asset-backed or special purpose issues, would not be eligible for

the system.  Securities that are valued in part on the basis of

the issuer's performance, such as structured securities or

tracking securities (e.g., GM Series H), could be made eligible

subject to special disclosure requirements.  Further, issuers

could opt in without subjecting issuances of the types of

securities currently exempt from the registration requirements of


==========================================START OF PAGE 60======
the Securities Act to the company registration system.  Thus,

commercial paper, tax-exempt private activity bonds and bank-

guaranteed debt would remain exempt from the system.

     Even in the case of a company taking full advantage of the

system, the Committee concluded that, during the pilot stage,

placements of straight (i.e., non-convertible) debt could be

excluded from the company registration system at the issuer's

election; debt securities, of course, also could be included at

the issuer's option.  The Committee believed that straight debt

placements, either on an agency basis or into the Rule 144A

market, are efficient, involve mostly institutions, and therefore

may not necessitate the protections provided by the registration

scheme.  Moreover, unlike the case with equity securities, the

integration and restricted securities concepts do not appear to

have created significant problems in the debt markets due to the

lack of fungibility among various debt issuances.

     C.   Offshore Offerings

     Under full company registration, purchasers of securities of

registered companies in the U.S. trading markets would have the

same disclosure and liability protections regardless of whether

the securities initially were sold overseas or in this country.

Offshore sales to non-U.S. persons would not have to be covered

by the company registration statement.  The adoption of a company

registration system is not intended to result in an indirect

assertion of U.S. registration jurisdiction over an issuer's

offshore financing transactions.   However, under full company


==========================================START OF PAGE 61======
registration, in light of the concerns regarding flowback of

equity securities initially sold offshore, a participating issuer

would be required to include equity securities on its company

registration statement on the Form C-1 for purposes of their

reentry into the United States in flowback transactions.  The

amount to be registered for this purpose would be based on the

issuer's reasonable estimate of the likely flowback into the

United States.  Thus, U.S. purchasers of equity securities

initially offered overseas would benefit from whatever statutory

protections are afforded to secondary market purchasers by

Section 11 of the Securities Act for the period of the applicable

statute of limitations, running from the time of the initial sale

by the issuer.  As a result, the concerns that have arisen with

respect to Regulation S offerings of equity securities with an

established trading market in this country-[67]- would

evaporate as a practical matter in the context of sales by

registered companies, because U.S. purchasers would be protected

to the same extent as if the securities initially had been issued

in the United States.

     D.   Preservation of Transactional Exemptions

     The Committee engaged in considerable discussion on whether

companies participating in the company registration system should

be able to rely on exemptions for private placements and other


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[67]-    Problematic Practices Under Regulation S,
               Securities Act Rel. 7190 (June 27, 1995) [60 FR
               35663 (July 10, 1995)].


==========================================START OF PAGE 62======
transactions that are available today from the registration and

liability provisions of the Securities Act.  On the one hand, the

inclusive nature of company registration ensures that issuers

could not use conduits to avoid liability that results from the

registration of securities.  Treating all sales as registered

generally eliminates the need for such concepts as restricted

securities, integration, general solicitation and flowback of

unregistered securities issued abroad, with respect to securities

issued by companies opting into the system.  To the extent

company-registered issuers or affiliates are permitted to engage

in unregistered private placements, the need for resale

restrictions and other concepts that burden the current scheme

would remain, thereby costing the new system some of its expected

benefits.  On the other hand, the loss of the private placement

option, and thus the potential for increased liability and

possible disclosure concerns arising from the need to update the

company's public disclosures and file the transactional

information, as well the need to pay a registration fee, when

making a company-registered offering could be a deterrent to the

use of the company registration system.-[68]-

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[68]-    Transcript of May 8, 1995 Advisory Committee
               Meeting at 177 (statements of Professor Coffee).
               The same concern may arise with respect to the
               ability to conduct an offshore offering under
               Regulation S without having to register the
               securities offered for flowback purposes or
               otherwise. If the issuer is contemplating an
               acquisition, Regulation S offers a means for the
               issuer to avoid delaying the offer until the full
               acquisition disclosure is available. The
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 63======
     Therefore, to permit a fair test of the company registration

concepts during the pilot stage, the Committee believed that

issuers should be afforded the option of continuing to conduct

private placements, while still taking advantage of most of the

benefits of the system.  Companies could choose either to waive

transactional exemptions, such as those for small issuances

(3(b) and Regulation A), private offerings (4(2)) and

Regulation D (Rules 504, 505 and 506)), intrastate offerings

(3(a)(11) and Rule 147), issuer exchange offers (3(a)(9)), and

transactions pursuant to fairness hearings (3(a)(10)), as well

as the jurisdictional safe harbor of Regulation S, or determine

to preserve the option to exclude those transactions from the

company registration system under a modified or less

comprehensive version of this system.

     In the case of participation in full company registration,

other than the limited exclusions for exempt securities discussed

above (commercial paper, bank debt, etc.), all issuer and

affiliate sales (outside Rule 144) would be deemed "registered"

for Securities Act purposes.  Thus, regardless of the nature of


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[68]-(...continued)
               Commission has proposed to address that concern by
               conforming the acquisition disclosure and
               accounting requirements under the Securities Act
               to the same standard as under the Exchange Act.
               See  Streamlining Disclosure Requirements Relating
               to Significant Business Acquisitions and Requiring
               Quarterly Reporting of Unregistered Equity Sales,
               Securities Act Rel. 7189 (June 27, 1995) [60 FR
               35656 (July 10, 1995)] (the "Streamlining Business
               Acquisitions Release").


==========================================START OF PAGE 64======
the transaction in which the securities were originally issued,

the securities would be freely tradeable.   Purchasers of those

securities from the issuer or an affiliate (outside Rule 144)

would enjoy the same remedies and disclosure protections as would

be the case if they purchased securities issued today in a

registered public offering.

     Companies participating in the modified version of the

system still would benefit from the "file and go" registration

process, so long as they agree to the disclosure enhancements.

Securities issued in excluded transactions, however, would be

restricted securities subject to current holding periods and

resale limitations to the same extent they are today.-[69]-

The new, more limited, applicability of resale limitations to

affiliates and definitions of underwriter would not apply with

respect to those issuers and transactions.-[70]-  These


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[69]-    Although certain of the forms of exempt
               transactions do not result in the issuance of
               restricted securities under current law, they are
               subject to limitations and restrictions that
               condition the exemption, as well as potential
               integration, that would not apply if conducted on
               a registered basis.

     -[70]-    The company registration model envisioned by the
               ALI Code also provided for exempt limited
               offerings.  Those offerings were defined as sales
               up to 35 buyers as well as an unlimited number of
               institutional investors. See Federal Securities
               Code Section 242(b) (Proposed Official Draft 1978)
               (Am. Law Inst.). While strict resale limitations
               were not imposed, securities issued in those
               transactions could not be held by more than 35
               noninstitutional investors for one year after the
               issuance in the case of seasoned issuers.  Id.


==========================================START OF PAGE 65======
exempt offerings, however, would not be subject to integration

with registered offerings conducted on the Form C-1.   This dual

approach, while adding complexity to the company registration

system during the pilot stage, would permit issuers and their

purchasers to weigh the costs and benefits of full registration

of all transactions versus private placements.

     In the Committee's view, even during the pilot stage, the

benefits resulting from registration, including the issuance of

freely tradeable securities in what otherwise would have been a

private transaction resulting in restricted securities, should

outweigh any additional costs imposed by registering the

securities under the system.  In addition, given the extensive

representations and warranties that normally are provided to

purchasers in a private placement, the fact that company-

registered transactions would be subject to Securities Act

statutory liability should not be a significant deterrent.

Similarly, the discount that normally adheres to private

placements (as high as 20 percent for equity securities) should

far outweigh the registration fee paid in registered offerings

(.034 percent).

     E.   Limited Placements

     An issuer participating in the full company registration

system may be concerned that it will not be able to raise capital

at a time when it is not in a position to disclose information

currently required in a registered offering.  This situation may

arise due to a material business development that must remain


==========================================START OF PAGE 66======
nonpublic for legitimate business reasons, the need to update

financial statements that have "gone stale," its offering

documentation (for example, the Form 8-K filing) not being

completed in time to take advantage of a market opportunity, or a

company's auditor not consenting to the use of its report in

connection with a registered offering.  All of these reasons may

induce a company to continue to conduct private placements.  In

these cases, an issuer could conduct a limited placement of

securities to one or more accredited investors, so long as those

securities (and any price-related securities) are not traded by

the purchaser until full disclosure is provided to the public

through a Form 8-K or other public filing of such information and

its inclusion in the Form C-1.  Of course, the issuer still would

have to make full disclosure to the purchaser at the time of the

sale (which could be done in writing as well as orally), subject

to whatever confidentiality agreements with the purchaser that

the issuer deems necessary.  In this manner, once the disclosure

is made to the public, the purchaser would have freely tradeable

securities.  The duration of any restriction on resale would be

determined by the parties, not a fixed holding period set by

Commission rule.  In addition, unlike an exempt offering, the

liability provisions of the Securities Act would attach to the

securities originally issued in these limited offerings.


==========================================START OF PAGE 67======
IV.  Disclosure Enhancements Under the Recommended Company

     Registration Model

     Adoption of a company registration system creates the
     opportunity for raising the quality and integrity of
     disclosure provided routinely to the markets through
     the company's Exchange Act reports in a variety of
     ways:  (a) by requiring a heightened focus on the part
     of senior managers and directors on their existing
     financial reporting responsibilities; (b) by increasing
     the scope and currency of disclosure to the markets of
     specified material developments; and (c) by increasing
     the opportunity for outside gatekeepers or monitors to
     participate.  Because company registration relies on
     the integrity of publicly available information and an
     efficient market for an issuer's securities, adherence
     to the recommended enhancements would be a condition to
     continued participation in the company registration
     system.  As a result, investors in the secondary
     trading markets, as well as those participating in
     primary offerings, would benefit from more
     comprehensive, current and reliable information.


     As envisioned by the Committee, company registration relies

heavily on the public availability of accurate and complete

information relating to a registered company's business and

financial condition.  Viewed in this light, the Committee's model

of company registration represents a logical extension of the

Commission's integrated disclosure scheme.   Despite integration

and a gradual shift in emphasis of Commission staff review over

the past decade away from Securities Act transactional documents

and toward Exchange Act periodic reports, there remain

substantial differences in the quality of the disclosures

provided under each statute.-[71]-  The expense of

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[71]-    As such, not much has changed since Milton Cohen
               observed in 1985:

                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 68======
continuous due diligence of the caliber expected in a primary

distribution, coupled with issuers' legitimate need to control

the timing of public disclosure of material developments, make it

difficult for Exchange Act documents always to achieve true

parity in terms of reliability and currency with documents filed

in connection with registered offerings.-[72]-  However,

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[71]-(...continued)
          Disclosure for [Exchange] Act purposes still tend to be
          taken far less seriously, and to be of lower quality,
          than those historically provided, and still aspired to,
          under the [Securities] Act.

          . . .

          Because of this disparity, and the disparity
          in liability provisions that it reflects, the
          SEC has considered it necessary for a
          registrant, on the occasion of a public
          offering, not merely to supplement its latest
          [Exchange] Act disclosures but to bring them
          within the coverage of section 11 by, at
          least, incorporating them by reference into a
          [Securities] Act registration statement.

     Cohen, Unfinished Business, supra n.37, at 992.  See 1977
     Advisory Committee Report, supra n.4, at 425-26.

     -[72]-    Traditionally, there have been "[t]wo principal
               qualitative reasons for placing particular stress"
               on Securities Act filings by comparison with
               Exchange Act filings, as suggested by the Wheat
               Report in 1968:

          First, the buyer of securities in an initial
          distribution is in a somewhat different position from
          the buyer in the trading markets.  Not only the
          [Securities] Act but much of the legislation previously
          passed by the states in the securities field rests on
          this premise.  The compensation that dealers and
          salesmen receive when they participate in a
          [Securities] Act offering is almost always appreciably
          more generous than that customarily received in
          exchange or over-the-counter trading.  New securities
          have to be distributed in short order.  Special efforts
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 69======
the Committee believes that additional improvements in Exchange

Act disclosures -- especially with respect to the attention paid

by senior management, outside directors and other gatekeepers or

monitors -- would achieve more fully the intent of the Commission

when it integrated the disclosure requirements of the two

statutes in 1982.

    Accordingly, the Committee recommends that the Commission

implement a series of mandatory disclosure enhancements

applicable to registered companies.  Voluntary, but encouraged,

measures such as SAS No. 71 reviews and appointment of a

disclosure committee, should operate in tandem with the mandated

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[72]-(...continued)
          are necessary if disclosure is to serve as a useful
          shield against the dangers inherent in such a
          situation.

          Second, new public offerings, especially those for the
          accounts of issuers, have a special economic
          significance.  The transaction in which one investor
          purchases from another a security originally issued
          many years ago has less impact on the economy than one
          in which the investor's dollars go directly into the
          treasury of a corporation in order to help it to
          develop a mine, construct a new plant, or exploit a new
          technological development.  A special disclosure effort
          may well be justified when allocation of capital in a
          free society is affected. . . .

                              . . .

          For these reasons, among others, quantitative
          differences between the new issue and trading markets
          must be regarded with caution. Nevertheless, in the
          Study's judgment, the statistics demonstrate the need
          to achieve a better balance in disclosure policy, with
          greater emphasis on continuing disclosures for the
          trading markets.

     Wheat Report, supra n.3, at 60-61.



==========================================START OF PAGE 70======
enhancements to facilitate greater outside director, auditor, and

underwriter attention to existing Securities Act due diligence

responsibilities.  Both the mandatory and voluntary measures

recommended by the Committee, therefore, should improve the

quality and integrity of corporate disclosure in connection with

not only primary distributions, but also the Exchange Act reports

upon which the trading markets depend.

     A.  Mandatory Disclosure Enhancements

     Committee member Robert Elliott has urged the Committee to

expand its primary focus on the reliability of the corporate

reporting process to address perceived problems in the content of

the resultant disclosures.  Mr. Elliott raised the concern,

echoed in the Jenkins Committee Report,-[73]- that much

SEC-prescribed financial reporting may have become obsolete,

redundant of generally accepted accounting principles ("GAAP") or

otherwise of marginal utility to the investing

public.-[74]-  These financial reporting issues are

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[73]-    See supra n.39.  Mr. Elliott was a member of the
               Jenkins Committee.

     -[74]-    In a letter dated November 10, 1995 from Mr.
               Elliott to Committee Chairman Wallman, Mr. Elliott
               suggested that the Commission conduct research
               into investor informational demands that focuses
               on "[t]he trade-off between relevance and
               reliability," noting that Jenkins Committee data
               show that investors "would prefer more relevance,
               even at the cost of reliability."  See Documents
               for Advisory Committee Meeting, November 21, 1995,
               Tab E (Letter dated November 10, 1995 from Robert
               Elliott to Commissioner Wallman at 2).  As Mr.
               Elliott points out:

                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 71======
relevant to the Commission's administration of its disclosure

program regardless of whether the Commission determines to move

to a company registration system.  In addition, the

recommendations of the Jenkins Committee already were being

considered by representatives of the affected constituencies

prior to the establishment of the Advisory Committee.-[75]-

For these reasons, the Committee determined to defer to these

other ongoing evaluations of the need to reform financial


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[74]-(...continued)
          If registrants are willing to pay some measure of cost
          to become C-1 companies, they should be just as willing
          to devote that measure to the incremental relevance it
          would purchase as to the incremental reliability it
          would purchase.  This is a policy choice that the SEC
          can and should make for the sake of its investor-
          protection mission.

                              . . .

          Companies often misperceive costs because they fail to
          count the capital-cost reduction benefit from clear,
          honest, complete disclosure policies.  The SEC should
          undertake to study these benefits through independent
          economic analysis and make the case to registrants that
          disclosures helpful to investors' decision making
          provide capital-cost reductions (as long as they don't
          reveal matters to competitors that (a) are economically
          deleterious and (b) the competitors didn't already
          know).

     Id. at 2-3.

     -[75]-    The Committee was advised by the analyst community
               that it would be premature to take up the Jenkins
               Committee Report recommendations before they are
               thoroughly examined by the accounting, corporate
               and end-user communities, as well as the FASB.
               See Documents for Advisory Committee Meeting,
               September 29, 1995, Tab E (Letter dated September
               27, 1995 from the AIMR to Commissioner Wallman, at
               6).



==========================================START OF PAGE 72======
reporting and confine its recommendations in this area to the

substantial enhancement of reporting procedures and the

reliability of reported information.  The Committee did make

substantive reporting proposals, however, such as the proposed

changes to the existing Forms 10-K and 8-K disclosures, where it

believed they were necessary.-[76]-

          1.  Enhanced Involvement by Senior Management

     When the Commission mandated in 1980 that senior managers

and at least a majority of the board of directors sign a

registrant's annual report on Form 10-K,-[77]- the

Commission expected management and the board to focus their

attention on the disclosures in the annual report.  In practice,

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[76]-    The Committee also considered, but rejected as
               unnecessarily burdensome when balanced against
               likely investor benefits, a requirement that
               registered companies report in a timely manner all
               material developments similar to the obligation
               issuers now incur as a condition to listing on the
               New York Stock Exchange.  See NYSE Listed Company
               Manual 202.05 (listed companies expected to
               "release quickly to the public any news or
               information which might reasonably be expected to
               materially affect the market for its securities");
               see also American Stock Exchange Company Guide
               1102, and National Association of Securities
               Dealers By-laws, Schedule D.  For substantially
               the same reason, the Committee did not require
               registered companies to procure auditor
               attestation of their management discussion and
               analysis, or obtain an opinion of counsel on
               periodic reports.

     -[77]-    See General Instruction D to Form 10-K, adopted in
               Amendments to Annual Report Form, Related Forms,
               Rules, Regulations,and Guides: Integration of
               Securities Acts Disclosure Systems, Securities Act
               Rel. 6231 (Sept. 2, 1980) [45 FR 63630 (September
               25, 1980)] (the "Annual Report Release").


==========================================START OF PAGE 73======
however, some of these corporate officials still devote far less

attention and care to the preparation and review of the Form 10-K

and other periodic and current Exchange Act reports than are

generally seen in the Securities Act context.  When presenting

and discussing this issue, both the Committee and its staff

repeatedly were advised that a routine practice among some

reporting companies is merely to have senior management (and

directors for the Form 10-K) execute the signature pages of a

required Exchange Act report without receiving, and hence

reviewing, the remainder of the document.-[78]-

     Whatever the causes of the disparities between the level of

attention given to the preparation of Securities Act and Exchange

Act disclosure documents, the result is clear -- the senior

management of many registrants could do far more than they are

doing today to assure the quality and reliability of information

disseminated to the nation's public trading markets.  Two

measures recommended by the Committee are intended to heighten

top managers' compliance with present reporting responsibilities:


(i) the certification by top management to the Commission that

specified Exchange Act disclosure documents have been reviewed by

them and do not, to the reviewing manager's knowledge, contain

any materially false or misleading information, and (ii) a senior

management report addressed and submitted to the audit committee

of the board of directors (or its equivalent) describing


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[78]-    See pp. 46 and 51 of Appendix A to the Report.


==========================================START OF PAGE 74======
procedures adopted both to ensure the integrity and accuracy of

such disclosure documents, and to prevent insider trading.

               a.  Top Management Certifications

      In requiring certification by responsible senior managers

that each Exchange Act report has been read, and that the

particular manager is not aware of any material misstatement or

omission in that report, the Committee hopes that the

Commission's longstanding objective of encouraging management (as

well as directors, accountants and attorneys) to refocus its

attention on the sufficiency of Exchange Act filings in order to

instill "a sufficient degree of discipline ... in the [integrated

disclosure] system to make it work" might be

fulfilled.-[79]-    Rather than create additional

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[79]-    Annual Report Release, supra n.77 (discussing
               reasons for imposing obligation to sign the Form
               10-K upon the issuer's principal executive
               officer, certain additional officers, and a
               majority of the board of directors).  Compare 1977
               Advisory Committee Report, supra n.4, at 426-27
               (rejecting a suggested requirement that a majority
               of the issuer's board of directors sign each
               Exchange Act report that would be incorporated by
               reference into a short-form registration
               statement, based on commenters' concerns that the
               increased liability the director signatories thus
               might incur would deter use of the short form;
               however, the Committee "encourage[d] the
               Commission to consider this concept as a possible
               means of upgrading the quality of reporting by
               improved attention by directors and top officers
               to their filings and the consequent enhanced
               possibility of liability").  Without addressing
               directly the 1977 Advisory Committee's conclusion,
               the Commission in expanding the Form 10-K
               signature requirement to require a majority of the
               board to execute this document regardless of its
               potential incorporation by reference into a
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 75======
managerial duties or liabilities, the new certification

requirement is intended to prompt the dissemination of more

reliable and informative disclosures to the markets for

registered companies' securities.  An affirmative attestation

obligation may well succeed in accomplishing what signature

requirements alone apparently have not -- underscoring top

management's duty to monitor the accuracy and integrity of all

information contained in its corporate reports.  The Committee

recommends that a minimum of two of four designated senior

executive officers (or their functional equivalents) in a

position to influence the content and quality of a registered

company's disclosures -- the Chief Executive Officer, the Chief

Operating Officer, Chief Financial Officer, or Chief Accounting

Officer -- provide this attestation to the Commission in

connection with the filing of each Form 10-K, Form 10-Q, and

mandatory Form 8-K.-[80]-  In the Committee's view, these

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[79]-(...continued)
               Securities Act form, reasoned that "this added
               measure of discipline is vital to the disclosure
               objectives of the federal securities laws, and
               outweighs the potential impact, if any, of the
               signature on legal liability."  Annual Report
               Release, supra n.77 [45 FR at 63630].

     -[80]-    A Form 8-K must be filed in connection with any
               one of the following per se material events: (a)
               change in control of the registrant (Item 1); (b)
               acquisition or disposition of a significant amount
               of assets outside the ordinary course of business
               (Item 2); (c) bankruptcy or receivership (Item 3);
               (d) changes in registrant's certifying accountants
               (Item 4); and (e) resignations of directors (Item
               6).  The five additional mandatory 8-K line items
               that the Committee recommends the Commission
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 76======
four senior officials (or their functional equivalents) are in

the best position to ensure that the company's disclosures fully

and fairly describe the company's financial condition, results of

operations and prospects.

               b.  Management Report to the Audit Committee

     Complementing the requirement of senior management

attestation, the Committee also recommends the adoption of a

management report addressed to the audit committee of the board

of directors on mechanisms established to assure accurate and

complete Exchange Act reporting.  Specifically, the management of

registered companies should be required to prepare and submit to

the board's audit committee (or a functionally equivalent

committee, including the disclosure committee if appointed and

different from the audit committee, or in the absence of either,

the entire board) a report describing the company's practices and

procedures, if any, to assure the integrity of all periodic and

current reports filed under the Exchange Act.  This report should

also contain a description of any procedures adopted by the

company to deter and/or detect insider trading abuse.-[81]-

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[80]-(...continued)
               adopt, discussed infra at p. 55-56, also would
               trigger the proposed attestation obligation.
               However, no such obligation would result from the
               voluntary filing of a Form 8-K pursuant to Item 5
               thereof.

     -[81]-    For example, many public companies require all
               executive officers to obtain prior approval of any
               purchase or sale of company securities.  The
               Committee included this provision because of the
               belief that appropriate mechanisms to deter
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 77======
The Committee suggests that the Commission require the new report

to be filed as an exhibit to the registered company's Form 10-K.

Absent a material change in its content, the report would not

need to be refiled on an annual basis.

     While the Committee is not recommending that the Commission

compel the adoption of any specific set of procedures, public

disclosure of actual procedures used by registered companies to

ensure the integrity and quality of their Exchange Act filings

should lead to the development of a private sector set of "best

disclosure practices."   Members of the board, investors and

management of registered companies likely will explore whether

procedures followed by competitors and comparable issuers might

function to improve the quality of their own reports.  The scope

of the required "procedures" disclosure should include a detailed

description of the steps currently taken by the company to

prepare its required reports so that investors and others can

gauge the quality of the preparation procedures.

     This report would not require an assessment of the overall

adequacy of a registered company's broader system of internal

controls designed to protect and preserve the integrity of




---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[81]-(...continued)
               insider trading will increase the expected level
               of integrity of the company's public reports, and
               because the reduction in resale limitations on
               some insiders could warrant better controls and
               monitoring within a company on insider
               transactions.


==========================================START OF PAGE 78======
financial reporting, compliance with GAAP, and

operations.-[82]-  Thus, the recommendation is far narrower

than prior Commission rulemaking proposals calling for management

reports on internal controls.-[83]-  The Committee does not

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[82]-    See ABA Committee on Law and Accounting,
               "Management" Reports on Internal Control:  A Legal
               Perspective, 49 Bus. Law. 889, 920 (1994) (the
               "ABA Report") (observing that "it appears that the
               SEC and the COSO [Committee of the Sponsoring
               Organizations of the Treadway Commission, a
               private-sector group of accounting experts formed
               in 1985 to study the U.S. financial reporting
               system] believe that controls cannot be immutably
               characterized as exclusively related to just one
               category of objectives -- of operations, or
               financial reporting, or compliance -- and for this
               reason, they no longer will use the term internal
               accounting control").

     -[83]-    See Report of Management's Responsibilities,
               Securities Act Rel. 6789 (July 19, 1988) [53 FR
               28009 (July 26,1988)] (proposing a management
               report to the board of directors or its audit
               committee -- to be published in the company's Form
               10-K and annual report to shareholders -- to
               describe management's responsibilities for the
               preparation of the company's financial statements
               and other related information and for establishing
               and maintaining a system of internal controls for
               financial reporting.)  Almost a decade earlier,
               the Commission had proposed to require inclusion
               in each Form 10-K and annual report to
               securityholders (filed under the proxy/information
               statement rules) of a statement of management's
               opinion as to whether the registrant's system of
               internal accounting controls offered reasonable
               assurance that only appropriately authorized
               transactions were executed consistent with the
               books and records provisions of the Foreign
               Corrupt Practices Act of 1977 (now codified in
               Section 13(b)(2) of the Exchange Act [15 U.S.C.
               78(m)(b)(2)]), and that transactions were
               recorded as necessary to permit preparation of
               financial statements in accordance with GAAP and
               to maintain accountability for assets.  See
               Statement of Management on Internal Accounting
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 79======
believe it is necessary, and therefore recommends that the

Commission not require, senior management of registered companies

to provide a public evaluation of internal controls.  Similarly,

the Committee does not support a requirement that the report

represent that prescribed procedures were followed with respect

to the preparation of any particular filing.  Indeed, an adequate

description of procedures could recognize expressly management

discretion to depart from the standards under appropriate

circumstances.-[84]-

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[83]-(...continued)
               Control, Exchange Act Rel. 15772 (April 30, 1979)
               [44 FR 26702 (May 4, 1979)].  This proposal was
               withdrawn one year later.  Statement of Management
               on Internal Accounting Control, Exchange Act Rel.
               16877 (June 6, 1980) [45 FR 40134 (June 13,
               1980)].

     -[84]-    Some have raised concerns that public disclosure
               of the report would expose the certifying
               officials to a greater risk of private litigation
               or a Commission enforcement action.  The fact that
               a report detailing procedures for preparation of a
               document is publicly filed would not enhance a
               company's potential liability in a suit premised
               upon materially false or misleading disclosures
               made in Commission documents.  Even if viewed as
               an implicit representation to the market that the
               disclosed procedures were followed, it would be
               difficult for a plaintiff to argue that
               noncompliance with these procedures added to the
               damages suffered by investors.  Any such suit
               would be premised on a misrepresented material
               fact or material omission regarding the issuer or
               its securities, not the lack of devotion to a
               particular procedure.  Though potentially relevant
               to whether the defendant met the requisite
               standard of care or mental state, a company's
               procedures and management's compliance therewith
               likely would be discoverable whether or not those
               procedures are contained in a filed report.  The
               issuer could be liable, however, in a Commission
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 80======
     2.   Improvements in the Content and Timeliness of 1934 Act
          Reporting

     The Committee also recommends that the Commission effect

certain enhancements to the content and timeliness of corporate

disclosures provided to the markets by companies participating in

the company registration system.  These enhancements increase the

currency of disclosure of material developments relating to a

registered company, and add key information on investment risk to

the annual report on Form 10-K.

               a.  More Timely and Informative Reports on Form 8-
               K

         The Committee recommends that expansion of the current

Form 8-K reporting obligation to mandate or accelerate disclosure

of the following five additional material developments.  Of

these, two would entail no more than earlier reporting of

information already prescribed by Form 10-Q (Nos. 1 and 3,

below).  The remaining three requirements would, in many

instances, already be required to be disclosed promptly either

due to general liability concerns under antifraud

provisions-[85]- or listing requirements.-[86]-

     1.   Material modifications to rights of holders of
          registered company securities, whether favorable or
          unfavorable, now reportable only on a quarterly basis


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[84]-(...continued)
               action for a materially false or misleading filing
               if the reports were, for example, fraudulent.

     -[85]-    See Basic Inc. v. Levinson, 485 U.S. 224 (1988).

     -[86]-    See, e.g., NYSE Listed Company Manual 2.


==========================================START OF PAGE 81======
          in Form 10-Q.-[87]-  A common criticism of
          quarterly reports today is that this and other key
          information is stale by the time it reaches the broader
          investing public, whereas more sophisticated
          institutional investors and analysts obtain timely
          access to such information directly from senior
          management.  The Committee believes that more prompt
          disclosure of important changes in securityholder
          rights, such as the imposition of restrictions on (or
          cessation of) dividend payments or the elimination of
          preemptive rights, both of which currently need not be
          reported until 45 days after the end of the quarter in
          which they occur, should level any perceived
          informational imbalance among investors and improve
          market efficiency.

     2.   Resignation or removal of any of a registered company's
          five most senior executive officers, currently required
          in the Form 8-K exclusively for directors.  Because
          general principles of materiality and listing standards
          in any event often result in prompt disclosure of the
          termination of the CEO and other members of top
          management,-[88]- the creation of a bright line
          test prescribing the timing of and vehicle for such
          disclosure should not impose appreciably greater
          compliance burdens on registered companies when
          measured against the obvious investor and market
          informational benefits.

     3.   Specified material defaults upon senior securities,
          which today must be disclosed solely in Form 10-
          Q.-[89]-  For the same reasons outlined above,
          the Committee recommends that the Commission accelerate
          disclosure of this information.

     4.   Sales of a significant percentage of the company's
          outstanding equity,            whether in the form of
          common shares or convertible securities, or made on a
          registered or exempt basis.  In proposing to require
          quarterly disclosure of unregistered equity sales
          during the covered period, whether pursuant to a

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[87]-    See Item 2 of Form 10-Q.

     -[88]-    See NYSE Listed Company Manual  204.15 ("[p]rompt
               notice is required to be given to the exchange of
               any changes in directors or officers of the
               company").

     -[89]-    See Item 3 to Form 10-Q.


==========================================START OF PAGE 82======
          private placement, a Regulation S offering or
          otherwise, the Commission already has recognized the
          importance of this information to the
          markets.-[90]-  Comment was sought in the
          relevant proposing release on whether this information
          will be disclosed in a sufficiently timely manner if
          required on Form 10-Q, or instead should be reported on
          a mandatory Form 8-K or notice of sale similar to that
          used for Regulation D offerings.  The Committee
          believes that such information is material to investors
          and should be disseminated to the markets on a more
          timely basis than in a quarterly report.

     5.   The issuer's receipt of notice from its independent
          auditor that reliance on an audit report included in
          previous filings is no longer permissible because of
          the auditor's concerns with respect to the continuing
          viability of the company as a going concern or a
          variety of other matters.  Also reportable would be an
          issuer's effort to engage another auditor to reaudit a
          period covered by a prior filed audited report, whether
          due to the predecessor auditor's withdrawal of its
          consent or any other reason.  Timely disclosure of this
          information will serve to reinforce the auditor's role
          as a gatekeeper or monitor on a continuous basis, a
          principal goal of company registration.

               b.  Form 10-K Risk Disclosure

     An analysis of risks associated with investment in a

company's securities is now required in all Securities Act

filings, to the extent material.-[91]-  No such requirement

currently applies in the context of Exchange Act reporting.   As

a result, investors in the trading markets do not have access to

the company's own evaluation of the mix of material factors


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[90]-    See Streamlining Business Acquisitions Release,
               supra n.68.

     -[91]-    See Regulation S-K, Item 503 [17 C.F.R. 229.503];
               see also Regulation S-K, Item 506 [17 C.F.R.
               229.506] (dilution of existing holders),
               referenced in Forms S-1,
     S-2, S-3, and S-4, among other forms.


==========================================START OF PAGE 83======
bearing on investment risk except when the company elects to

raise capital through a public offering of securities.  This

information traditionally has been viewed as extremely useful for

both potential and existing investors.-[92]-

     The Committee believes that participating companies,

investors, and the markets, would benefit from the inclusion of

risk disclosure requirements in the annual report on Form

10-K, for those companies that currently would be required to

provide such information in a Securities Act filing.  The

Committee recognizes that for many of the companies initially

subject to the pilot, no such disclosure is currently required

and none would be required in the Exchange Act reports.  However,

where a discussion of material risk factors would be required

when the company is selling its own securities, it also should be

required when investors are purchasing the securities in the

secondary trading markets.  Provided that the mandatory risk

disclosures are not obscured or rendered materially false or

misleading, the company could (and, in fact, should be encouraged

to) amplify such disclosure with a discussion of the benefits of

ownership of a particular class of securities.  Registered

companies would gain the advantage of being able to incorporate

the risk factor analysis by reference from the Form 10-K to

satisfy line item requirements in other documents prescribed by


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[92]-    See, e.g., Jenkins Committee Report, supra n.39,
               at 29.  See also 1977 Advisory Committee Report,
               supra n.4, at 486-487.


==========================================START OF PAGE 84======
Commission rule under the Securities Act and the Exchange

Act.-[93]-  In addition, any material change in the risk

disclosure should be provided in the next Form

10-Q.







































---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[93]-    Obviously, companies could not rely on general
               disclosures in the Form
     10-K to describe the unique risks of investing in certain
     classes of complex or novel securities.  Those unique risks
     would have to be separately described, as today.


==========================================START OF PAGE 85======
     B.  Conclusion

     The Committee anticipates that the mandatory disclosure

enhancements should improve the quality of information provided

by registered companies in connection not only with episodic

securities distributions, but also disclosures made on a

continuous basis through periodic and current reports filed under

the Exchange Act.  Some members of the Committee have indicated

that they would not limit the recommendation to companies

participating in the company registration system since, in either

offerings under the shelf or recommended company registration

system, issuers can access the markets quickly without

intervention by the Commission staff.  The current universal

shelf has raised the same concerns regarding adequate opportunity

for due diligence that also have been raised with respect to

company registration.  For these reasons, some members urged that

the disclosure enhancements be made a condition to the use of the

shelf for equity offerings over a specified amount.  Put simply,

the price for this speedy, unfettered access to the markets in

the case of substantial equity offerings, whether under a shelf

or the company registration system, should be the enhancements

designed to improve the level and reliability of corporate

reports and facilitate the gatekeeping function.

     If required to comply with the disclosure enhancements and

investor protections (such as Form 8-K filing for non-de minimis

equity offerings) in order to conduct a shelf offering, there

would be little reason for current shelf issuers not to opt into


==========================================START OF PAGE 86======
the company registration system, at least the modified version,

in order to benefit from the added flexibility of the company

registration system.  Taken together, while imposing requirements

to enhance the level of disclosure and investor protection, the

resulting system would represent a significant expansion and

liberalization of the shelf procedure.

     On balance, the Committee concluded that modification of the

existing shelf registration to impose all the disclosure

enhancements is not necessary just to implement company

registration, at least on a pilot basis.  At the same time, the

Committee recommends that a Form 8-K be required for non-de

minimis equity offerings conducted on the current shelf, and that

the Commission give careful consideration to whether requiring

disclosure enhancements across the board for shelf registrants as

well, could lead to measurable improvements in the current

disclosure.

V.   Liability and Due Diligence Under Company Registration

     Company registration will preserve the current
     statutory liability provisions and, indeed, will extend
     those protections to transactions that today are
     conducted without registration, such as private
     placements and offshore offerings.  Company
     registration also will promote more effective and
     continuous due diligence.  Directors, underwriters and
     other parties with due diligence obligations will
     receive more useful guidance on their ability to
     consider, in meeting those obligations, the ongoing
     oversight of the company's disclosures conducted by
     persons who are better positioned to perform that role.



     A.   Liability Under Company Registration

          1.   Other Liability Approaches Considered


==========================================START OF PAGE 87======
     The Committee considered several liability schemes that

could be applied under a company registration system with the

goal of preserving and enhancing the gatekeepers' or monitors'

existing roles in protecting investors.  In recommending the

proposed company registration model and pilot project, the

Committee concluded that retention of the current liability

scheme, at least during the pilot stage, would maintain important

investor protections while achieving the objectives of company

registration, provided that additional guidance was furnished to

gatekeepers on the factors relevant to establishing a due

diligence defense under Sections 11 and 12(a)(2) of the

Securities Act.

     Section 11 creates strict liability for the benefit of any

purchaser of a security sold pursuant to a materially false or

misleading registration statement on offering participants

(including the issuer, officers and directors, underwriters and

experts, such as the accountants), but provides the defendants

other than the issuer with a defense based essentially upon proof

that they engaged in a reasonable investigation and had

reasonable grounds to believe in the accuracy of the

disclosure.-[94]-  Section 12(a)(2) allows purchasers to

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[94]-    Under Section 11 of the Securities Act, a lower
               standard of due diligence must be met as to
               "expertized" portions of the registration
               statement by persons other than the certifying
               expert.  The defendant invoking this affirmative
               defense must show that, "he had no reasonable
               ground to believe and did not believe, at the time
               such part of the registration statement became
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 88======
recover against their sellers (a much more narrow class than that

covered by Section 11), unless the sellers can show that they

were not negligent in failing to discover false and misleading

statements.  Remedies available pursuant to Section 12(a)(1) of

the Securities Act for Section 5 violations, as well as Sections

10 and 18 of the Exchange Act, and Rule 10b-5 adopted thereunder

for fraud, also would continue to be available in the same manner

as today under the shelf registration system.

      During the July 26, 1995 Advisory Committee Meeting, the

Committee analyzed, in addition to maintaining the current

liability scheme, the following alternatives:

     (i)  a liability structure in which issuers would incur
          Section 11 liability only for IPOs and extraordinary
          distributions, and Section 12(a)(2) liability for
          routine transactions.  Under this approach, Section
          12(a)(2) would apply to all prospectus disclosure,
          including information incorporated by reference;

     (ii) extending Sections 11 and 12(a)(2) remedies to all
          purchasers in primary offerings and in secondary market
          transactions contemporaneous with the offering.  The
          company's total liability would have been limited to
          the lesser of the dollar amount of the offering
          proceeds or damages caused.  Awarded damages then would
          be prorated among investors in the primary and
          secondary markets;

     (iii)     eliminating Section 11 liability and extending
               Section 12(a)(2) liability to all statements by
               the issuer (including those currently subject only
               to Rule

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[94]-(...continued)
               effective, that the statements therein were untrue
               or that there was an omission to state a material
               fact required to be stated therein or necessary to
               make the statements therein not misleading."
               Section 11(b)(3)(C) of the Securities Act [15
               U.S.C. 77k(b)(3)(C)].


==========================================START OF PAGE 89======
          10b-5) regardless of whether the issuer is selling
          securities or its securities are trading in the
          secondary market;-[95]- and

     (iv) limiting liability for a registered company's routine
          financings to Rule 10b-5 liability only.-[96]-


     In this regard, the Committee considered differing views on

the impact of Sections 11 and 12(a)(2).  In its analysis, the

Committee found it difficult to determine the full extent of

Section 11 litigation and the effects of Section 11 liability

exposure on issuers' financing choices.  According to several

commenters, there are few reported cases actually decided on

Section 11 grounds,-[97]- but in meetings with industry

representatives the Committee staff was informed that a

significant number of potential Section 11 claims are settled

without actions being instituted or without reported

decisions.-[98]-

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[95]-    For a discussion of a somewhat similar liability
               scheme in which a negligence standard like Section
               12(a)(2) would be extended to Exchange Act
               documents, and consequently a civil remedy would
               be available for purchasers of a company's
               securities in the open market as well as in
               capital raisings, see Margaret Bancroft,
               Responding to Gustafson: Company Registration and
               a New Negligence Standard, INSIGHTS, July 1995, at
               14.

     -[96]-    See Documents for Advisory Committee Meeting, July
               26, 1995, Tab C.

     -[97]-    Transcript of July 26, 1995 Advisory Committee
               Meeting at 287 (statements of Commissioner Wallman
               and Professor Coffee).

     -[98]-    Some have suggested, however, that Section 11(e)'s
               requirement of an undertaking for the payment of
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 90======
     Notwithstanding the absence of dispositive evidence of the

effect of Section 11 on disclosure practices and an issuer's

choice of whether to engage in a public or private offering, it

is the Committee's view that Section 11 liability continues to

play an integral role in compelling "truth in securities."

Congress explicitly recognized the importance of the role of

underwriters and other monitors in the offering process by

including them in the group of persons potentially liable for

omissions or misstatements in registration statements.  As Milton

Cohen stated, the liability provisions have "had the in terrorem

effect of creating an extraordinarily high sense of care and

responsibility in the preparation of registration

statements."-[99]-  Consequently, the Committee believed

that Section 11 should continue to be applied under a company

registration system in a manner similar to its current

application.-[100]-

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[98]-(...continued)
               litigation costs if the court determines the suit
               or defense to be without merit and the difficulty
               faced by purchasers in the open market of tracing
               the securities back to the registration statement
               in question act as an impediment to Section 11
               suits. See Edward F. Greene, Determining the
               Responsibilities of Underwriters Distributing
               Securities Within an Integrated Disclosure System,
               56 Notre Dame L. Rev. 755, 770 n.90 (1981).

     -[99]-    Cohen, supra n.2, at 1355.

     -[100]-   It also has been suggested that the Committee
               should urge the Commission to express disagreement
               with the well-established policy against
               indemnification of underwriters for Section 11
               liability, at least in the context of shelf and
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 91======
          2.   Preservation and Expansion of Statutory Liability

     During the pilot stage, purchasers in offerings by

registered companies would have recourse pursuant to Section 11

to the same extent as under the current liability system.

Issuers, officers, directors, experts, and underwriters would be

subject to Section 11 liability for false or misleading

statements in the Form C-1, including all incorporated

information filed in Exchange Act reports.  Indeed, for those

issuers that elect to take full advantage of the system and

register all of their securities issuances, the Section 11 remedy

would be available to purchasers in private placement

transactions that otherwise would be exempt  under the current

system.  Similarly, U.S. purchasers of securities initially

issued overseas in offerings that today would qualify for the

Regulation S safe harbor, would under full company registration

have Section 11 remedies against the issuer to the extent the

flowback is registered and the U.S. purchaser can trace the

purchased securities back to the company registration statement.

Moreover, again under full company registration, because all

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[100]-(...continued)
               company registration offerings.  See Documents for
               Advisory Committee Meeting, November 21, 1995, Tab
               E (Letter dated November 2, 1995 from the
               Securities Industry Association to the Advisory
               Committee at 9-10) (the "SIA Letter").  The
               Committee has determined to make no recommendation
               either way concerning this issue.  The current
               statutory provision for contribution, however,
               provides in essence for economic indemnification
               with respect to almost all of a potential claim
               against an underwriter.


==========================================START OF PAGE 92======
affiliate resales (except those that continue to be effected

under Rule 144) are registered on the Form C-1 rather than sold

in exempt transactions, Section 11 liability would apply with

respect to each such sale.  Likewise, broker-dealer underwriting

firms participating in a registered company's offering would

remain subject to Sections 11 and 12(a)(2) liability.

     In addition, under the shelf registration system, issuers

may provide transactional disclosure, including material updating

information, in a prospectus supplement rather than by means of a

filing included in the registration statement.  As a result,

investors are denied the core protections of Section 11 regarding

such information.  As the Commission has noted, "Section 11

ordinarily does not apply to statements omitted from an effective

registration statement and subsequently disclosed in a prospectus

or prospectus supplement, rather than a post-effective

amendment."-[101]-  The pilot will make Section 11 more

effective than today (both for company registration and shelf

offerings, if the Form 8-K requirement is extended to the shelf),

since the transactional information disclosed in a Form 8-K filed

at the commencement of non-de minimis equity offerings must be


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[101]-   Elimination of Certain Pricing Amendments and
               Revision of Prospectus Filing Procedures,
               Securities Act Rel. 6672 (Oct. 27, 1986) [51 FR
               39868 (November 3, 1986)].  But cf. Shaw v.
               Digital Equipment Corp., 82 F.3d 1194 (1st Cir.
               1996) (though not discussing issue, allowing
               Section 11 (along with Section 12(a)(2)) claim
               predicated on prospectus supplement on motion to
               dismiss).


==========================================START OF PAGE 93======
incorporated into the registration statement and thus would be

covered by Section 11.-[102]-  In addition, the

opportunity to avoid preparing and delivering a separate

prospectus by incorporating by reference into sales literature or

the confirmation of sale, transactional information filed in an

Exchange Act report will provide an incentive for issuers to file

that information on a Form 8-K, even when not required.  In

connection with further implementation of the company

registration system, including extending the system to a broader

class of issuers, the Commission could consider whether it is

necessary to extend full Section 11 liability to the information

provided at the time of an offering under the company

registration system, regardless of whether filed with the

Commission on a Form 8-K or in a prospectus supplement delivered

to investors.

     With respect to Section 12(a)(2), some have expressed the

view that one of the reasons companies may choose to raise

capital in the private markets is the differential liability

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[102]-   Reports filed under the Exchange Act automatically
               become part of the registration statement and thus
               are subject to Section 11 liability. See Wielgos
               v. Commonwealth Edison, 688 F.Supp. 331, 338-40
               (N.D. Ill. 1988).  However, unless the information
               represents a fundamental change in the information
               previously provided in the registration statement,
               the report will not have the legal effect of a
               post-effective amendment or a new registration
               statement or change the effective date for
               liability purposes. See Regulation S-K Item 512(a)
               [17 C.F.R. 229.512(a)]; Irving Bank Corp. v. Bank
               of N.Y. Co., Inc., 692 F. Supp. 172, 176-80
               (S.D.N.Y. 1988).


==========================================START OF PAGE 94======
standards between the negligence standard of liability in Section

12(a)(2) and the strict liability standard of Section

11.-[103]-  After Gustafson, it would appear that only

Rule 10b-5 liability may attach to private placements, although

it is unclear what impact the decision will have on the number or

dollar volume of private placements.

     The Committee believes that Rule 10b-5 liability will

continue to provide significant deterrence to fraud in private

placements,-[104]- and that Section 12(a)(2) should

continue to be applied as under current law.  To the extent an

issuer chooses to register transactions under company

registration that otherwise would qualify as exempt private

placements, the effect of the Gustafson decision on the

applicability of Section 12(a)(2) should be minimized since both

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[103]-   Gustafson v. Alloyd Co., 115 S.Ct. 106 (1995).
               Prior to Gustafson, most practitioners and the
               Commission believed that Section 12(a)(2)
               liability applied to secondary market transactions
               and exempt offerings.   As a result, due diligence
               for private offerings tended to be as extensive as
               it is for public offerings (see, e.g., Robert F.
               Quaintance Jr., Getting Comfortable with 'Public-
               Style' Rule 144A Offerings', INSIGHTS, September
               1993, at 8).  In its extreme application,
               Gustafson would mean that Section 12(a)(2) does
               not apply to private placements.  As a result,
               although underwriting techniques in the Rule 144A
               market closely resemble that of a public offering,
               including the absence of negotiations and an
               opportunity for individual due diligence,
               purchasers would not receive any of the statutory
               protections of a public offering.

     -[104]-   Transcript of September 29, 1995 Advisory
               Committee Meeting at 27-29 (statements of Mr.
               Sonsini).


==========================================START OF PAGE 95======
Section 11 and Section 12(a)(2) would be applicable.  In

addition, to the extent that an issuer chooses to use selling

materials as the statutory prospectus by incorporating filed

information from the Form 8-K, Section 12(a)(2), rather than Rule

10b-5, would apply to those selling materials.

     B.   Due Diligence Under Company Registration

     The Commission's development of the integrated disclosure

system over the last decade and a half has shifted the primary

source of key disclosures concerning the company from the

sporadic or infrequent disclosures contained in public offering

documents under the Securities Act to the updated reservoirs of

information regarding a company contained in Exchange Act

reports.  The gatekeepers have tried to adapt to these changes

since the inception of the integrated disclosure system.  The

underwriter community, in particular, has voiced longstanding

concerns regarding the impact of these reforms on traditional due

diligence functions.-[105]-   The Committee is

cognizant of the concerns raised by underwriters and outside

directors that market changes have altered the dynamics and

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[105]-   See SIA Letter, supra n.100 (recommending that the
               Committee and the Commission consider recommending
               amendments to Section 11 with respect to
               underwriters to eliminate the requirement that, in
               establishing their due diligence defense, they
               prove that they made a reasonable investigation);
               see also American Bar Association Committee on
               Federal Regulation of Securities, Report of the
               Task Force on Sellers' Due Diligence and Similar
               Defenses Under the Federal Securities Laws, 48
               Bus. Law. 1185 (May 1993) (the "ABA Due Diligence
               Report").


==========================================START OF PAGE 96======
nature of their relationships with issuers and, consequently,

their traditional due diligence functions.  In particular, the

Committee acknowledges that the tightened time constraints may

make it more difficult for underwriters and outside directors to

discharge their due diligence obligations.  In order to protect

investors by maintaining the integrity of the disclosure system,

the Committee has concluded that continued emphasis on the due

diligence obligations of underwriters and outside directors is

critical to maintaining and increasing investor protection.

Moreover, between the choices of simply limiting liability for

participants versus providing reasonable procedures so that

participants can better perform their due diligence obligations

and, therefore, as a practical matter limit their exposure by

reducing the opportunity for material misstatements to be

disseminated to the public, the Committee strongly prefers the

latter.

     Following the lead of the ABA Task Force appointed to study

due diligence practices under integrated disclosure and shelf

registration,-[106]- the Committee determined that, rather

than excusing monitors from their due diligence responsibilities,

more guidance regarding their respective responsibilities should

be furnished by the Commission.  The Committee recommends

providing additional guidance, within the framework of current

Commission Rule 176, that would elaborate upon the factors courts


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[106]-   See ABA Due Diligence Report, supra note 105.


==========================================START OF PAGE 97======
may consider as indicia of "reasonable investigation" and/or

"reasonable care" for purposes of determining whether the

particular defendant has met its due diligence obligations under

Sections 11 and 12(a)(2) in the context of an offering made under

the company registration system.-[107]-  The Committee

determined not to recommend that additional Commission guidance

regarding the due diligence function take the form of a safe

harbor from liability or an evidentiary presumption.  The

Committee agrees with the district court in Escott v. BarChris,

which stated that "[i]t is impossible to lay down a rigid rule

suitable for every case defining the extent to which such

verification must go.  It is a question of degree, a matter of

judgment in each case."-[108]-

     To the extent changes in the offering process require

greater reliance on other gatekeepers in order to deter fraud and

provide incentives for the highest quality disclosures, the

Committee believes that underwriters and outside directors should


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[107]-   The ABA Due Diligence Report recommends extension
               of Rule 176's enumeration of "relevant
               circumstances" to an underwriter's or agent's
               exercise of "reasonable care" under Section
               12(a)(2).  See id.

     Notably, Section 12(a)(2) does not refer to the need for a
     "reasonable investigation," and consequently raises the
     question about whether Congress intended to require a lesser
     standard of care.  For a discussion of legislative history
     and case law on whether different levels of due diligence
     are required, see id. at 1190.

     -[108]-   Escott v. BarChris Construction Corporation, 283
               F. Supp. 643, 697 (S.D.N.Y. 1968).


==========================================START OF PAGE 98======
be able to take the efforts of those other persons into account

in evaluating the appropriate due diligence they should perform

at the time of the offering.  This facts and circumstances

approach to due diligence was embraced by the Commission when it

adopted Rule 176 in response to identical concerns raised by the

underwriting community and others when the integrated disclosure

system was implemented in 1982:

     For example, the Commission believes that a court would not
     expect the investigation undertaken in connection with a
     short form registration of a seasoned company to be the same
     as that which would be reasonable in connection with an
     initial public offering.-[109]-

     Under the recommended approach, as under current Rule 176,

persons who are eligible for the due diligence/reasonable care

defenses codified in Sections 11 and 12(a)(2), respectively,

could consider the due diligence inquiries of those persons in

the best position on an ongoing basis to oversee the quality and

accuracy of the requisite disclosure in determining the degree of

due diligence investigation they themselves need to perform to

satisfy their statutory obligation.  As under current Rule 176,

the factors are meant to be illustrative, not exhaustive, and the

weight given to each factor necessarily must vary with the facts

and circumstances of a particular offering, including whether the

offering is a routine financing, or involves equity or debt.  As

outlined below, this guidance should create incentives for those


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[109]-   Securities Act Release No. 6383 (March 3, 1982),
               note 101 [47 FR 113800, 11400 n.101]; SIA Letter,
               supra n.100, at 9.


==========================================START OF PAGE 99======
engaging in due diligence to make better use of others who are in

a position to help ensure the quality and integrity of the

disclosure -- to the ultimate benefit of investors.

     The Committee believes SAS No. 71 interim financial reviews

by the company's outside auditor to be particularly relevant in

this context.-[110]-  By recognizing the appropriateness

of an underwriter's and outside director's reliance on those

reviews in discharging their due diligence duties, the Commission

will encourage registered companies to involve this outside

monitor more extensively and on a more continuous basis with

unaudited information.  As a result, widespread use of interim

reviews should increase investor confidence in the quality of

quarterly reporting.

     Comfort letters provided by the company's outside auditing

firm to the underwriters in accordance with SAS No. 72 also may

be relevant.  Although the legal effect of an auditor's comfort

letter necessarily varies with the audited or non-audited

character of the underlying financial information, and the letter

alone normally will not be determinative of whether a reasonable

investigation was conducted, such a letter nevertheless adds

important independent oversight of the issuer's financial

reporting in connection with an offering.  Consequently, the

receipt of a comfort letter appropriately should be recognized as

a factor to be weighed in evaluating how a gatekeeper must


---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[110]-   See supra pp. 24-28.


==========================================START OF PAGE 100======
perform its due diligence in order to discharge its

responsibilities under all the relevant facts and circumstances.

          1.   Underwriters

     Although underwriters would not be relieved of

responsibility for the accuracy and completeness of the issuer's

disclosure, their review at the time of the offering should be

facilitated by the continuous review conducted by other monitors

as well as the enhanced disclosure practices recommended by the

Committee.-[111]-  This assistance would be in addition to

the other recommendations of the Committee, such as the filing of

a Form 8-K at the time of the offering, that are intended in part

to facilitate the underwriter's due diligence review at the time

of most equity offerings.-[112]-  The underwriters'

ability to confer with other persons familiar with the issuer as

well as with management to assess the scope of their review

preserves the underwriters' central, independent role in ensuring

the quality of disclosures regarding the securities they bring to

market.  Accordingly, the Committee determined that (in addition

to the factors in the current Rule 176) the relevant factors to

be considered in connection with the underwriter's due diligence

defense should include the following:

          (i)  The Senior Management Certifications (described
               above);

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[111]-   Transcript of September 29, 1995 Advisory
               Committee Meeting at 189-194 (statements of Mr.
               Sutton and Mr. Elliott).

     -[112]-   See supra p. 23-24.


==========================================START OF PAGE 101======
          (ii) The Management Report to the Audit Committee
               (described above);

          (iii)     Whether other outside professionals have
                    reviewed the relevant documents, for example,
                    pursuant to a review of the issuer's interim
                    financial statements by the company's
                    auditors in accordance with SAS No. 71, the
                    performance of procedures with respect to
                    events subsequent to the date of the audited
                    financial statements in accordance with SAS
                    No. 37, and the receipt of a "comfort letter"
                    under SAS No. 72, or whether the board or a
                    committee of the board received a Rule 10b-5
                    opinion letter from counsel regarding the
                    non-financial and non-expertized portions of
                    the periodic reports;

          (iv) The extent of the underwriter's access to their
               own or outside analysts that have followed the
               issuer for a significant period of
               time;-[113]-

          (v)  Whether a board disclosure committee was appointed
               and the quality of the review engaged in by the
               disclosure committee; and

          (vi) The size of the offering, both in absolute and
               relative terms, vis-a-vis the size of the issuer.


     Ultimately, however, underwriters bringing offerings to

market will continue to have significant responsibility for the

disclosures used in connection with that offering.  Even apart

from the potential for civil liability under Sections 11 and

12(a)(2), an underwriter has a legal obligation under the

antifraud provisions of the federal securities laws to have a

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[113]-   See Circumstances Affecting the Determination of
               What Constitutes Reasonable Investigation and
               Reasonable Grounds for Belief Under Section 11 of
               the Securities Act; Treatment of Information
               Incorporated by Reference Into Registration
               Statements, Securities Act Rel. 6335 (Aug. 6,
               1981) [46 FR 42015 (August 18, 1981)].


==========================================START OF PAGE 102======
reasonable basis for its recommendations and its belief in the

accuracy of the statements contained in the offering

materials.-[114]-  As a result, notwithstanding the

comfort afforded by the proposed guidance regarding the due

diligence defense, the underwriter must take care to ensure that

it has performed all the procedures and investigations necessary

to form a reasonable basis for its belief regarding the accuracy

and adequacy of the issuer's disclosures.

          2.   Outside Directors

     Certain Committee members expressed particular concern about

exposing outside directors to greater liability under the company

registration system.-[115]-  The Committee believes that

outside directors of public corporations currently are not always

properly positioned to perform a full investigative function.

For example, because of timing constraints characteristic of

shelf takedowns, outside directors may not have sufficient time

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[114]-   See In re Donaldson, Lufkin & Jenrette Securities
               Corporation, Securities Act Rel. 6959 (Sept. 22,
               1992); Justin Klein, Underwriter Beware: SEC
               Brings Proceeding for Failure to Conduct Adequate
               Due Diligence, INSIGHTS, March 1993, at 17.   See
               also Exchange Act Rule 15c2-12 (Municipal
               Securities Disclosure) [17 C.F.R. 240.15c2-12];
               Municipal Securities Disclosure, Exchange Act Rel.
               26100 (September 22, 1988) [53 FR 37778 (September
               28, 1988)]; Municipal Securities Disclosure,
               Exchange Act Rel. 26985 (June 28, 1989) [54 FR
               28799 (July 10, 1989)].

     -[115]-   See, e.g., Transcript of July 26, 1995 Advisory
               Committee Meeting at 247-52 (statements of
               Professor Coffee); Concurring Statement of John C.
               Coffee, Jr., Edward F. Greene and Lawrence W.
               Sonsini.


==========================================START OF PAGE 103======
to review any disclosure documents other than the Form 10-Ks.

Frequent, repetitive equity takedowns, such as those effected

pursuant to the at-the-market provisions of the shelf rules, may

pose difficult problems for outside directors.-[116]-  The

potential extension of director liability under Section 11 to

transactions that today would be conducted as exempt private

placements could exacerbate those concerns for outside directors.

     Outside directors, however, also are almost uniquely

positioned to maintain continuous oversight of the company's

disclosures, provided a practical mechanism were established to

permit them to do so.  The audit committee is an obvious example

of such an initiative to formalize the role of outside directors.


The Committee sought similar approaches to strengthen the role of

outside directors in the disclosure process in order to ensure

that the promise of appropriate outside director gatekeeping

could be realized.  As discussed previously, the establishment of

a disclosure committee would provide such a formal mechanism for

outside directors to accomplish that goal.  The Committee also

believes that the outside directors, like the underwriters,

should be able to consider management certifications and reports,

and the preparation or review of relevant documents by various

independent professionals, in determining the appropriate level

of due diligence necessary to satisfy the directors' statutory

obligation.  Specifically, the Committee determined that, in

addition to the factors in current Rule 176, the relevant factors
---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[116]-   See n. 79 to Appendix A to the Report.


==========================================START OF PAGE 104======
that courts should consider in connection with an outside

director's establishment of a due diligence defense should

include, but not be limited to, the following:

           (i) The Senior Management Certifications (described
               above);

          (ii) The Management Report to the Audit Committee
               (described above); and

            (iii)   Whether outside professionals have reviewed
                    the relevant documents, for example, pursuant
                    to a review of the issuer's interim financial
                    statements by the company's auditors in
                    accordance with SAS No. 71 and a "comfort
                    letter" under SAS No. 72, or whether the
                    board or a committee of the board received a
                    10b-5 opinion letter from counsel regarding
                    the non-financial and non-expertized portions
                    of the periodic reports.

     C.   Conclusion

     The Committee has determined to preserve, and in the case of

all non-de minimis equity offerings expand, the current Section

11 and 12(a)(2) liability scheme and to provide additional

guidance regarding due diligence defenses.  The pilot gives the

Commission a meaningful opportunity to test the company

registration system while monitoring the effects on participants

of continued exposure to current standards of liability.  If

experience with the pilot demonstrates that more concrete

guidance is appropriate, the Commission could consider further

measures in connection with steps towards final implementation of

the company registration system.   The Committee thus encourages

the Commission during the pilot stage to monitor the due

diligence practices that evolve generally from the use of company

registration, and specifically from the application of the new


==========================================START OF PAGE 105======
guidance, and to evaluate the consequences for due diligence and

investor protection.

==========================================START OF PAGE 1======



                SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
                      ADVISORY COMMITTEE ON
          THE CAPITAL FORMATION AND REGULATORY PROCESSES

                       TERM SHEET FOR PILOT
                   COMPANY REGISTRATION SYSTEM

Goals

     The goals of the company registration system are to:

     (i) maintain and enhance the protection of investors in the
     primary markets;

     (ii) eliminate unnecessary regulatory costs and
     uncertainties that impede a company's access to capital;

     (iii) eliminate complexities arising from the need to
     distinguish between public and private, domestic and
     offshore, and issuer and non-issuer transactions; and

     (iv) enhance the level and reliability of disclosure
     provided to investors in the secondary markets on an ongoing
     basis, not just when the issuer conducts a public offering.

Concept

     Registration is company, not transaction-based (except for
     IPOs and other specific transactions).  Once meeting
     eligibility standards, companies register with the SEC and
     file periodic reports.  Routine financings, as well as
     resales by affiliates and resales of what are currently
     known as restricted securities, could be consummated without
     the current SEC review and registration process.
     Information provided to investors in the marketing of these
     routine financings would be based on what the market demands
     and on company and transactional information required to be
     filed as part of the issuer's periodic reports.  The
     principal distinctions currently existing between public and
     nonpublic offerings by registered companies (with the
     resultant formalities and restrictive concepts such as gun-
     jumping and integration) would be eliminated, because offers
     and sales by companies already registered with the SEC
     generally would not be subject to additional transactional
     registration requirements.


==========================================START OF PAGE 2======


Essential Elements of the Pilot System

1.   Disclosure

     (a) Company Registration Statement  An eligible company may
     file a Form  C-1 registration statement disclosing plans to
     make offerings from time to time on a company-registered
     basis and registering all sales of all securities.-[1]-
     Form C-1 generically registers the types of securities and
     offerings (including resales by affiliates and statutory
     underwriters, see Section 1(e) below) that are contemplated
     and incorporates all existing and future periodic reports.
     Certain exemptions or exclusions from the registration form
     would be available (see Section 3(b) below).  Amendments can
     be filed to reflect changed plans as appropriate (e.g.,
     where a company changes the manner of financing or amends
     its charter to authorize a new class of securities).  The
     Form C-1 registration statement also is updated
     automatically by each filing under the Exchange Act.  Only a
     nominal registration fee would be paid at the time of
     filing, with the issuer undertaking to pay a fee upon the
     sale of securities (i.e., pay as you go).-[2]-

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[1]-     A company could effect its transition to the
               company registration system from the current
               system simply by electing to be governed under and
               complying with the company registration system
               requirements.  To the extent the company currently
               has restricted securities outstanding, the company
               could elect, as part of its transition to a
               company registration system, to register any or
               all of its outstanding restricted securities for
               resale on the Form C-1 (and pay the applicable fee
               and execute a qualified indenture in the case of
               debt securities at that time) or merely allow the
               restricted securities to retain that status until
               the expiration of the Rule 144 restricted periods
               (three years, but recently proposed to be
               shortened to two years; limited resales allowed
               after two years, recently proposed to be shortened
               to one year).

     -[2]-     There are various mechanisms to achieve this
               result within the current statutory framework:
               Once the Form C-1 has becomes effective, it could
               serve as an evergreen registration statement for
               offers and sales of securities.  Alternatively,
               the effective date of the Form C-1 with respect to
               a specific offering could be delayed until an
                                                   (continued...)


==========================================START OF PAGE 3======

     (b) File and Go    Sales could be consummated upon the
     filing with the Commission of disclosure regarding the
     specific offering of securities and the payment of a
     transaction-based fee.  (Prospectus delivery requirements




































---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[2]-(...continued)
               amendment is filed regarding that transaction.
               Another alternative would be to have the Form C-1
               go effective upon filing, but require another
               abbreviated registration statement to be filed at
               the time of the transaction.  In any case, the
               Form C-1 could serve as the basis for multiple
               offerings, applicable statutes of limitation
               periods would run commencing from the time of
               sales made under the form, and the fee would be
               paid at the time of the particular sale.


==========================================START OF PAGE 4======

     are discussed below.)  The transactional information would
     consist of the following, to the extent material and
     otherwise not previously disclosed:

          description of securities/pricing
          plan of distribution, experts, and underwriter
information
          summary financial and dilution information/pro formas
          actual use of proceeds
          risk factors
          material changes

     Thus, at least the same level of public disclosure on file
     with the Commission concerning registered offerings that
     currently exists today for seasoned issuers would be
     maintained under a company registration scheme.

     The manner in which the transactional information could be
     filed with the Commission will depend on the nature of the
     offering.  In equity offerings (including offerings of
     convertible debt and warrants) over the specified threshold
     (e.g., 3 percent of public float), the issuer would file a
     Form    8-K, which would be incorporated into the
     registration statement.  The Committee recommends that this
     requirement apply to non-de minimis equity shelf offerings
     by non-company registrants as well.  The purpose for the
     Form 8-K filing is to facilitate due diligence inquiries by
     underwriters and other offering participants, and to ensure
     full coverage of Section 11 statutory liability to this
     information, which would automatically be incorporated into
     the registration statement.  The Form 8-K would be filed a
     reasonable time in advance of the offering (as specified by
     Commission rule, e.g., one to three business days), where
     necessary to provide the market with adequate notice of
     material developments.  The transactional information need
     not be filed on a Form    8-K until the time of the
     offering.

     With respect to all other offerings, the issuer will have a
     choice regarding the manner in which the transactional
     disclosure will be filed with the Commission.  The issuer
     could voluntarily file a Form 8-K, as described above;
     alternatively, the issuer could merely file the prospectus
     supplement containing the required information when that
     information is delivered to investors.  The information
     contained in the prospectus supplement normally would not be
     part of the registration statement.  This latter method of
     filing is consistent with practice under shelf registration
     today.  Neither the Form 8-K nor the prospectus supplement
     normally would be subject to prereview prior to the
     commencement of the offering.


==========================================START OF PAGE 5======

     Consistent with current practice relating to shelf
     offerings, information representing a fundamental change in
     the information regarding the issuer previously disclosed by
     the issuer would be made by an amendment the Form C-1 or by
     a Form 8-K or other Exchange Act filing; a prospectus
     supplement disclosing the fundamental change alone would not
     suffice.  Other types of material developments, however,
     could be provided either in the Form 8-K Exchange Act filing
     prior to the offering or as part of the prospectus
     supplement, as described above.  In either case, the
     issuer's public disclosures must be current at the time of
     the offering.

     (c)  Auditor's Consent  Consistent with current practice
     under the shelf registration system, an auditor's consent
     would not have to be filed with each sale or takedown off
     the company registration statement.  An auditor's consent to
     the use of its report would be dated as of or shortly before
     the effective date of the registration statement (as updated
     for the filing of audited financial statements on Form 10-K
     or other fundamental changes) and would have to be on file
     at the time of the offering.  The auditor could consent to
     incorporation of its audit report into the company
     registration statement at the time the Form 10-K containing
     its audit report is filed by including a currently dated
     consent in the Form 10-K.  That consent (as of the
     registration statement's effective date), unless withdrawn
     by the auditor, would be applicable to all offerings
     pursuant to the Form C-1 until the issuance of a new set of
     audited financial statements or other fundamental changes
     that update the effective date of the registration
     statement.  Alternatively, the consent could be filed and
     currently dated for a specific issuance of securities or
     conditions could be attached to its use.

     (d) Prospectus Delivery  Delivery of the transactional
     information could be accomplished either by incorporation by
     reference or by actual delivery, depending on the size of
     the offering and other factors.  The prospectus would not be
     subject to prior staff review except in the case of
     "extraordinary securities transactions," as defined below.
     These different levels of transactions essentially fall into
     three tiers:

     Tier One: In "routine" transactions, an issuer could
               incorporate information contained in the Form C-1
               registration statement and filed reports,
               including the transactional information filed on a
               Form 8-K, into a document serving as the
               prospectus, such as the confirmation or selling
               materials, that is then distributed to investors,


==========================================START OF PAGE 6======

               thereby satisfying in any of these  cases the
               prospectus delivery requirement.

               Any material company developments to be
               incorporated must be filed on the Form 8-K a
               reasonable time prior to the dissemination of the
               prospectus incorporating the information (e.g.,
               one to three business days) to provide the market
               an opportunity to absorb the information.
               Otherwise, as today, the information must be
               delivered physically as part of the formal
               prospectus, which is filed simultaneously with the
               Commission.

     Tier Two: In "nonroutine" transactions, the issuer would be
               required to prepare and deliver a formal
               prospectus containing transactional and, where
               appropriate to update disclosures, company
               information.  The prospectus would be filed (in
               addition to or as part of the mandated Form 8-K in
               non-de minimis equity offerings) with, but would
               not be subject to registration or prior review by,
               the SEC.-[3]- Information previously provided
               in selling materials or in a formal prospectus
               need not be redelivered.

               Nonroutine transactions would consist of any
               single transaction increasing, or potentially
               increasing, the issuer's outstanding voting
               securities by more than 20%. The  Commission could
               adopt a similar standard for offerings of other
               equity and senior securities.

               The offering of a new class of securities would
               require actual delivery of information specific to
               that security (e.g., terms and description of the
               security, investment risks specific to that
               security).

               Actual delivery of information generally of
               interest only to purchasers in the offering and
               not the market (such as  underwriter discount
               information or security specific information)
               could be provided as part of the confirmation.

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[3]-     However, other than in the case of underwritten
               offerings for cash, exchange listing requirements
               would require shareholder approval of these
               offerings, thus creating an opportunity for SEC
               review of the disclosure materials under the proxy
               rules.


==========================================START OF PAGE 7======

               In those cases where formal prospectus delivery is
               mandated, the prospectus must be delivered prior
               to the investors agreement to purchase.

               To the extent written selling materials that do
               not satisfy prospectus disclosure requirements are
               distributed to investors in the course of the
               offering, a prospectus containing the mandated
               information would have to be delivered prior to or
               simultaneous with the selling materials,
               consistent with current statutory and regulatory
               requirements.  An issuer could avoid delivery of a
               statutory prospectus by either including or
               incorporating the required information into the
               selling materials and treating the selling
               materials as the statutory prospectus.  That
               approach, however, would subject those materials
               to liability under Section 12(2) of the Act.

               Actual delivery of the prospectus information
               would not be required in the case of sales to
               accredited investor purchasers, with the
               expectation that these investors will demand the
               information they require.  This would be
               consistent with the requirements under Regulation
               D and Rule 144A today.

     Tier Three:    In "extraordinary transactions," a post-
                    effective amendment to the Form C-1 would be
                    required and would be subject to SEC staff
                    review of the transactional information.  The
                    same prospectus delivery requirements as in
                    Tier Two transactions would apply.

               These transactions would include any financing,
               merger, material acquisition or other
               restructuring transaction involving a company's
               issuance of securities that results in an
               increase, or potential increase, of at least 40%
               of the outstanding voting securities.


     (e)  Affiliate and Underwriter Sales  In cases where all
     sales by an issuer are registered on the Form C-1, there is
     a far reduced concern about the potential use of conduits as
     a means to distribute unregistered shares into the market.
     Accordingly, in the case where an issuer elects to cover all
     sales under the company registration statement, a more


==========================================START OF PAGE 8======

     narrow application of the registration and resale
     requirements would apply.-[4]-

          The class of persons subject to the affiliate resale
          limitations would include only the CEO and inside
          directors and, as a rebuttable presumption, perhaps
          holders of 20% of the voting power, or 10% of the
          voting power with at least one director representative
          on the board, and any representatives of such holders.

          These affiliates could continue to sell without
          registration under the existing provisions in Rule 144
          for affiliate sales.  Sales by these affiliates
          exceeding the Rule 144 limits would be registered as
          resales under the Form C-1.  An issuer could control
          the sales of affiliates by declining to file a
          prospectus supplement or a Form 8-K to complete the
          registration process at the time of the secondary
          offering (just as an issuer can refuse to grant
          registration rights under the current system).
          Significant shareholders could resell without
          restrictions if they can rebut the presumption of
          control arising from their holdings.   Contractual
          resale restrictions also would provide a means for an
          issuer to control resale activities of its insiders and
          significant shareholders.

          Resales by statutory underwriters for issuers and
          affiliates would be registered under the Form C-1.  A
          statutory underwriter for the purpose of offerings
          registered under the Form C-1 would consist of a person
          engaged in the business of a broker-dealer (regardless
          of whether or not registered as such) acting on behalf
          of an issuer or affiliate in a distribution.

2.   Eligible companies

     The system would be phased in and made available on an
     experimental basis.  The pilot would be voluntary; eligible
     companies could elect to opt in as desired.  It would begin
     with larger, more seasoned issuers eligible to elect to be
     covered.  Once the election is made, a company can opt out

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[4]-     An issuer also may elect to maintain the current
               private placement exemption for sales of equity
               securities (see Section 3(b)(iii) below).  If an
               issuer elects to maintain such exemption, the
               current applicability of the affiliate and
               statutory underwriter resale limitations, as
               opposed to the narrower approach as described
               herein, would continue to apply.


==========================================START OF PAGE 9======

     by withdrawing the Form C-1, but would not be eligible to
     use the Form again for a period of two years.  During the
     pilot stage, eligibility would be limited to a senior class
     of S-3 companies-[5]- that have a

          (a)  Public float of $75 million;

          (b)  Reporting experience of two years; and

          (c)  NYSE, Amex or NMS listings.

               This final requirement would provide the benefit:

               (i)  of adding an overlay of listing standards,
                    including the agreement to provide prompt
                    disclosure of material developments; and

               (ii) of minimizing the amount of coordination with
                    the states necessary to implement the pilot
                    stage due to the common Blue Sky exemption
                    for offerings by listed companies.

     These standards collectively reduce the number of companies
     eligible to use the Form C-1 during the pilot stage to
     approximately 30% of public companies.

     A subsidiary of an eligible company could issue debt that is
     guaranteed in full by the parent under the parent's Form C-
     1.

     Closed-end investment companies would not be eligible.

     Foreign issuers would be eligible for the pilot if they
     undertake to file the same forms and meet the same
     requirements as domestic companies.  The Commission should
     consider whether reconciled interim financials filed on Form
     6-K on a semi-annual basis should suffice (this is the
     current practice for foreign issuers using the shelf on Form
     F-3).

     To be eligible, issuers must undertake to adopt measures
     that would enhance secondary market disclosure (as discussed
     below in Section 4).  Noncompliance with the conditions as
     of the time of the Form 10-K update would result in the loss
     of eligibility (for two years) to make offerings pursuant to

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[5]-     S-3 companies generally include only those that
               have a $75 million public float; one-year
               reporting history; and are current with respect to
               their reporting requirements and certain fixed
               obligations.


==========================================START OF PAGE 10======

     the Form C-1.  In addition, the issuer must be current with
     respect to its Exchange Act filing obligations before
     commencing an offering off the Form C-1.

     Eventually, the system would be made available to all
     publicly held companies (that have engaged in an IPO), but
     with additional enhancements or conditions, including
     prospectus delivery, pre-sale notice or filing requirements,
     prereview annual financial information, etc.

3.   Transactions Covered

     As noted, the Form C-1 registration statement would register
     all sales of all securities made by the issuer or its
     affiliates (subject to exceptions and exclusions as
     discussed below, see in particular Section 3(b)
     below).-[6]-  Since sales made subject to the Form C-1
     would be registered, the securities would be freely
     tradeable.

          Thus, under the proposed system, registered companies
          would waive transactional exemptions such as those for
          private offerings (4(2), and Reg. D (Rules 505 and
          506)), intrastate offerings (3(a)(11) and Rule 147),
          issuer exchange offers (3(a)(9)), and transactions
          pursuant to fairness hearings (3(a)(10)).-[7]-

          The inclusive nature of the Form C-1 registration
          statement ensures that issuers could not use conduits
          to avoid liability that results from registration of
          securities.  Treating all sales as registered generally
          eliminates the need for concepts of restricted
          securities, integration, general solicitation,
          flowback, etc., with respect to securities issued by
          companies opting into the system.

     Where an issuer is not prepared to disclose publicly a
     material development or other material information that
     would otherwise be required to be disclosed in a registered
     offering, the issuer still can sell pursuant to the Form C-1
     by providing the information to the purchaser(s) on a

---------FOOTNOTES----------
     -[6]-     To the extent relevant during the transitional
               stages, secondary offerings of restricted
               securities by existing security holders could be
               made pursuant to the system as well.

     -[7]-     It may be necessary to preserve the Section
               3(a)(10) exemption for involuntary distributions
               pursuant to court orders, such as settlements of
               class actions.


==========================================START OF PAGE 11======

     confidential basis with a lock-up agreement.  The Commission
     would provide a full or partial exemption from its filing
     requirements for these limited placements if made to
     sophisticated investors, and accompanied by measures to
     ensure that those securities are not traded until full
     disclosure is provided to the public (as would be necessary
     under Rule 10b-5).

     In this manner, once the issuer makes public disclosure of
     the otherwise confidential information or the information is
     no longer material, the purchaser would have freely
     tradeable securities without any additional holding period
     or registration requirements.  In addition, unlike an exempt
     offering, the liability provisions of the Securities Act
     would attach to the securities originally issued in the
     limited offerings.


==========================================START OF PAGE 12======


     (a)  Exclusions:

          (i)  IPOs:  Only companies that have conducted a
               registered public offering of debt or equity would
               be eligible to use the company registration form.

          (ii) Complex securities not valued on the basis of the
               issuing company's business and financial
               information, such as asset backed or special
               purpose issuers.  Complex securities that are
               valued in part on the basis of the issuer's
               performance, such as structured securities or
               tracking securities (e.g., GM Series H) could be
               made eligible subject to special disclosure
               requirements.

          (iii)     Exempt securities such as commercial paper
                    and bank guaranteed debt.

     (b)  Voluntary Exclusions:

          (i)  Offshore offerings of any securities to non-U.S.
               persons could be excluded from the Form C-1.
               However, equity securities would be registered
               (and a fee paid with respect thereto) on the Form
               C-1 for purposes of any resales of the securities
               into the United States as a result of flowback
               transactions (the fee would be based upon the
               amount reasonably estimated to flow back into the
               United States; thus, U.S. purchasers of equity
               securities initially offered overseas would
               benefit from the statutory protections to the same
               extent as if the securities were initially sold in
               the United States.  The statute of limitations
               would run from the time of the initial overseas
               sale by the issuer.

          (ii) Placements of non-convertible debt to
               institutional investors could be excluded from the
               Form C-1.

          (iii)     Modified Company Registration -- "Company
                    Lite"  The issuer could elect a modified form
                    of company registration that would continue
                    to permit private placements of any of its
                    securities, including equity securities, as
                    well as reliance on the other transactional
                    exemptions.

               So long as the issuer undertakes to adopt the
               enhanced disclosure practices, the issuer would


     ==========================================START OF PAGE 13======

               have the benefits of the file and go registration
               process for its public offerings, the payment of
               filing fees at time of sale, and most of the other
               benefits of company registration.  Exempt sales
               would not be integrated with registered sales made
               pursuant to the Form
               C-1.

               However, the securities sold in the private
               placement would be restricted securities subject
               to current holding periods and resale limitations.

               In addition, the new, limited application of
               affiliate resale restrictions would not apply to
               securities sold by that issuer -- the current
               restrictions on affiliate resales would continue
               to apply.  Likewise, the statutory underwriter
               concept for resale purposes would not be limited
               to broker-dealer firms in connection with these
               private placements.  This approach would permit
               issuers to weigh the benefits of registration of
               all equity sales against the benefits of a
               continued private placement exemption, including
               the absence of Section 11 liability for sales made
               pursuant to such exemption.

4.   Disclosure Enhancements

     Complementing measures to ease issuer access to the market
     would be measures to improve the level and reliability of
     secondary market disclosure.  The Commission, following the
     pilot stage, should consider reviewing the enhancements to
     determine whether it would be desirable to make them
     applicable to all issuers, or at least those issuers using
     the shelf registration procedure, rather than having
     separate requirements applicable only to registered
     companies.

     (a)  Top Management Certifications   Certification to the
          Commission (not a filed document) would be required of
          two of the following four officers that they have
          reviewed the Form 10-K, the Form
          10-Qs and any Form 8-Ks reporting mandated events, but
          not for voluntarily filed 8-Ks, and are not aware of
          any misleading disclosures or omissions: the CEO, COO,
          CFO, or CAO.  The attestation would be required upon
          the filing of each such document with the Commission.

     (b)  Management Report to Audit Committee   A report
          prepared by management and submitted to the audit
          committee describing procedures followed to ensure the
          integrity of periodic and current reports and, in light
          of the new narrow application of affiliate resale


==========================================START OF PAGE 14======

          restrictions, procedures instituted to avoid potential
          insider trading abuses (e.g., any requirement that
          company insiders clear trades with the general
          counsel's office).  This report would be made public as
          an exhibit to the Form 10-K; the report need not be
          resubmitted if the described procedures are unchanged.

     (c)  Form 8-K Enhancements   Expansion of current reporting
          obligation on Form 8-K under the Exchange Act to
          mandate disclosure of additional material developments:


               (i)  Material modifications to rights of security
                    holders (current Item 2 of Form 10-Q);

               (ii)      Resignation or removal of any of top
                         five executive officers;

               (iii)     Defaults of senior securities (current
                         Item 3 of Form 10-Q);

               (iv)      Sales of significant percentage of the
                         company's outstanding stock (whether in
                         the form of common shares or convertible
                         securities);

               (v)  Issuer advised by independent auditor that
                    reliance on audit report included in previous
                    filings is no longer permissible because of
                    auditor concerns over its report or issuer
                    seeks to have a different auditor reaudit a
                    period covered by a filed audit report.

          For the above items that are required now to be filed
          on a Form    10-Q, the information therefore would be
          provided on a current, rather than a quarterly, basis.
          Moreover, the period within which a Form 8-K must be
          filed following any mandatory event specified in that
          form would be accelerated from 15 calendar days to 5
          business days.

     (d)  Risk Factors   Risk factor analysis disclosure
          requirements currently required in all Securities Act
          filings would be added to the Form
          10-K (and would thereby be capable of being
          incorporated by reference).  The caption could be
          modified to be "Significant Considerations in
          Connection with Investing in Company Securities,"
          instead of "Risk Factors," when the analysis is
          presented in the Form 10-K.


==========================================START OF PAGE 15======

     (e)  Other Action (Voluntary)  Companies under the company
          registration system also may voluntarily adopt measures
          such as the creation of a disclosure committee of
          outside directors, and the obtaining of SAS 71 reviews.

          Such measures would be included within the list of
          relevant factors for assessing the adequacy of due
          diligence in current Rule 176 (see below).


==========================================START OF PAGE 16======


5.   Liability

     Section 11 Liability  The issuer would be subject to strict
     Section 11 liability to purchasers of securities sold under
     the company registration statement for materially false or
     misleading information in the Form C-1 (including all
     incorporated information such as transactional information
     filed as part of the Form 8-K).  Officers, directors,
     experts and underwriters likewise would be liable for
     materially false or misleading statements in the Form C-1
     (including the transactional and updating information filed
     on the Form 8-K and incorporated into the Form C-1) and any
     post-effective amendments thereto (with the due diligence
     defenses afforded under current law).

     This approach does not represent a change in the liability
     system for public offerings (with the exception of sales by
     persons who would no longer be subject to resale
     restrictions and thus who would not have liability under
     Section 11 for their resales), but represents an expansion
     of liability to the extent transactions that would otherwise
     be exempt private placements or flowback from overseas
     placements are covered by the Form C-1.  In addition,
     because in many offerings the transactional information will
     be filed on a Form 8-K and made part of the registration
     statement, rather than merely part of a prospectus
     supplement as is the practice in shelf offerings today,
     Section 11 will apply to that disclosure when it has not
     been applicable under the current scheme.


          Similar to current law, the Section 11 remedy would
          extend to all purchasers of securities sold initially
          under the Form C-1 (subject to statute of limitations
          and the ability of purchasers to trace securities to
          the misleading registration statement).  Thus, issuers
          and affiliates cannot avoid liability by placing
          securities with conduits for resale to the public.
          Indeed, sham transactions involving strawmen would be
          deemed registered issuer (or affiliate) sales.

     Section 12(2) Liability  Rather than merely fraud liability,
     negligence liability for sellers in public offerings would
     apply to any selling materials serving as a statutory
     prospectus (i.e., no formal prospectus has been previously
     delivered) and incorporated documents (in addition to any
     Section 11 liability that might be applicable to those
     documents).  Likewise, oral communications will continue to
     be subject to Section 12(2) liability.


==========================================START OF PAGE 17======

     Exchange Act Liability  Liability under Sections 18 and
     10(b) of the Exchange Act and Rule 10b-5 thereunder, would
     remain applicable for material misstatements or omissions in
     filed reports or made in connection with the purchase or
     sale of securities.

     Due Diligence Guidance  To provide incentives for the
     adoption of improved disclosure practices and to address the
     expanded Section 11 liability exposure of officers and
     directors of registered companies, guidance setting forth
     the criteria for evaluating the adequacy of a non-issuer
     defendant's Section 11 due diligence in connection with a
     particular offering would be provided.  The goal is to
     enhance the quality of disclosure and to provide more
     meaningful guidance regarding the satisfaction by
     underwriters and directors of their ("reasonable
     investigation") due diligence responsibilities.  Rule 176
     currently specifies that a relevant factor is reasonable
     reliance on officers, employees and directors whose duties
     should have given them knowledge of the facts.

     Guidance would be provided to clarify as well the relevant
     factors that may be considered when such defendants attempt
     to establish a defense of "reasonable care" to a Section
     12(2) negligence claim.

     (a)  Both underwriters and outside directors could take into
          account
          (i) the certifications of senior management (e.g., CEO,
          COO, CAO and CFO) discussed above, and (ii) the
          Management Report to the Audit Committee discussed
          above.

     (b)  Underwriters and outside directors also may consider
          whether other professionals have reviewed the
          documents, such as a review of the issuer's interim
          financial statements by the company's auditors in
          accordance with SAS 71 or other more detailed
          procedures, subsequent event reviews consistent with
          SAS 37, and a "comfort letter" under SAS 72, or whether
          the board or a committee of the board received a Rule
          10b-5 opinion letter from counsel regarding non-
          financial and non-expertized portions of the periodic
          reports and Form C-1.

               Use of these measures by the issuer is voluntary
               and the fact that an issuer does not adopt such
               practices is not indicative of an inadequate
               review by offering participants.

     (c)  Underwriters also may consider the extent of their
          access to analysts (either their own or outside


==========================================START OF PAGE 18======

          analysts, and consistent with appropriate "chinese
          wall" procedures) that have followed the issuer for a
          significant period of time in determining how much
          additional due diligence must be performed by the
          underwriter in order to satisfy the applicable due
          diligence standard.

     (d)  Underwriters also may consider whether a Disclosure
          Committee (see below) was established and may take into
          account the scope of the review engaged in by the
          Disclosure Committee.

     (e)  These additional factors may be interpreted as indicia
          of "reasonable investigation"/"reasonable care," but
          such factors will be illustrative, not exhaustive or
          conclusive.  The degree to which any of such factors
          will serve as indicators will depend upon the
          particular facts of the offering (including whether the
          offering is a routine financing).

     Need to Monitor Developments  The Commission should solicit
     comment, and monitor developments regarding the due
     diligence practices of underwriters during the pilot stage,
     to determine if offering techniques developed under the
     company registration system adversely affect either investor
     protection or an underwriter's ability to perform due
     diligence or create an unreasonable risk of liability for
     underwriters.  The Commission then could consider whether
     the proposed new rule could be strengthened consistent with
     the protection of investors, premised perhaps on the
     underwriter following specified procedures to identify
     disclosure problems.

          After experience with the company registration system,
          consideration could be given to whether the additional
          due diligence benefits under these provisions could be
          made available to all registered offerings, not just
          those made pursuant to the Form C-1.  However, such
          benefits likely should be conditioned on adoption of
          the mandatory enhancements described in Section 4
          above, and extension of liability as described above.
          Consequently, it is likely that these additional
          benefits would be applicable only to the company
          registration system.

6.   Delegation to Disclosure Committee  The Committee
     considered, in the course of its deliberations on the
     company registration model, a separate proposal to expand
     the role of the outside directors in ensuring the integrity
     of corporate disclosures.  Although not an integral or
     necessary part of the company registration model developed
     by the Committee, the Committee determined to recommend that


==========================================START OF PAGE 19======

     the Commission endorse a new procedure that would allow (but
     not require) outside directors to use the issuer's audit
     committee or a separate committee of one or more outside
     directors (a "Disclosure Committee") to conduct
     investigation of the issuer's disclosures.  The Committee
     believes that this proposal has merit whether or not company
     registration is pursued by the Commission.

     The Disclosure Committee can perform the investigative
     function on behalf of all outside directors, so long as:

          (i) the delegating directors reasonably believe that
          the member(s) of the Disclosure Committee are
          sufficiently knowledgeable and capable of exercising
          the due diligence obligations on behalf of the outside
          directors (if necessary, with the assistance of their
          professional advisers) and with adequate resources,
          i.e., the delegation must be reasonable;

          (ii) the delegating directors maintain appropriate
          oversight of the Disclosure Committee (including by
          requiring the Disclosure Committee to report to the
          Board on the procedures followed to ensure the
          integrity of the disclosure) and reasonably believe
          that the Disclosure Committee's procedures are adequate
          and are being performed; and

          (iii) the delegating directors reasonably believe that
          the disclosure is not materially false or misleading.

7.   Summary of Benefits of the Proposed Company Registration
System

     (a)  Benefits to Issuers and Affiliates

               Speed of access to market: market considerations,
               rather than regulatory concerns, will govern
               timing -- elimination of mandatory waiting period
               and Commission staff review that now add cost and
               uncertainty.

               Greater flexibility to go to market more often in
               lesser amounts, in light of lower transaction
               costs and less delay and uncertainty -- adoption
               of "just in time capital" techniques.

               Elimination of the potential negative price impact
               known as "market overhang," that may still result
               from registering equity securities on a universal
               shelf for many issuers.


==========================================START OF PAGE 20======

               Greater flexibility in determining nature of
               marketing efforts -- timing and content of
               prospectus driven by informational needs of
               investors, not the need to prepare and deliver
               after-the-fact compliance documents determined by
               regulation.

               Elimination of a separate registration requirement
               for acquisitions.

               Payment of filing fees at time of sale, rather
               than in advance (as in the case of shelf
               offerings).

               Reduction or elimination of concerns regarding
               gun-jumping, integration, general solicitation,
               restricted securities, and other constructs
               developed over the years to maintain the
               separation of the public and private markets.

               Elimination of discount attaching to sale of
               restricted securities in private markets.

               Lower risk premiums paid on cost of capital as a
               result of enhanced disclosure practices.

     (b)  Benefits to Investors

               Disclosure enhancements will result in better due
               diligence practices and raise level and
               reliability of corporate reporting, benefitting
               purchasers in both primary offerings and in the
               secondary market.

               Greater flexibility in negotiating transactions
               due to elimination of regulatory constraints
               (eliminates timing constraints, fungibility
               constraints, resale restrictions, etc.).

               Protection afforded by registration provisions,
               including statutory remedies, potentially extended
               to broader class of transactions that otherwise
               would be conducted outside those protections, such
               as private placements or flowback of securities
               from overseas offerings.

               Full liquidity for what otherwise would be
               privately placed securities.

               In contrast to the prospectus supplement procedure
               currently used in shelf offerings, transactional
               information and material development disclosures


==========================================START OF PAGE 21======

               would be covered by Section 11 liability and
               provided to the trading markets in a more timely
               fashion.

               Lower costs of capital raising incurred by issuers
               will inure to the benefit of the issuer's
               shareholders through greater productivity and
               profits.

               Improved prospectus disclosure that permits
               issuers to prepare offering documents containing
               clear and concise information tailored to the
               needs of investors and the nature of the
               transaction.


==========================================START OF PAGE 22======

     (c)  Benefits to Underwriters, Officers, and Directors

               Elimination of registration requirements and
               resale restrictions with respect to most directors
               and officers that are imposed as a result of their
               status as "affiliates."

               Better opportunity to perform adequate due
               diligence due to Form 8-K filing requirements.

               Significantly better guidance as to what
               constitutes a reasonable investigation in the
               context of integrated disclosure and streamlined
               offering processes.

         UNITED STATES SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

        CHARTER OF THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
    ADVISORY COMMITTEE ON THE CAPITAL FORMATION AND REGULATORY
PROCESSES

                             Preamble

     In accordance with the terms and provisions of the Federal
Advisory Committee Act, as amended, 5 U.S.C. App., Chairman
Arthur Levitt, with the concurrence of the other members of the
Securities and Exchange Commission ("Commission"), hereby
establishes an Advisory Committee to advise the Commission
regarding the informational needs of investors and the regulatory
costs imposed on the U.S. securities markets.

                             Charter

     Pursuant to Section 9(c) of the Federal Advisory Committee
Act, and by direction of the Chairman of the Commission, with the
concurrence of the other members of the Commission:

     (A)  The Advisory Committee's official designation is the
"Securities and Exchange Commission Advisory Committee on the
Capital Formation and Regulatory Processes."

     (B)  The Advisory Committee's objective is to assist the
Commission in evaluating the efficiency and effectiveness of the
regulatory process and the disclosure requirements relating to
public offerings of securities, secondary market trading and
corporate reporting, and in identifying and developing means to
minimize costs imposed by current regulatory programs, from the
perspective of investors, issuers, the various market
participants, and other interested persons and regulatory
authorities.

     (C)  The Advisory Committee shall operate on a continuing
basis until the Chairman of the Commission, with the concurrence
of the other members of the Commission, determines that its
continuance is no longer in the public interest, subject to
paragraph (I) of this charter, set forth below, and Section
14(a)(2) of the Federal Advisory Committee Act.

     (D)  The Chairman of the Commission, or his designee, shall
receive the advice of the Advisory Committee on behalf of the
Commission.

     (E)  The Commission shall provide any necessary support
services.

     (F)  The duties of the Advisory Committee shall be solely
advisory and shall extend only to the submission of advice or
recommendations to the Commission.  Determinations of action to
be taken and policy to be expressed with respect to matters upon


==========================================START OF PAGE 2======

which the Advisory Committee provides advice or recommendations
shall be made solely by the Commission.

     (G)  The estimated annual operating costs in dollars and
staff-years of the Advisory Committee are as follows:

          (1)  Dollar Cost: $20,000 per year, for the travel, per
               diem, and miscellaneous expenses of Advisory
               Committee members and Commission personnel.

          (2)  Staff-Years:  3 staff-years, per year, of
               Commission personnel time on a continuing basis.

     (H)  The Advisory Committee shall meet at such intervals as
are necessary to carry out its functions.  It is estimated the
meetings of the full Advisory Committee generally will occur no
more frequently than nine times; meetings of subgroups of the
full Advisory Committee will likely occur more frequently.

     (I)  The Advisory Committee shall terminate at the end of
one year from the date of its establishment unless, prior to such
time, its charter is renewed in accordance with the Federal
Advisory Committee Act, or unless the Chairman, with the
concurrence of the other members of the Commission, shall direct
that the Advisory Committee terminate on an earlier date.

     (J)  This charter has been filed with the Chairman of the
Commission, the Senate Committee on Banking, Housing, and Urban
Affairs, the House Committee on Commerce, and furnished to the
Library of Congress on February 24, 1995.





                              __/s/______________________________
                              Arthur Levitt
                              Chairman


         UNITED STATES SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

        CHARTER OF THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
    ADVISORY COMMITTEE ON THE CAPITAL FORMATION AND REGULATORY
                             PROCESSES

                             Preamble


     In accordance with the terms and provisions of the Federal
Advisory Committee Act, as amended, 5 U.S.C. App., Chairman
Arthur Levitt, with the concurrence of the other members of the
Securities and Exchange Commission ("Commission"), hereby renews
an Advisory Committee to advise the Commission regarding the
informational needs of investors and the regulatory costs imposed
on the U.S. securities markets.

                             Charter

     Pursuant to Section 9(c) of the Federal Advisory Committee
Act, and by direction of the Chairman of the Commission, with the
concurrence of the other members of the Commission:

     (A)  The Advisory Committee's official designation is the
"Securities and Exchange Commission Advisory Committee on the
Capital Formation and Regulatory Processes."

     (B)  The Advisory Committee's objective is to assist the
Commission in evaluating the efficiency and effectiveness of the
regulatory process and the disclosure requirements relating to
public offerings of securities, secondary market trading and
corporate reporting, and in identifying and developing means to
minimize costs imposed by current regulatory programs, from the
perspective of investors, issuers, the various market
participants, and other interested persons and regulatory
authorities.

     (C)  The Advisory Committee shall operate on a continuing
basis until the Chairman of the Commission, with the concurrence
of the other members of the Commission, determines that its
continuance is no longer in the public interest, subject to
paragraph (I) of this charter, set forth below, and Section
14(a)(2) of the Federal Advisory Committee Act.

     (D)  The Chairman of the Commission, or his designee, shall
receive the advice of the Advisory Committee on behalf of the
Commission.

     (E)  The Commission shall provide any necessary support
services.


==========================================START OF PAGE 2======

     (F)  The duties of the Advisory Committee shall be solely
advisory and shall extend only to the submission of advice or
recommendations to the Commission.  Determinations of action to
be taken and policy to be expressed with respect to matters upon
which the Advisory Committee provides advice or recommendations
shall be made solely by the Commission.

     (G)  The estimated annual operating costs in dollars and
staff-years of the Advisory Committee are as follows:

          (1)  Dollar Cost: $20,000 per year, for the travel, per
               diem, and miscellaneous expenses of Advisory
               Committee members and Commission personnel.

          (2)  Staff-Years:  1 staff-year, per year, of
               Commission personnel time on a continuing basis.

     (H)  The Advisory Committee shall meet at such intervals as
are necessary to carry out its functions.  It is estimated the
meetings of the full Advisory Committee generally will occur no
more frequently than 5 times; meetings of subgroups of the full
Advisory Committee will likely occur more frequently.

     (I)  The Advisory Committee shall terminate on September 30,
1996, unless, prior to such time, its charter is renewed in
accordance with the Federal Advisory Committee Act, or unless the
Chairman, with the concurrence of the other members of the
Commission, shall direct that the Advisory Committee terminate on
an earlier date.

     (J)  This charter has been filed with the Chairman of the
Commission, the Senate Committee on Banking, Housing, and Urban
Affairs, the House Committee on Commerce, and furnished to the
Library of Congress on February 21, 1996.






__/s/________________________________
                              Arthur Levitt
                              Chairman




Last Reviewed or Updated: March 24, 2026